Import pkg_install from NetBSD
Change-Id: I9a3071b94dd2e9bfe2e3b162994e06ae10077b5a
This commit is contained in:
parent
ebfedea0ce
commit
a824f5a100
79 changed files with 18408 additions and 1 deletions
|
@ -2340,6 +2340,7 @@
|
|||
./usr/man/man1/basename.1 minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/bdes.1 minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/bg.1 minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/bpm.1 minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/break.1 minix-sys obsolete
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/bsdtar.1 minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/bsfilt.1 minix-sys
|
||||
|
@ -2557,6 +2558,11 @@
|
|||
./usr/man/man1/pathchk.1 minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/pax.1 minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/ping.1 minix-sys obsolete
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/pkg_add.1 minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/pkg_admin.1 minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/pkg_create.1 minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/pkg_delete.1 minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/pkg_info.1 minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/pkg_view.1 minix-sys obsolete
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/playwave.1 minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/man/man1/popd.1 minix-sys
|
||||
|
@ -5339,10 +5345,13 @@
|
|||
./usr/preserve minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/run minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/audit-packages minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/bpm minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/btrace minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/chown minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/chroot minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/diskctl minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/download-vulnerability-list minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/fbdctl minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/group minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/groupadd minix-sys
|
||||
|
@ -5358,6 +5367,11 @@
|
|||
./usr/sbin/mkproto minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/mtree minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/newfs_mfs minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/pkg_add minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/pkg_admin minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/pkg_create minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/pkg_delete minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/pkg_info minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/postinstall minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/pwd_mkdb minix-sys
|
||||
./usr/sbin/rdate minix-sys
|
||||
|
|
2
external/bsd/Makefile
vendored
2
external/bsd/Makefile
vendored
|
@ -10,7 +10,7 @@ SUBDIR= byacc fetch file flex less \
|
|||
SUBDIR+= atf
|
||||
.endif
|
||||
.if (${MKCRYPTO} != "no")
|
||||
#SUBDIR+= pkg_install
|
||||
SUBDIR+= pkg_install
|
||||
.endif
|
||||
# IP Filter
|
||||
.if (${MKIPFILTER} != "no")
|
||||
|
|
5
external/bsd/pkg_install/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
5
external/bsd/pkg_install/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
|
|||
# $NetBSD: Makefile,v 1.1 2008/09/30 19:19:56 joerg Exp $
|
||||
|
||||
SUBDIR= lib .WAIT sbin
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.subdir.mk>
|
13
external/bsd/pkg_install/Makefile.inc
vendored
Normal file
13
external/bsd/pkg_install/Makefile.inc
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,13 @@
|
|||
# $NetBSD: Makefile.inc,v 1.4 2011/09/16 16:41:20 joerg Exp $
|
||||
|
||||
DIST= ${NETBSDSRCDIR}/external/bsd/pkg_install/dist
|
||||
|
||||
USE_FORT?=yes # network client
|
||||
|
||||
CPPFLAGS+=-I${DIST}/lib
|
||||
CPPFLAGS+=-I${NETBSDSRCDIR}/external/bsd/pkg_install/lib
|
||||
CPPFLAGS+=-DHAVE_CONFIG_H -DNETBSD -DHAVE_SSL
|
||||
CPPFLAGS+=-DSYSCONFDIR='"/etc"'
|
||||
|
||||
WARNS= 4
|
||||
CWARNFLAGS+= -Wno-missing-noreturn
|
50
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/add/add.h
vendored
Normal file
50
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/add/add.h
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: add.h,v 1.1.1.7 2011/02/18 22:32:27 aymeric Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/* from FreeBSD Id: add.h,v 1.8 1997/02/22 16:09:15 peter Exp */
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Include and define various things wanted by the add command.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _INST_ADD_H_INCLUDE
|
||||
#define _INST_ADD_H_INCLUDE
|
||||
|
||||
extern char *Destdir;
|
||||
extern char *OverrideMachine;
|
||||
extern char *Prefix;
|
||||
extern char *View;
|
||||
extern char *Viewbase;
|
||||
extern Boolean NoView;
|
||||
extern Boolean NoInstall;
|
||||
extern Boolean NoRecord;
|
||||
extern Boolean Force;
|
||||
extern Boolean Automatic;
|
||||
extern int LicenseCheck;
|
||||
extern int Replace;
|
||||
extern int ReplaceSame;
|
||||
|
||||
extern Boolean ForceDepends;
|
||||
extern Boolean ForceDepending;
|
||||
|
||||
int make_hierarchy(char *);
|
||||
void apply_perms(char *, char **, int);
|
||||
|
||||
int pkg_perform(lpkg_head_t *);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _INST_ADD_H_INCLUDE */
|
221
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/add/main.c
vendored
Normal file
221
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/add/main.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,221 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: main.c,v 1.1.1.10 2011/02/18 22:32:27 aymeric Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: main.c,v 1.1.1.10 2011/02/18 22:32:27 aymeric Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is the add module.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H
|
||||
#include <sys/param.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
#include "add.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static char Options[] = "AC:DIK:LP:RVW:fhm:np:t:Uuvw:";
|
||||
|
||||
char *Destdir = NULL;
|
||||
char *OverrideMachine = NULL;
|
||||
char *Prefix = NULL;
|
||||
char *View = NULL;
|
||||
char *Viewbase = NULL;
|
||||
Boolean NoView = FALSE;
|
||||
Boolean NoInstall = FALSE;
|
||||
Boolean NoRecord = FALSE;
|
||||
Boolean Automatic = FALSE;
|
||||
Boolean ForceDepends = FALSE;
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Normally, updating fails if the dependencies of a depending package
|
||||
* are not satisfied by the package to be updated. ForceDepending
|
||||
* turns that failure into a warning.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
Boolean ForceDepending = FALSE;
|
||||
|
||||
int LicenseCheck = 0;
|
||||
int Replace = 0;
|
||||
int ReplaceSame = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
usage(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
(void) fprintf(stderr, "%s\n%s\n%s\n%s\n",
|
||||
"usage: pkg_add [-AfhILnRuVv] [-C config] [-P destdir] [-K pkg_dbdir]",
|
||||
" [-m machine] [-p prefix] [-s verification-type",
|
||||
" [-W viewbase] [-w view]\n",
|
||||
" [[ftp|http]://[user[:password]@]host[:port]][/path/]pkg-name ...");
|
||||
exit(1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
main(int argc, char **argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int ch, error=0;
|
||||
lpkg_head_t pkgs;
|
||||
|
||||
setprogname(argv[0]);
|
||||
while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, Options)) != -1) {
|
||||
switch (ch) {
|
||||
case 'A':
|
||||
Automatic = TRUE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'C':
|
||||
config_file = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'D':
|
||||
ForceDepending = TRUE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'P':
|
||||
Destdir = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'f':
|
||||
Force = TRUE;
|
||||
ForceDepends = TRUE;
|
||||
ForceDepending = TRUE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'I':
|
||||
NoInstall = TRUE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'K':
|
||||
pkgdb_set_dir(optarg, 3);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'L':
|
||||
NoView = TRUE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'R':
|
||||
NoRecord = TRUE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'm':
|
||||
OverrideMachine = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'n':
|
||||
Fake = TRUE;
|
||||
Verbose = TRUE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'p':
|
||||
Prefix = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'U':
|
||||
ReplaceSame = 1;
|
||||
Replace = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'u':
|
||||
Replace = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'V':
|
||||
show_version();
|
||||
/* NOTREACHED */
|
||||
|
||||
case 'v':
|
||||
Verbose = TRUE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'W':
|
||||
Viewbase = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'w':
|
||||
View = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'h':
|
||||
case '?':
|
||||
default:
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
argc -= optind;
|
||||
argv += optind;
|
||||
|
||||
pkg_install_config();
|
||||
|
||||
if (Destdir != NULL) {
|
||||
char *pkgdbdir;
|
||||
|
||||
pkgdbdir = xasprintf("%s/%s", Destdir, config_pkg_dbdir);
|
||||
pkgdb_set_dir(pkgdbdir, 4);
|
||||
free(pkgdbdir);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
process_pkg_path();
|
||||
TAILQ_INIT(&pkgs);
|
||||
|
||||
if (argc == 0) {
|
||||
/* If no packages, yelp */
|
||||
warnx("missing package name(s)");
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (strcasecmp(do_license_check, "no") == 0)
|
||||
LicenseCheck = 0;
|
||||
else if (strcasecmp(do_license_check, "yes") == 0)
|
||||
LicenseCheck = 1;
|
||||
else if (strcasecmp(do_license_check, "always") == 0)
|
||||
LicenseCheck = 2;
|
||||
else
|
||||
errx(1, "Unknown value of the configuration variable"
|
||||
"CHECK_LICENSE");
|
||||
|
||||
if (LicenseCheck)
|
||||
load_license_lists();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Get all the remaining package names, if any */
|
||||
for (; argc > 0; --argc, ++argv) {
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp;
|
||||
|
||||
if (IS_STDIN(*argv))
|
||||
lpp = alloc_lpkg("-");
|
||||
else
|
||||
lpp = alloc_lpkg(*argv);
|
||||
|
||||
TAILQ_INSERT_TAIL(&pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
error += pkg_perform(&pkgs);
|
||||
if (error != 0) {
|
||||
warnx("%d package addition%s failed", error, error == 1 ? "" : "s");
|
||||
exit(1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
exit(0);
|
||||
}
|
1607
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/add/perform.c
vendored
Normal file
1607
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/add/perform.c
vendored
Normal file
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load diff
448
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/add/pkg_add.1
vendored
Normal file
448
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/add/pkg_add.1
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,448 @@
|
|||
.\" $NetBSD: pkg_add.1,v 1.1.1.12 2011/02/18 22:32:28 aymeric Exp $
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintenance
|
||||
.\" of non-core utilities.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
.\" are met:
|
||||
.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" @(#)pkg_add.1
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.Dd June 16, 2010
|
||||
.Dt PKG_ADD 1
|
||||
.Os
|
||||
.Sh NAME
|
||||
.Nm pkg_add
|
||||
.Nd a utility for installing and upgrading software package distributions
|
||||
.Sh SYNOPSIS
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
.Op Fl AfILnRUuVv
|
||||
.Op Fl C Ar config
|
||||
.Op Fl K Ar pkg_dbdir
|
||||
.Op Fl m Ar machine
|
||||
.Op Fl P Ar destdir
|
||||
.Op Fl p Ar prefix
|
||||
.Op Fl W Ar viewbase
|
||||
.Op Fl w Ar view
|
||||
.Ar Oo Oo Li ftp|http Oc Ns Li :// Ns Oo Ar user Oc Ns \
|
||||
Oo Li \&: Ns Ar password Oc \
|
||||
Ns Li @ Oc Ns Ar host Ns Oo Li \&: Ns Ar port Oc Ns \
|
||||
Oo Li / Ns Ar path/ Oc Ns Ar pkg-name ...
|
||||
.Sh DESCRIPTION
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
command is used to extract and upgrade packages that have been
|
||||
previously created with the
|
||||
.Xr pkg_create 1
|
||||
command.
|
||||
Packages are prepared collections of pre-built binaries, documentation,
|
||||
configurations, installation instructions and/or other files.
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
can recursively install other packages that the current package
|
||||
depends on or requires from both local disk and via FTP or HTTP.
|
||||
.Sh WARNING
|
||||
.Bf -emphasis
|
||||
Since the
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
command may execute scripts or programs contained within a package file,
|
||||
your system may be susceptible to
|
||||
.Dq Trojan horses
|
||||
or other subtle
|
||||
attacks from miscreants who create dangerous package files.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
You are advised to verify the competence and identity of those who
|
||||
provide installable package files.
|
||||
For extra protection, use the digital signatures provided where possible
|
||||
(see the
|
||||
.Xr pkg_install.conf 5 ) ,
|
||||
or, failing that, use
|
||||
.Xr tar 1
|
||||
to extract the package file, and inspect its contents and scripts
|
||||
to ensure it poses no danger to your system's integrity.
|
||||
Pay particular attention to any
|
||||
.Pa +INSTALL
|
||||
or
|
||||
.Pa +DEINSTALL
|
||||
files, and inspect the
|
||||
.Pa +CONTENTS
|
||||
file for
|
||||
.Cm @cwd ,
|
||||
.Cm @mode
|
||||
(check for setuid),
|
||||
.Cm @dirrm ,
|
||||
.Cm @exec ,
|
||||
and
|
||||
.Cm @unexec
|
||||
directives, and/or use the
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1
|
||||
command to examine the package file.
|
||||
.Ef
|
||||
.Sh OPTIONS
|
||||
The following command line arguments are supported:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent
|
||||
.It Ar pkg-name [ ... ]
|
||||
The named packages are installed.
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
will first try to use
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name
|
||||
as full URL or path name without any wildcard processing.
|
||||
If that fails,
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
will try to match packages using wildcard processing.
|
||||
If that fails as well and
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name
|
||||
does not contain any /, the entries of the
|
||||
.Dv PKG_PATH
|
||||
variable are searched using the wildcard processing rules.
|
||||
.It Fl A
|
||||
Mark package as installed automatically, as dependency of another
|
||||
package.
|
||||
You can use
|
||||
.Dl Ic pkg_admin set automatic=YES
|
||||
to mark packages this way after installation, and
|
||||
.Dl Ic pkg_admin unset automatic
|
||||
to remove the mark.
|
||||
If you
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
a package without specifying
|
||||
.Fl A
|
||||
after it had already been automatically installed, the mark is
|
||||
removed.
|
||||
.It Fl C Ar config
|
||||
Read the configuration file from
|
||||
.Ar config
|
||||
instead of the system default.
|
||||
.It Fl f
|
||||
Force installation to proceed even if prerequisite packages are not
|
||||
installed or the install script fails.
|
||||
Although
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
will still try to find and auto-install missing prerequisite packages,
|
||||
a failure to find one will not be fatal.
|
||||
This flag also overrides the fatal error when the operating system or
|
||||
architecture the package was built on differ from that of the host.
|
||||
.It Fl D
|
||||
Force updating even if the dependencies of depending packages are not
|
||||
satisfied by the new package.
|
||||
This is used by "make replace", after which one would typically
|
||||
replace the depending packages.
|
||||
.It Fl I
|
||||
If an installation script exists for a given package, do not execute it.
|
||||
.It Fl K Ar pkg_dbdir
|
||||
Override the value of the
|
||||
.Dv PKG_DBDIR
|
||||
configuration option with the value
|
||||
.Ar pkg_dbdir .
|
||||
.It Fl L
|
||||
Don't add the package to any views after installation.
|
||||
.It Fl m
|
||||
Override the machine architecture returned by uname with
|
||||
.Ar machine .
|
||||
.It Fl n
|
||||
Don't actually install a package, just report the steps that
|
||||
would be taken if it was.
|
||||
.It Fl P Ar destdir
|
||||
Prefix all file and directory names with
|
||||
.Ar destdir .
|
||||
For packages without install scripts this has the same behavior as
|
||||
using
|
||||
.Xr chroot 8 .
|
||||
.It Fl p Ar prefix
|
||||
Override the prefix stored in the package with
|
||||
.Ar prefix .
|
||||
.It Fl R
|
||||
Do not record the installation of a package.
|
||||
This implies
|
||||
.Fl I .
|
||||
This means that you cannot deinstall it later, so only use this option if
|
||||
you know what you are doing!
|
||||
.It Fl U
|
||||
Replace an already installed version from a package.
|
||||
Implies
|
||||
.Fl u .
|
||||
.It Fl u
|
||||
If the package that's being installed is already installed,
|
||||
an update is performed.
|
||||
Installed dependent packages are updated recursively, if they are too
|
||||
old to fulfill the dependencies of the to-be-installed version.
|
||||
See below for a more detailed description of the process.
|
||||
.It Fl V
|
||||
Print version number and exit.
|
||||
.It Fl v
|
||||
Turn on verbose output.
|
||||
.It Fl W Ar viewbase
|
||||
Passed down to
|
||||
.Xr pkg_view 1
|
||||
for managed views.
|
||||
.It Fl w Ar view
|
||||
Passed down to
|
||||
.Xr pkg_view 1
|
||||
for managed views.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
One or more
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name
|
||||
arguments may be specified, each being either a file containing the
|
||||
package (these usually ending with the
|
||||
.Dq .tgz
|
||||
suffix) or a
|
||||
URL pointing at a file available on an ftp or web site.
|
||||
Thus you may extract files directly from their anonymous ftp or WWW
|
||||
locations (e.g.,
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
ftp://ftp.NetBSD.org/pub/pkgsrc/packages/NetBSD/i386/3.1_2007Q2/shells/bash-3.2.9.tgz
|
||||
or
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
http://www.example.org/packages/screen-4.0.tbz).
|
||||
Note: For ftp transfers, if you wish to use
|
||||
.Bf -emphasis
|
||||
passive mode
|
||||
.Ef
|
||||
ftp in such transfers, set the variable
|
||||
.Bf -emphasis
|
||||
FTP_PASSIVE_MODE
|
||||
.Ef
|
||||
to some value in your environment.
|
||||
Otherwise, the more standard ACTIVE mode may be used.
|
||||
If
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
consistently fails to fetch a package from a site known to work,
|
||||
it may be because you have a firewall that demands the usage of
|
||||
.Bf -emphasis
|
||||
passive mode
|
||||
.Ef
|
||||
ftp.
|
||||
.Sh TECHNICAL DETAILS
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
extracts each package's meta data (including the
|
||||
.Dq packing list )
|
||||
to memory and then runs through the following sequence to fully extract
|
||||
the contents of the package:
|
||||
.Bl -enum -offset indent
|
||||
.It
|
||||
A check is made to determine if the package or another version of it
|
||||
is already recorded as installed.
|
||||
If it is,
|
||||
installation is terminated if the
|
||||
.Fl u
|
||||
or
|
||||
.Fl U
|
||||
options are not given.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
If the same version is installed and
|
||||
.Fl U
|
||||
is not given, it is marked as manually installed and process stops.
|
||||
If the
|
||||
.Fl u
|
||||
option is given, it's assumed the package should be replaced by the
|
||||
new version instead.
|
||||
Before doing so, all packages that depend on the
|
||||
pkg being upgraded are checked if they also work with the new version.
|
||||
If that test is not successful, the dependent packages are updated first.
|
||||
The replacing is then prepared by moving an existing
|
||||
.Pa +REQUIRED_BY
|
||||
file aside (if it exists), and running
|
||||
.Xr pkg_delete 1
|
||||
on the installed package.
|
||||
Installation then proceeds as if the package
|
||||
was not installed, and restores the
|
||||
.Pa +REQUIRED_BY
|
||||
file afterwards.
|
||||
.It
|
||||
The package build information is extracted from the
|
||||
.Pa +BUILD_INFO
|
||||
file and compared against the result of
|
||||
.Xr uname 3 .
|
||||
If the operating system or architecture of the package differ from
|
||||
that of the host, installation is aborted.
|
||||
This behavior is overridable with the
|
||||
.Fl f
|
||||
flag.
|
||||
.It
|
||||
The package build information from
|
||||
.Pa +BUILD_INFO
|
||||
is then checked for
|
||||
.Ev USE_ABI_DEPENDS=NO
|
||||
(or
|
||||
.Ev IGNORE_RECOMMENDED ) .
|
||||
If the package was built with ABI dependency recommendations ignored,
|
||||
a warning will be issued.
|
||||
.It
|
||||
A check is made to determine if the package conflicts (from
|
||||
.Cm @pkgcfl
|
||||
directives, see
|
||||
.Xr pkg_create 1 )
|
||||
with an already recorded as installed package or if an installed package
|
||||
conflicts with the package.
|
||||
If it is, installation is terminated.
|
||||
.It
|
||||
The file list of the package is compared to the file lists of the
|
||||
installed packages.
|
||||
If there is any overlap, the installation is terminated.
|
||||
.It
|
||||
All package dependencies (from
|
||||
.Cm @pkgdep
|
||||
directives, see
|
||||
.Xr pkg_create 1 )
|
||||
are read from the packing list.
|
||||
If any of these required packages are not currently installed,
|
||||
an attempt is made to find and install it;
|
||||
if the missing package cannot be found or installed,
|
||||
the installation is terminated.
|
||||
.It
|
||||
If the package contains an
|
||||
.Ar install
|
||||
script, it is executed with the following arguments:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indentindent
|
||||
.It Ar pkg-name
|
||||
The name of the package being installed.
|
||||
.It Cm PRE-INSTALL
|
||||
Keyword denoting that the script is to perform any actions needed before
|
||||
the package is installed.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
If the
|
||||
.Ar install
|
||||
script exits with a non-zero status code, the installation is terminated.
|
||||
.It
|
||||
The files from the file list are extracted to the chosen prefix.
|
||||
.It
|
||||
If an
|
||||
.Ar install
|
||||
script exists for the package, it is executed with the following arguments:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indentindent
|
||||
.It Ar pkg_name
|
||||
The name of the package being installed.
|
||||
.It Cm POST-INSTALL
|
||||
Keyword denoting that the script is to perform any actions needed
|
||||
after the package has been installed.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.It
|
||||
After installation is complete, a copy of the packing list,
|
||||
.Ar deinstall
|
||||
script, description, and display files are copied into
|
||||
.Pa \*[Lt]PKG_DBDIR\*[Gt]/\*[Lt]pkg-name\*[Gt]
|
||||
for subsequent possible use by
|
||||
.Xr pkg_delete 1 .
|
||||
Any package dependencies are recorded in the other packages'
|
||||
.Pa +REQUIRED_BY
|
||||
file.
|
||||
.It
|
||||
If the package is a depoted package, then add it to the registered
|
||||
by calling
|
||||
.Xr pkg_view 1
|
||||
accordingly.
|
||||
.It
|
||||
Finally, if we were upgrading a package, any
|
||||
.Pa +REQUIRED_BY
|
||||
file that was moved aside before upgrading was started is now moved
|
||||
back into place.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Ar install
|
||||
script is called with the environment variable
|
||||
.Ev PKG_PREFIX
|
||||
set to the installation prefix (see the
|
||||
.Fl p
|
||||
option above).
|
||||
This allows a package author to write a script
|
||||
that reliably performs some action on the directory where the package
|
||||
is installed, even if the user might change it with the
|
||||
.Fl p
|
||||
flag to
|
||||
.Cm pkg_add .
|
||||
The scripts are also called with the
|
||||
.Ev PKG_METADATA_DIR
|
||||
environment variable set to the location of the
|
||||
.Pa +*
|
||||
meta-data files, and with the
|
||||
.Ev PKG_REFCOUNT_DBDIR
|
||||
environment variable set to the location of the package reference counts
|
||||
database directory.
|
||||
If the
|
||||
.Fl P
|
||||
flag was given to
|
||||
.Nm ,
|
||||
.Ev PKG_DESTDIR
|
||||
will be set to
|
||||
.Ar destdir .
|
||||
Additionally,
|
||||
.Ev PKG_METADATA_DIR
|
||||
and
|
||||
.Ev PKG_REFCOUNT_DBDIR
|
||||
are prefixed with
|
||||
.Ar destdir .
|
||||
.Sh ENVIRONMENT
|
||||
See
|
||||
.Xr pkg_install.conf 5
|
||||
for options, that can also be specified using the environment.
|
||||
Packages using views are also affected by the environment variables
|
||||
documented for
|
||||
.Xr pkg_view 1 .
|
||||
.Sh EXAMPLES
|
||||
In all cases,
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
will try to install binary packages listed in dependencies list.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
You can specify a compiled binary package explicitly on the command line.
|
||||
.Bd -literal
|
||||
# pkg_add /usr/pkgsrc/packages/All/tcsh-6.14.00.tgz
|
||||
.Ed
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
If you omit the version number,
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
will install the latest version available.
|
||||
With
|
||||
.Fl v ,
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
emits more messages to terminal.
|
||||
.Bd -literal
|
||||
# pkg_add -v /usr/pkgsrc/packages/All/unzip
|
||||
.Ed
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
You can grab a compiled binary package from remote location by specifying
|
||||
a URL.
|
||||
The base URL can also be provided by the configuration variable,
|
||||
.Dv PKG_PATH .
|
||||
.Bd -literal
|
||||
# pkg_add -v ftp://ftp.NetBSD.org/pub/pkgsrc/packages/NetBSD/i386/3.1_2007Q2/All/firefox-2.0.0.4.tgz
|
||||
|
||||
# export PKG_PATH=ftp://ftp.NetBSD.org/pub/pkgsrc/packages/NetBSD/i386/3.1_2007Q2/All
|
||||
# pkg_add -v firefox
|
||||
.Ed
|
||||
.Sh SEE ALSO
|
||||
.Xr pkg_admin 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_create 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_delete 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_install.conf 5 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkgsrc 7
|
||||
.Sh AUTHORS
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent -compact
|
||||
.It "Jordan Hubbard"
|
||||
Initial work and ongoing development.
|
||||
.It "John Kohl"
|
||||
.Nx
|
||||
refinements.
|
||||
.It "Hubert Feyrer"
|
||||
.Nx
|
||||
wildcard dependency processing, pkgdb, upgrading, etc.
|
||||
.It Thomas Klausner
|
||||
HTTP support.
|
||||
.It Joerg Sonnenberger
|
||||
Rewrote most of the code base to work without external commands.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Sh BUGS
|
||||
Package upgrading needs a lot more work to be really universal.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
Sure to be others.
|
39
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/admin.h
vendored
Normal file
39
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/admin.h
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,39 @@
|
|||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
* TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
* PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
* CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
* SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
* INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
* CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
* ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
* POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int quiet;
|
||||
extern int verbose;
|
||||
|
||||
void check(char **);
|
||||
|
||||
void audit_pkgdb(int, char **);
|
||||
void audit_pkg(int, char **);
|
||||
void audit_batch(int, char **);
|
||||
void audit_history(int, char **);
|
||||
void check_pkg_vulnerabilities(int, char **);
|
||||
void fetch_pkg_vulnerabilities(int, char **);
|
||||
|
||||
void usage(void);
|
66
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/audit-packages.8
vendored
Normal file
66
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/audit-packages.8
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,66 @@
|
|||
.\" $NetBSD: audit-packages.8,v 1.1.1.1 2010/04/23 20:54:06 joerg Exp $
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Copyright (c) 2010 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
.\" All rights reserved.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
.\" by Thomas Klausner.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
.\" are met:
|
||||
.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
.\" ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
.\" TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
.\" PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
.\" POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.Dd March 18, 2010
|
||||
.Dt AUDIT-PACKAGES 8
|
||||
.Os
|
||||
.Sh NAME
|
||||
.Nm audit-packages
|
||||
.Nd report vulnerabilities for the installed packages
|
||||
.Sh SYNOPSIS
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
.Op Fl deqsVv
|
||||
.Op Fl c Ar config_file
|
||||
.Op Fl F Ar file
|
||||
.Op Fl g Ar file
|
||||
.Op Fl h Ar file
|
||||
.Op Fl K Ar pkg_dbdir
|
||||
.Op Fl n Ar package
|
||||
.Op Fl p Ar package
|
||||
.Op Fl Q Ar varname
|
||||
.Op Fl t Ar type
|
||||
.Sh DESCRIPTION
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
is deprecated.
|
||||
Please use the
|
||||
.Cm audit ,
|
||||
.Cm audit-pkg ,
|
||||
.Cm audit-batch ,
|
||||
and
|
||||
.Cm fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities
|
||||
commands of
|
||||
.Xr pkg_admin 1
|
||||
instead.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
script is installed for backwards compatibility only and will
|
||||
eventually be removed.
|
||||
.Sh SEE ALSO
|
||||
.Xr pkg_admin 1
|
130
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/audit-packages.sh.in
vendored
Normal file
130
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/audit-packages.sh.in
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,130 @@
|
|||
#!/bin/sh
|
||||
|
||||
pkg_admin=@PKG_ADMIN@
|
||||
|
||||
usage() {
|
||||
echo 'Usage: audit-packages [-deqsVv] [-c config_file] [-F file]' >& $2
|
||||
echo ' [-g file] [-h file]' >& $2
|
||||
echo ' [-K pkg_dbdir] [-n package] [-p package]' >& $2
|
||||
echo ' [-Q varname] [-t type]' >& $2
|
||||
echo "Please use the audit, audit-pkg, audit-batch and fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities" >& $2
|
||||
echo "commands of pkg_admin instead." >& $2
|
||||
exit $1
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
do_pkgdb=
|
||||
do_eol=
|
||||
do_fetch=
|
||||
do_quiet=
|
||||
do_sign=
|
||||
do_verbose=
|
||||
do_check_file=
|
||||
do_check_pattern=
|
||||
do_check_installed=
|
||||
do_check_vul_file=
|
||||
do_limit_type=
|
||||
do_print_var=
|
||||
|
||||
args=`getopt F:K:Q:Vc:deg:h:n:p:qst:v $*`
|
||||
if [ $? -ne 0 ]; then
|
||||
usage 1 2
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
set -- $args
|
||||
|
||||
while [ $# -gt 0 ]; do
|
||||
case "$1" in
|
||||
-F)
|
||||
do_check_file=$2
|
||||
shift
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-K)
|
||||
do_pkgdb="$1 $2"
|
||||
shift
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-Q)
|
||||
do_print_var="$2"
|
||||
shift
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-V)
|
||||
exec ${pkg_admin} -V
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-c)
|
||||
echo "The audit-packages wrapper does not support -c" >&2
|
||||
echo "Please use the audit, audit-pkg, audit-batch and fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities" >& 2
|
||||
echo "commands of pkg_admin instead." >& 2
|
||||
exit 1
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-d)
|
||||
do_fetch=1
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-e)
|
||||
do_eol=-e
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-g)
|
||||
echo "The audit-packages wrapper does not support -g" >&2
|
||||
echo "Please switch to \`\`pkg_admin fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities''." >&2
|
||||
exit 1
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-h)
|
||||
do_check_vul_file=$2
|
||||
shift
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-n)
|
||||
do_check_pattern=$2
|
||||
shift
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-p)
|
||||
do_check_installed=$2
|
||||
shift
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-q)
|
||||
do_quiet=-q
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-s)
|
||||
do_sign=-s
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-t)
|
||||
do_limit_type="-t $2"
|
||||
shift
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-v)
|
||||
do_verbose="$do_verbose -v"
|
||||
;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
shift
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
if [ -n "${do_fetch}" ]; then
|
||||
exec ${pkg_admin} ${do_pkgdb} fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities ${do_sign}
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
if [ -n "${do_check_vul_file}" ]; then
|
||||
exec ${pkg_admin} ${do_pkgdb} check-pkg-vulnerabilities ${do_sign} "${do_check_vul_file}"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
if [ -n "${do_print_var}" ]; then
|
||||
exec ${pkg_admin} ${do_pkgdb} config-var "${do_print_var}"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
if [ -n "${do_check_file}" ]; then
|
||||
if [ -n "${do_check_pattern}" -o -n "${do_check_installed}" ]; then
|
||||
echo "Only one of -F, -n or -p is interpreted at a time." >& 2
|
||||
usage 1 2
|
||||
fi
|
||||
exec ${pkg_admin} ${do_pkgdb} ${do_verbose} ${do_quiet} audit-pkg \
|
||||
${do_eol} ${do_limit_type} ${do_check_file}
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
if [ -n "${do_check_pattern}" ]; then
|
||||
if [ -n "${do_check_installed}" ]; then
|
||||
echo "Only one of -F, -n or -p is interpreted at a time." >& 2
|
||||
usage 1 2
|
||||
fi
|
||||
exec ${pkg_admin} ${do_pkgdb} ${do_verbose} ${do_quiet} audit-pkg \
|
||||
${do_eol} ${do_limit_type} ${do_check_pattern}
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
# If do_check_installed is empty, all packages are checked.
|
||||
exec ${pkg_admin} ${do_pkgdb} ${do_verbose} ${do_quiet} audit \
|
||||
${do_eol} ${do_limit_type} ${do_check_installed}
|
507
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/audit.c
vendored
Normal file
507
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/audit.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,507 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: audit.c,v 1.1.1.9 2011/02/18 22:32:28 aymeric Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: audit.c,v 1.1.1.9 2011/02/18 22:32:28 aymeric Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_TYPES_H
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_STAT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/stat.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERRNO_H
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_FCNTL_H
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SIGNAL_H
|
||||
#include <signal.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDIO_H
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifdef NETBSD
|
||||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#include <nbcompat/unistd.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <fetch.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "admin.h"
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static int check_signature = 0;
|
||||
static const char *limit_vul_types = NULL;
|
||||
static int update_pkg_vuln = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
static struct pkg_vulnerabilities *pv;
|
||||
|
||||
static const char audit_options[] = "est:";
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
parse_options(int argc, char **argv, const char *options)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int ch;
|
||||
|
||||
optreset = 1;
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* optind == 0 is interpreted as partial reset request
|
||||
* by GNU getopt, so compensate against this and cleanup
|
||||
* at the end.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
optind = 1;
|
||||
++argc;
|
||||
--argv;
|
||||
|
||||
while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, options)) != -1) {
|
||||
switch (ch) {
|
||||
case 'e':
|
||||
check_eol = "yes";
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 's':
|
||||
check_signature = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 't':
|
||||
limit_vul_types = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'u':
|
||||
update_pkg_vuln = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
/* NOTREACHED */
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
--optind; /* See above comment. */
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
check_exact_pkg(const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return audit_package(pv, pkg, limit_vul_types, quiet ? 0 : 1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
check_batch_exact_pkgs(const char *fname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *f;
|
||||
char buf[4096], *line, *eol;
|
||||
int ret;
|
||||
|
||||
ret = 0;
|
||||
if (strcmp(fname, "-") == 0)
|
||||
f = stdin;
|
||||
else {
|
||||
f = fopen(fname, "r");
|
||||
if (f == NULL)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "Failed to open input file %s",
|
||||
fname);
|
||||
}
|
||||
while ((line = fgets(buf, sizeof(buf), f)) != NULL) {
|
||||
eol = line + strlen(line);
|
||||
if (eol == line)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
--eol;
|
||||
if (*eol == '\n') {
|
||||
if (eol == line)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
*eol = '\0';
|
||||
}
|
||||
ret |= check_exact_pkg(line);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (f != stdin)
|
||||
fclose(f);
|
||||
|
||||
return ret;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
check_one_installed_pkg(const char *pkg, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int *ret = cookie;
|
||||
|
||||
*ret |= check_exact_pkg(pkg);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
check_installed_pattern(const char *pattern)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int ret = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
match_installed_pkgs(pattern, check_one_installed_pkg, &ret);
|
||||
|
||||
return ret;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
check_and_read_pkg_vulnerabilities(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct stat st;
|
||||
time_t now;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkg_vulnerabilities_file == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "PKG_VULNERABILITIES is not set");
|
||||
|
||||
if (verbose >= 1) {
|
||||
if (stat(pkg_vulnerabilities_file, &st) == -1) {
|
||||
if (errno == ENOENT)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE,
|
||||
"pkg-vulnerabilities not found, run %s -d",
|
||||
getprogname());
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "pkg-vulnerabilities not readable");
|
||||
}
|
||||
now = time(NULL);
|
||||
now -= st.st_mtime;
|
||||
if (now < 0)
|
||||
warnx("pkg-vulnerabilities is from the future");
|
||||
else if (now > 86400 * 7)
|
||||
warnx("pkg-vulnerabilities is out of date (%ld days old)",
|
||||
(long)(now / 86400));
|
||||
else if (verbose >= 2)
|
||||
warnx("pkg-vulnerabilities is %ld day%s old",
|
||||
(long)(now / 86400), now / 86400 == 1 ? "" : "s");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
pv = read_pkg_vulnerabilities_file(pkg_vulnerabilities_file, 0, check_signature);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
audit_pkgdb(int argc, char **argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int rv;
|
||||
|
||||
parse_options(argc, argv, audit_options);
|
||||
argv += optind;
|
||||
|
||||
check_and_read_pkg_vulnerabilities();
|
||||
|
||||
rv = 0;
|
||||
if (*argv == NULL)
|
||||
rv |= check_installed_pattern("*");
|
||||
else {
|
||||
for (; *argv != NULL; ++argv)
|
||||
rv |= check_installed_pattern(*argv);
|
||||
}
|
||||
free_pkg_vulnerabilities(pv);
|
||||
|
||||
if (rv == 0 && verbose >= 1)
|
||||
fputs("No vulnerabilities found\n", stderr);
|
||||
exit(rv ? EXIT_FAILURE : EXIT_SUCCESS);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
audit_pkg(int argc, char **argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int rv;
|
||||
|
||||
parse_options(argc, argv, audit_options);
|
||||
argv += optind;
|
||||
|
||||
check_and_read_pkg_vulnerabilities();
|
||||
rv = 0;
|
||||
for (; *argv != NULL; ++argv)
|
||||
rv |= check_exact_pkg(*argv);
|
||||
|
||||
free_pkg_vulnerabilities(pv);
|
||||
|
||||
if (rv == 0 && verbose >= 1)
|
||||
fputs("No vulnerabilities found\n", stderr);
|
||||
exit(rv ? EXIT_FAILURE : EXIT_SUCCESS);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
audit_batch(int argc, char **argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int rv;
|
||||
|
||||
parse_options(argc, argv, audit_options);
|
||||
argv += optind;
|
||||
|
||||
check_and_read_pkg_vulnerabilities();
|
||||
rv = 0;
|
||||
for (; *argv != NULL; ++argv)
|
||||
rv |= check_batch_exact_pkgs(*argv);
|
||||
free_pkg_vulnerabilities(pv);
|
||||
|
||||
if (rv == 0 && verbose >= 1)
|
||||
fputs("No vulnerabilities found\n", stderr);
|
||||
exit(rv ? EXIT_FAILURE : EXIT_SUCCESS);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
check_pkg_vulnerabilities(int argc, char **argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
parse_options(argc, argv, "s");
|
||||
if (argc != optind + 1)
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
|
||||
pv = read_pkg_vulnerabilities_file(argv[optind], 0, check_signature);
|
||||
free_pkg_vulnerabilities(pv);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
fetch_pkg_vulnerabilities(int argc, char **argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct pkg_vulnerabilities *pv_check;
|
||||
char *buf;
|
||||
size_t buf_len, buf_fetched;
|
||||
ssize_t cur_fetched;
|
||||
struct url *url;
|
||||
struct url_stat st;
|
||||
fetchIO *f;
|
||||
int fd;
|
||||
struct stat sb;
|
||||
char my_flags[20];
|
||||
const char *flags;
|
||||
|
||||
parse_options(argc, argv, "su");
|
||||
if (argc != optind)
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
|
||||
if (verbose >= 2)
|
||||
fprintf(stderr, "Fetching %s\n", pkg_vulnerabilities_url);
|
||||
|
||||
url = fetchParseURL(pkg_vulnerabilities_url);
|
||||
if (url == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE,
|
||||
"Could not parse location of pkg_vulnerabilities: %s",
|
||||
fetchLastErrString);
|
||||
|
||||
flags = fetch_flags;
|
||||
if (update_pkg_vuln) {
|
||||
fd = open(pkg_vulnerabilities_file, O_RDONLY);
|
||||
if (fd != -1 && fstat(fd, &sb) != -1) {
|
||||
url->last_modified = sb.st_mtime;
|
||||
snprintf(my_flags, sizeof(my_flags), "%si",
|
||||
fetch_flags);
|
||||
flags = my_flags;
|
||||
} else
|
||||
update_pkg_vuln = 0;
|
||||
if (fd != -1)
|
||||
close(fd);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
f = fetchXGet(url, &st, flags);
|
||||
if (f == NULL && update_pkg_vuln &&
|
||||
fetchLastErrCode == FETCH_UNCHANGED) {
|
||||
if (verbose >= 1)
|
||||
fprintf(stderr, "%s is not newer\n",
|
||||
pkg_vulnerabilities_url);
|
||||
exit(EXIT_SUCCESS);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (f == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Could not fetch vulnerability file: %s",
|
||||
fetchLastErrString);
|
||||
|
||||
if (st.size > SSIZE_MAX - 1)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "pkg-vulnerabilities is too large");
|
||||
|
||||
buf_len = st.size;
|
||||
buf = xmalloc(buf_len + 1);
|
||||
buf_fetched = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
while (buf_fetched < buf_len) {
|
||||
cur_fetched = fetchIO_read(f, buf + buf_fetched,
|
||||
buf_len - buf_fetched);
|
||||
if (cur_fetched == 0)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE,
|
||||
"Truncated pkg-vulnerabilities received");
|
||||
else if (cur_fetched == -1)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE,
|
||||
"IO error while fetching pkg-vulnerabilities: %s",
|
||||
fetchLastErrString);
|
||||
buf_fetched += cur_fetched;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
buf[buf_len] = '\0';
|
||||
|
||||
pv_check = read_pkg_vulnerabilities_memory(buf, buf_len, check_signature);
|
||||
free_pkg_vulnerabilities(pv_check);
|
||||
|
||||
fd = open(pkg_vulnerabilities_file, O_WRONLY | O_CREAT | O_TRUNC, 0644);
|
||||
if (fd == -1)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot create pkg-vulnerability file %s",
|
||||
pkg_vulnerabilities_file);
|
||||
|
||||
if (write(fd, buf, buf_len) != (ssize_t)buf_len)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot write pkg-vulnerability file");
|
||||
if (close(fd) == -1)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot close pkg-vulnerability file after write");
|
||||
|
||||
free(buf);
|
||||
|
||||
exit(EXIT_SUCCESS);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
check_pkg_history_pattern(const char *pkg, const char *pattern)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *delim, *end_base;
|
||||
|
||||
if (strpbrk(pattern, "*[") != NULL) {
|
||||
end_base = NULL;
|
||||
for (delim = pattern;
|
||||
*delim != '\0' && *delim != '['; delim++) {
|
||||
if (*delim == '-')
|
||||
end_base = delim;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (end_base == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Missing - in wildcard pattern %s",
|
||||
pattern);
|
||||
if ((delim = strchr(pattern, '>')) != NULL ||
|
||||
(delim = strchr(pattern, '<')) != NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE,
|
||||
"Mixed relational and wildcard patterns in %s",
|
||||
pattern);
|
||||
} else if ((delim = strchr(pattern, '>')) != NULL) {
|
||||
end_base = delim;
|
||||
if ((delim = strchr(pattern, '<')) != NULL && delim < end_base)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Inverted operators in %s",
|
||||
pattern);
|
||||
} else if ((delim = strchr(pattern, '<')) != NULL) {
|
||||
end_base = delim;
|
||||
} else if ((end_base = strrchr(pattern, '-')) == NULL) {
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Missing - in absolute pattern %s",
|
||||
pattern);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (strncmp(pkg, pattern, end_base - pattern) != 0)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
if (pkg[end_base - pattern] != '\0')
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
check_pkg_history1(const char *pkg, const char *pattern)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *open_brace, *close_brace, *inner_brace, *suffix, *iter;
|
||||
size_t prefix_len, suffix_len, middle_len;
|
||||
char *expanded_pkg;
|
||||
|
||||
open_brace = strchr(pattern, '{');
|
||||
if (open_brace == NULL) {
|
||||
if ((close_brace = strchr(pattern, '}')) != NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Unbalanced {} in pattern %s",
|
||||
pattern);
|
||||
return check_pkg_history_pattern(pkg, pattern);
|
||||
}
|
||||
close_brace = strchr(open_brace, '}');
|
||||
if (strchr(pattern, '}') != close_brace)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Unbalanced {} in pattern %s",
|
||||
pattern);
|
||||
|
||||
while ((inner_brace = strchr(open_brace + 1, '{')) != NULL) {
|
||||
if (inner_brace >= close_brace)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
open_brace = inner_brace;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
expanded_pkg = xmalloc(strlen(pattern)); /* {} are going away... */
|
||||
|
||||
prefix_len = open_brace - pattern;
|
||||
suffix = close_brace + 1;
|
||||
suffix_len = strlen(suffix) + 1;
|
||||
memcpy(expanded_pkg, pattern, prefix_len);
|
||||
|
||||
++open_brace;
|
||||
|
||||
do {
|
||||
iter = strchr(open_brace, ',');
|
||||
if (iter == NULL || iter > close_brace)
|
||||
iter = close_brace;
|
||||
|
||||
middle_len = iter - open_brace;
|
||||
memcpy(expanded_pkg + prefix_len, open_brace, middle_len);
|
||||
memcpy(expanded_pkg + prefix_len + middle_len, suffix,
|
||||
suffix_len);
|
||||
if (check_pkg_history1(pkg, expanded_pkg)) {
|
||||
free(expanded_pkg);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
open_brace = iter + 1;
|
||||
} while (iter < close_brace);
|
||||
|
||||
free(expanded_pkg);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
check_pkg_history(const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t i;
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < pv->entries; ++i) {
|
||||
if (!quick_pkg_match(pv->vulnerability[i], pkg))
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (strcmp("eol", pv->classification[i]) == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (check_pkg_history1(pkg, pv->vulnerability[i]) == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
|
||||
printf("%s %s %s\n", pv->vulnerability[i],
|
||||
pv->classification[i], pv->advisory[i]);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
audit_history(int argc, char **argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
parse_options(argc, argv, "st:");
|
||||
argv += optind;
|
||||
|
||||
check_and_read_pkg_vulnerabilities();
|
||||
for (; *argv != NULL; ++argv)
|
||||
check_pkg_history(*argv);
|
||||
|
||||
free_pkg_vulnerabilities(pv);
|
||||
exit(EXIT_SUCCESS);
|
||||
}
|
259
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/check.c
vendored
Normal file
259
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/check.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,259 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: check.c,v 1.1.1.4 2010/01/30 21:33:23 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: check.c,v 1.1.1.4 2010/01/30 21:33:23 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 1999-2008 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
* by Hubert Feyrer <hubert@feyrer.de>.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
* TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
* PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
* CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
* SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
* INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
* CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
* ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
* POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_TYPES_H
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_STAT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/stat.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_DIRENT_H
|
||||
#include <dirent.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERRNO_H
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_FCNTL_H
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef NETBSD
|
||||
#include <nbcompat/md5.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#include <md5.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_LIMITS_H
|
||||
#include <limits.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDIO_H
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "admin.h"
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static int checkpattern_fn(const char *, void *);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Assumes CWD is in /var/db/pkg/<pkg>!
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void
|
||||
check1pkg(const char *pkgdir, int *filecnt, int *pkgcnt)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *f;
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
package_t Plist;
|
||||
char *PkgName, *dirp = NULL, *md5file;
|
||||
char file[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
char *content;
|
||||
|
||||
content = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkgdir, CONTENTS_FNAME);
|
||||
f = fopen(content, "r");
|
||||
if (f == NULL)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "can't open %s", content);
|
||||
free(content);
|
||||
|
||||
read_plist(&Plist, f);
|
||||
p = find_plist(&Plist, PLIST_NAME);
|
||||
if (p == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Package %s has no @name, aborting.",
|
||||
pkgdir);
|
||||
PkgName = p->name;
|
||||
for (p = Plist.head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
switch (p->type) {
|
||||
case PLIST_FILE:
|
||||
if (dirp == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("dirp not initialized, please send-pr!");
|
||||
abort();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
(void) snprintf(file, sizeof(file), "%s/%s", dirp, p->name);
|
||||
|
||||
if (isfile(file) || islinktodir(file)) {
|
||||
if (p->next && p->next->type == PLIST_COMMENT) {
|
||||
if (strncmp(p->next->name, CHECKSUM_HEADER, ChecksumHeaderLen) == 0) {
|
||||
if ((md5file = MD5File(file, NULL)) != NULL) {
|
||||
/* Mismatch? */
|
||||
if (strcmp(md5file, p->next->name + ChecksumHeaderLen) != 0)
|
||||
printf("%s fails MD5 checksum\n", file);
|
||||
|
||||
free(md5file);
|
||||
}
|
||||
} else if (strncmp(p->next->name, SYMLINK_HEADER, SymlinkHeaderLen) == 0) {
|
||||
char buf[MaxPathSize + SymlinkHeaderLen];
|
||||
int cc;
|
||||
|
||||
(void) strlcpy(buf, SYMLINK_HEADER, sizeof(buf));
|
||||
if ((cc = readlink(file, &buf[SymlinkHeaderLen],
|
||||
sizeof(buf) - SymlinkHeaderLen - 1)) < 0) {
|
||||
warnx("can't readlink `%s'", file);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
buf[SymlinkHeaderLen + cc] = 0x0;
|
||||
if (strcmp(buf, p->next->name) != 0) {
|
||||
printf("symlink (%s) is not same as recorded value, %s: %s\n",
|
||||
file, buf, p->next->name);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
(*filecnt)++;
|
||||
} else if (isbrokenlink(file)) {
|
||||
warnx("%s: Symlink `%s' exists and is in %s but target does not exist!", PkgName, file, CONTENTS_FNAME);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
warnx("%s: File `%s' is in %s but not on filesystem!", PkgName, file, CONTENTS_FNAME);
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_CWD:
|
||||
if (strcmp(p->name, ".") != 0)
|
||||
dirp = p->name;
|
||||
else
|
||||
dirp = pkgdb_pkg_dir(pkgdir);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_IGNORE:
|
||||
p = p->next;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_SHOW_ALL:
|
||||
case PLIST_SRC:
|
||||
case PLIST_CMD:
|
||||
case PLIST_CHMOD:
|
||||
case PLIST_CHOWN:
|
||||
case PLIST_CHGRP:
|
||||
case PLIST_COMMENT:
|
||||
case PLIST_NAME:
|
||||
case PLIST_UNEXEC:
|
||||
case PLIST_DISPLAY:
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGDEP:
|
||||
case PLIST_DIR_RM:
|
||||
case PLIST_OPTION:
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGCFL:
|
||||
case PLIST_BLDDEP:
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGDIR:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
free_plist(&Plist);
|
||||
fclose(f);
|
||||
(*pkgcnt)++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct checkpattern_arg {
|
||||
int filecnt;
|
||||
int pkgcnt;
|
||||
int got_match;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
checkpattern_fn(const char *pkg, void *vp)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct checkpattern_arg *arg = vp;
|
||||
|
||||
check1pkg(pkg, &arg->filecnt, &arg->pkgcnt);
|
||||
if (!quiet)
|
||||
printf(".");
|
||||
|
||||
arg->got_match = 1;
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
check_pkg(const char *pkg, int *filecnt, int *pkgcnt, int allow_unmatched)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct checkpattern_arg arg;
|
||||
char *pattern;
|
||||
|
||||
arg.filecnt = *filecnt;
|
||||
arg.pkgcnt = *pkgcnt;
|
||||
arg.got_match = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (match_installed_pkgs(pkg, checkpattern_fn, &arg) == -1)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot process pkdbdb");
|
||||
if (arg.got_match != 0) {
|
||||
*filecnt = arg.filecnt;
|
||||
*pkgcnt = arg.pkgcnt;
|
||||
return;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (ispkgpattern(pkg)) {
|
||||
if (allow_unmatched)
|
||||
return;
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "No matching pkg for %s.", pkg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
pattern = xasprintf("%s-[0-9]*", pkg);
|
||||
|
||||
if (match_installed_pkgs(pattern, checkpattern_fn, &arg) == -1)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot process pkdbdb");
|
||||
|
||||
if (arg.got_match == 0)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "cannot find package %s", pkg);
|
||||
free(pattern);
|
||||
|
||||
*filecnt = arg.filecnt;
|
||||
*pkgcnt = arg.pkgcnt;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
check(char **argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int filecnt, pkgcnt;
|
||||
|
||||
filecnt = 0;
|
||||
pkgcnt = 0;
|
||||
setbuf(stdout, NULL);
|
||||
|
||||
if (*argv == NULL) {
|
||||
check_pkg("*", &filecnt, &pkgcnt, 1);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
for (; *argv != NULL; ++argv)
|
||||
check_pkg(*argv, &filecnt, &pkgcnt, 0);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
printf("\n");
|
||||
printf("Checked %d file%s from %d package%s.\n",
|
||||
filecnt, (filecnt == 1) ? "" : "s",
|
||||
pkgcnt, (pkgcnt == 1) ? "" : "s");
|
||||
}
|
54
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/download-vulnerability-list.8
vendored
Normal file
54
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/download-vulnerability-list.8
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,54 @@
|
|||
.\" $NetBSD: download-vulnerability-list.8,v 1.1.1.1 2010/04/23 20:54:06 joerg Exp $
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Copyright (c) 2010 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
.\" All rights reserved.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
.\" by Thomas Klausner.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
.\" are met:
|
||||
.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
.\" ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
.\" TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
.\" PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
.\" POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.Dd March 18, 2010
|
||||
.Dt DOWNLOAD-VULNERABILITY-LIST 8
|
||||
.Os
|
||||
.Sh NAME
|
||||
.Nm download-vulnerability-list
|
||||
.Nd download vulnerability list used for checking installed packages
|
||||
.Sh SYNOPSIS
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
.Op Fl hs
|
||||
.Op Fl c Ar config_file
|
||||
.Sh DESCRIPTION
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
is deprecated.
|
||||
Please use the
|
||||
.Cm fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities
|
||||
command of
|
||||
.Xr pkg_admin 1
|
||||
instead.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
script is installed for backwards compatibility only and will
|
||||
eventually be removed.
|
||||
.Sh SEE ALSO
|
||||
.Xr pkg_admin 1
|
37
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/download-vulnerability-list.sh.in
vendored
Normal file
37
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/download-vulnerability-list.sh.in
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,37 @@
|
|||
#!/bin/sh
|
||||
|
||||
pkg_admin=@PKG_ADMIN@
|
||||
|
||||
usage() {
|
||||
echo 'Usage: download-vulnerability-list [-hs] [-c config_file]' >& $2
|
||||
echo "Please use \`\`pkg_admin fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities'' instead." >& $2
|
||||
exit $1
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
do_sign=
|
||||
|
||||
args=`getopt c:hs $*`
|
||||
if [ $? -ne 0 ]; then
|
||||
usage 1 2
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
set -- $args
|
||||
|
||||
while [ $# -gt 0 ]; do
|
||||
case "$1" in
|
||||
-c)
|
||||
echo "The download-vulnerability-list wrapper does not support -c" >&2
|
||||
echo "Please switch to \`\`pkg_admin fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities''." >&2
|
||||
exit 1
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-h)
|
||||
usage 0 1
|
||||
;;
|
||||
-s)
|
||||
do_sign=-s
|
||||
;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
shift
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
exec ${pkg_admin} fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities ${do_sign}
|
754
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/main.c
vendored
Normal file
754
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/main.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,754 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: main.c,v 1.1.1.15 2010/04/23 20:54:07 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: main.c,v 1.1.1.15 2010/04/23 20:54:07 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 1999-2009 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
* by Hubert Feyrer <hubert@feyrer.de> and
|
||||
* by Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
* TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
* PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
* CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
* SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
* INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
* CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
* ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
* POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_TYPES_H
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_STAT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/stat.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_DIRENT_H
|
||||
#include <dirent.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERRNO_H
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_FCNTL_H
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef NETBSD
|
||||
#include <nbcompat/md5.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#include <md5.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_LIMITS_H
|
||||
#include <limits.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDIO_H
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef BOOTSTRAP
|
||||
#include <archive.h>
|
||||
#include <fetch.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "admin.h"
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#define DEFAULT_SFX ".t[bg]z" /* default suffix for ls{all,best} */
|
||||
|
||||
struct pkgdb_count {
|
||||
size_t files;
|
||||
size_t directories;
|
||||
size_t packages;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static const char Options[] = "C:K:SVbd:qs:v";
|
||||
|
||||
int quiet, verbose;
|
||||
|
||||
static void set_unset_variable(char **, Boolean);
|
||||
|
||||
/* print usage message and exit */
|
||||
void
|
||||
usage(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
(void) fprintf(stderr, "usage: %s [-bqSVv] [-C config] [-d lsdir] [-K pkg_dbdir] [-s sfx] command [args ...]\n"
|
||||
"Where 'commands' and 'args' are:\n"
|
||||
" rebuild - rebuild pkgdb from +CONTENTS files\n"
|
||||
" rebuild-tree - rebuild +REQUIRED_BY files from forward deps\n"
|
||||
" check [pkg ...] - check md5 checksum of installed files\n"
|
||||
" add pkg ... - add pkg files to database\n"
|
||||
" delete pkg ... - delete file entries for pkg in database\n"
|
||||
" set variable=value pkg ... - set installation variable for package\n"
|
||||
" unset variable pkg ... - unset installation variable for package\n"
|
||||
" lsall /path/to/pkgpattern - list all pkgs matching the pattern\n"
|
||||
" lsbest /path/to/pkgpattern - list pkgs matching the pattern best\n"
|
||||
" dump - dump database\n"
|
||||
" pmatch pattern pkg - returns true if pkg matches pattern, otherwise false\n"
|
||||
" fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities [-s] - fetch new vulnerability file\n"
|
||||
" check-pkg-vulnerabilities [-s] <file> - check syntax and checksums of the vulnerability file\n"
|
||||
" audit [-es] [-t type] ... - check installed packages for vulnerabilities\n"
|
||||
" audit-pkg [-es] [-t type] ... - check listed packages for vulnerabilities\n"
|
||||
" audit-batch [-es] [-t type] ... - check packages in listed files for vulnerabilities\n"
|
||||
" audit-history [-t type] ... - print all advisories for package names\n"
|
||||
" check-license <condition> - check if condition is acceptable\n"
|
||||
" check-single-license <license> - check if license is acceptable\n"
|
||||
" config-var name - print current value of the configuration variable\n"
|
||||
" check-signature ... - verify the signature of packages\n"
|
||||
" x509-sign-package pkg spkg key cert - create X509 signature\n"
|
||||
" gpg-sign-package pkg spkg - create GPG signature\n",
|
||||
getprogname());
|
||||
exit(EXIT_FAILURE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* add1pkg(<pkg>)
|
||||
* adds the files listed in the +CONTENTS of <pkg> into the
|
||||
* pkgdb.byfile.db database file in the current package dbdir. It
|
||||
* returns the number of files added to the database file.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
add_pkg(const char *pkgdir, void *vp)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *f;
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
package_t Plist;
|
||||
char *contents;
|
||||
char *PkgName, *dirp;
|
||||
char file[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
struct pkgdb_count *count;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!pkgdb_open(ReadWrite))
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "cannot open pkgdb");
|
||||
|
||||
count = vp;
|
||||
++count->packages;
|
||||
|
||||
contents = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkgdir, CONTENTS_FNAME);
|
||||
if ((f = fopen(contents, "r")) == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "%s: can't open `%s'", pkgdir, CONTENTS_FNAME);
|
||||
free(contents);
|
||||
|
||||
read_plist(&Plist, f);
|
||||
if ((p = find_plist(&Plist, PLIST_NAME)) == NULL) {
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Package `%s' has no @name, aborting.", pkgdir);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
PkgName = p->name;
|
||||
dirp = NULL;
|
||||
for (p = Plist.head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
switch(p->type) {
|
||||
case PLIST_FILE:
|
||||
if (dirp == NULL) {
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "@cwd not yet found, please send-pr!");
|
||||
}
|
||||
(void) snprintf(file, sizeof(file), "%s/%s", dirp, p->name);
|
||||
if (!(isfile(file) || islinktodir(file))) {
|
||||
if (isbrokenlink(file)) {
|
||||
warnx("%s: Symlink `%s' exists and is in %s but target does not exist!",
|
||||
PkgName, file, CONTENTS_FNAME);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
warnx("%s: File `%s' is in %s but not on filesystem!",
|
||||
PkgName, file, CONTENTS_FNAME);
|
||||
}
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
pkgdb_store(file, PkgName);
|
||||
++count->files;
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGDIR:
|
||||
add_pkgdir(PkgName, dirp, p->name);
|
||||
++count->directories;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_CWD:
|
||||
if (strcmp(p->name, ".") != 0)
|
||||
dirp = p->name;
|
||||
else
|
||||
dirp = pkgdb_pkg_dir(pkgdir);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_IGNORE:
|
||||
p = p->next;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_SHOW_ALL:
|
||||
case PLIST_SRC:
|
||||
case PLIST_CMD:
|
||||
case PLIST_CHMOD:
|
||||
case PLIST_CHOWN:
|
||||
case PLIST_CHGRP:
|
||||
case PLIST_COMMENT:
|
||||
case PLIST_NAME:
|
||||
case PLIST_UNEXEC:
|
||||
case PLIST_DISPLAY:
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGDEP:
|
||||
case PLIST_DIR_RM:
|
||||
case PLIST_OPTION:
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGCFL:
|
||||
case PLIST_BLDDEP:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
free_plist(&Plist);
|
||||
fclose(f);
|
||||
pkgdb_close();
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
delete1pkg(const char *pkgdir)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (!pkgdb_open(ReadWrite))
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "cannot open pkgdb");
|
||||
(void) pkgdb_remove_pkg(pkgdir);
|
||||
pkgdb_close();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
rebuild(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *cachename;
|
||||
struct pkgdb_count count;
|
||||
|
||||
count.files = 0;
|
||||
count.directories = 0;
|
||||
count.packages = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
cachename = pkgdb_get_database();
|
||||
if (unlink(cachename) != 0 && errno != ENOENT)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "unlink %s", cachename);
|
||||
|
||||
setbuf(stdout, NULL);
|
||||
|
||||
iterate_pkg_db(add_pkg, &count);
|
||||
|
||||
printf("\n");
|
||||
printf("Stored %" PRIzu " file%s and %zu explicit director%s"
|
||||
" from %"PRIzu " package%s in %s.\n",
|
||||
count.files, count.files == 1 ? "" : "s",
|
||||
count.directories, count.directories == 1 ? "y" : "ies",
|
||||
count.packages, count.packages == 1 ? "" : "s",
|
||||
cachename);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
lspattern(const char *pkg, void *vp)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *dir = vp;
|
||||
printf("%s/%s\n", dir, pkg);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
lsbasepattern(const char *pkg, void *vp)
|
||||
{
|
||||
puts(pkg);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
remove_required_by(const char *pkgname, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *path;
|
||||
|
||||
path = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkgname, REQUIRED_BY_FNAME);
|
||||
|
||||
if (unlink(path) == -1 && errno != ENOENT)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot remove %s", path);
|
||||
|
||||
free(path);
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
add_required_by(const char *pattern, const char *required_by)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *best_installed, *path;
|
||||
int fd;
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
|
||||
best_installed = find_best_matching_installed_pkg(pattern);
|
||||
if (best_installed == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("Dependency %s of %s unresolved", pattern, required_by);
|
||||
return;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
path = pkgdb_pkg_file(best_installed, REQUIRED_BY_FNAME);
|
||||
free(best_installed);
|
||||
|
||||
if ((fd = open(path, O_WRONLY | O_APPEND | O_CREAT, 0644)) == -1)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot write to %s", path);
|
||||
free(path);
|
||||
|
||||
len = strlen(required_by);
|
||||
if (write(fd, required_by, len) != (ssize_t)len ||
|
||||
write(fd, "\n", 1) != 1 ||
|
||||
close(fd) == -1)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot write to %s", path);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
add_depends_of(const char *pkgname, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *fp;
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
package_t plist;
|
||||
char *path;
|
||||
|
||||
path = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkgname, CONTENTS_FNAME);
|
||||
if ((fp = fopen(path, "r")) == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot read %s of package %s",
|
||||
CONTENTS_FNAME, pkgname);
|
||||
free(path);
|
||||
read_plist(&plist, fp);
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
|
||||
for (p = plist.head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
if (p->type == PLIST_PKGDEP)
|
||||
add_required_by(p->name, pkgname);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
free_plist(&plist);
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
rebuild_tree(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (iterate_pkg_db(remove_required_by, NULL) == -1)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "cannot iterate pkgdb");
|
||||
if (iterate_pkg_db(add_depends_of, NULL) == -1)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "cannot iterate pkgdb");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
main(int argc, char *argv[])
|
||||
{
|
||||
Boolean use_default_sfx = TRUE;
|
||||
Boolean show_basename_only = FALSE;
|
||||
char lsdir[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
char sfx[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
char *lsdirp = NULL;
|
||||
int ch;
|
||||
|
||||
setprogname(argv[0]);
|
||||
|
||||
if (argc < 2)
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
|
||||
while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, Options)) != -1)
|
||||
switch (ch) {
|
||||
case 'C':
|
||||
config_file = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'K':
|
||||
pkgdb_set_dir(optarg, 3);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'S':
|
||||
sfx[0] = 0x0;
|
||||
use_default_sfx = FALSE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'V':
|
||||
show_version();
|
||||
/* NOTREACHED */
|
||||
|
||||
case 'b':
|
||||
show_basename_only = TRUE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'd':
|
||||
(void) strlcpy(lsdir, optarg, sizeof(lsdir));
|
||||
lsdirp = lsdir;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'q':
|
||||
quiet = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 's':
|
||||
(void) strlcpy(sfx, optarg, sizeof(sfx));
|
||||
use_default_sfx = FALSE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'v':
|
||||
++verbose;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
default:
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
/* NOTREACHED */
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
argc -= optind;
|
||||
argv += optind;
|
||||
|
||||
if (argc <= 0) {
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* config-var is reading the config file implicitly,
|
||||
* so skip it here.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "config-var") != 0)
|
||||
pkg_install_config();
|
||||
|
||||
if (use_default_sfx)
|
||||
(void) strlcpy(sfx, DEFAULT_SFX, sizeof(sfx));
|
||||
|
||||
if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "pmatch") == 0) {
|
||||
|
||||
char *pattern, *pkg;
|
||||
|
||||
argv++; /* "pmatch" */
|
||||
|
||||
if (argv[0] == NULL || argv[1] == NULL) {
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
pattern = argv[0];
|
||||
pkg = argv[1];
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkg_match(pattern, pkg)){
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "rebuild") == 0) {
|
||||
|
||||
rebuild();
|
||||
printf("Done.\n");
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "rebuild-tree") == 0) {
|
||||
|
||||
rebuild_tree();
|
||||
printf("Done.\n");
|
||||
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "check") == 0) {
|
||||
argv++; /* "check" */
|
||||
|
||||
check(argv);
|
||||
|
||||
if (!quiet) {
|
||||
printf("Done.\n");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "lsall") == 0) {
|
||||
argv++; /* "lsall" */
|
||||
|
||||
while (*argv != NULL) {
|
||||
/* args specified */
|
||||
int rc;
|
||||
const char *basep, *dir;
|
||||
|
||||
dir = lsdirp ? lsdirp : dirname_of(*argv);
|
||||
basep = basename_of(*argv);
|
||||
|
||||
if (show_basename_only)
|
||||
rc = match_local_files(dir, use_default_sfx, 1, basep, lsbasepattern, NULL);
|
||||
else
|
||||
rc = match_local_files(dir, use_default_sfx, 1, basep, lspattern, __UNCONST(dir));
|
||||
if (rc == -1)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Error from match_local_files(\"%s\", \"%s\", ...)",
|
||||
dir, basep);
|
||||
|
||||
argv++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "lsbest") == 0) {
|
||||
argv++; /* "lsbest" */
|
||||
|
||||
while (*argv != NULL) {
|
||||
/* args specified */
|
||||
const char *basep, *dir;
|
||||
char *p;
|
||||
|
||||
dir = lsdirp ? lsdirp : dirname_of(*argv);
|
||||
basep = basename_of(*argv);
|
||||
|
||||
p = find_best_matching_file(dir, basep, use_default_sfx, 1);
|
||||
|
||||
if (p) {
|
||||
if (show_basename_only)
|
||||
printf("%s\n", p);
|
||||
else
|
||||
printf("%s/%s\n", dir, p);
|
||||
free(p);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
argv++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "list") == 0 ||
|
||||
strcasecmp(argv[0], "dump") == 0) {
|
||||
|
||||
pkgdb_dump();
|
||||
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "add") == 0) {
|
||||
struct pkgdb_count count;
|
||||
|
||||
count.files = 0;
|
||||
count.directories = 0;
|
||||
count.packages = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
for (++argv; *argv != NULL; ++argv)
|
||||
add_pkg(*argv, &count);
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "delete") == 0) {
|
||||
argv++; /* "delete" */
|
||||
while (*argv != NULL) {
|
||||
delete1pkg(*argv);
|
||||
argv++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "set") == 0) {
|
||||
argv++; /* "set" */
|
||||
set_unset_variable(argv, FALSE);
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "unset") == 0) {
|
||||
argv++; /* "unset" */
|
||||
set_unset_variable(argv, TRUE);
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "config-var") == 0) {
|
||||
argv++;
|
||||
if (argv == NULL || argv[1] != NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "config-var takes exactly one argument");
|
||||
pkg_install_show_variable(argv[0]);
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "check-license") == 0) {
|
||||
if (argv[1] == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "check-license takes exactly one argument");
|
||||
|
||||
load_license_lists();
|
||||
|
||||
switch (acceptable_pkg_license(argv[1])) {
|
||||
case 0:
|
||||
puts("no");
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
case 1:
|
||||
puts("yes");
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
case -1:
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "invalid license condition");
|
||||
}
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "check-single-license") == 0) {
|
||||
if (argv[1] == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "check-license takes exactly one argument");
|
||||
load_license_lists();
|
||||
|
||||
switch (acceptable_license(argv[1])) {
|
||||
case 0:
|
||||
puts("no");
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
case 1:
|
||||
puts("yes");
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
case -1:
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "invalid license");
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
#ifndef BOOTSTRAP
|
||||
else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "findbest") == 0) {
|
||||
struct url *url;
|
||||
char *output;
|
||||
int rc;
|
||||
|
||||
process_pkg_path();
|
||||
|
||||
rc = 0;
|
||||
for (++argv; *argv != NULL; ++argv) {
|
||||
url = find_best_package(NULL, *argv, 1);
|
||||
if (url == NULL) {
|
||||
rc = 1;
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
output = fetchStringifyURL(url);
|
||||
puts(output);
|
||||
fetchFreeURL(url);
|
||||
free(output);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return rc;
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities") == 0) {
|
||||
fetch_pkg_vulnerabilities(--argc, ++argv);
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "check-pkg-vulnerabilities") == 0) {
|
||||
check_pkg_vulnerabilities(--argc, ++argv);
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "audit") == 0) {
|
||||
audit_pkgdb(--argc, ++argv);
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "audit-pkg") == 0) {
|
||||
audit_pkg(--argc, ++argv);
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "audit-batch") == 0) {
|
||||
audit_batch(--argc, ++argv);
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "audit-history") == 0) {
|
||||
audit_history(--argc, ++argv);
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "check-signature") == 0) {
|
||||
struct archive *pkg;
|
||||
int rc;
|
||||
|
||||
rc = 0;
|
||||
for (--argc, ++argv; argc > 0; --argc, ++argv) {
|
||||
char *archive_name;
|
||||
|
||||
pkg = open_archive(*argv, &archive_name);
|
||||
if (pkg == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("%s could not be opened", *argv);
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (pkg_full_signature_check(archive_name, &pkg))
|
||||
rc = 1;
|
||||
free(archive_name);
|
||||
if (!pkg)
|
||||
archive_read_finish(pkg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
return rc;
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "x509-sign-package") == 0) {
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_SSL
|
||||
--argc;
|
||||
++argv;
|
||||
if (argc != 4)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "x509-sign-package takes exactly four arguments");
|
||||
pkg_sign_x509(argv[0], argv[1], argv[2], argv[3]);
|
||||
#else
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "OpenSSL support is not included");
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
} else if (strcasecmp(argv[0], "gpg-sign-package") == 0) {
|
||||
--argc;
|
||||
++argv;
|
||||
if (argc != 2)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "gpg-sign-package takes exactly two arguments");
|
||||
pkg_sign_gpg(argv[0], argv[1]);
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
else {
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct set_installed_info_arg {
|
||||
char *variable;
|
||||
char *value;
|
||||
int got_match;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
set_installed_info_var(const char *name, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct set_installed_info_arg *arg = cookie;
|
||||
char *filename;
|
||||
int retval;
|
||||
|
||||
filename = pkgdb_pkg_file(name, INSTALLED_INFO_FNAME);
|
||||
|
||||
retval = var_set(filename, arg->variable, arg->value);
|
||||
|
||||
free(filename);
|
||||
arg->got_match = 1;
|
||||
|
||||
return retval;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
set_unset_variable(char **argv, Boolean unset)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct set_installed_info_arg arg;
|
||||
char *eq;
|
||||
char *variable;
|
||||
int ret = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (argv[0] == NULL || argv[1] == NULL)
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
|
||||
variable = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
if (unset) {
|
||||
arg.variable = argv[0];
|
||||
arg.value = NULL;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
eq = NULL;
|
||||
if ((eq=strchr(argv[0], '=')) == NULL)
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
|
||||
variable = xmalloc(eq-argv[0]+1);
|
||||
strlcpy(variable, argv[0], eq-argv[0]+1);
|
||||
|
||||
arg.variable = variable;
|
||||
arg.value = eq+1;
|
||||
|
||||
if (strcmp(variable, AUTOMATIC_VARNAME) == 0 &&
|
||||
strcasecmp(arg.value, "yes") != 0 &&
|
||||
strcasecmp(arg.value, "no") != 0) {
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE,
|
||||
"unknown value `%s' for " AUTOMATIC_VARNAME,
|
||||
arg.value);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (strpbrk(arg.variable, "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ") != NULL) {
|
||||
free(variable);
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE,
|
||||
"variable name must not contain uppercase letters");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
argv++;
|
||||
while (*argv != NULL) {
|
||||
arg.got_match = 0;
|
||||
if (match_installed_pkgs(*argv, set_installed_info_var, &arg) == -1)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot process pkdbdb");
|
||||
if (arg.got_match == 0) {
|
||||
char *pattern;
|
||||
|
||||
if (ispkgpattern(*argv)) {
|
||||
warnx("no matching pkg for `%s'", *argv);
|
||||
ret++;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
pattern = xasprintf("%s-[0-9]*", *argv);
|
||||
|
||||
if (match_installed_pkgs(pattern, set_installed_info_var, &arg) == -1)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot process pkdbdb");
|
||||
|
||||
if (arg.got_match == 0) {
|
||||
warnx("cannot find package %s", *argv);
|
||||
++ret;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(pattern);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
argv++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (ret > 0)
|
||||
exit(EXIT_FAILURE);
|
||||
|
||||
free(variable);
|
||||
|
||||
return;
|
||||
}
|
324
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/pkg_admin.1
vendored
Normal file
324
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/admin/pkg_admin.1
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,324 @@
|
|||
.\" $NetBSD: pkg_admin.1,v 1.1.1.12 2013/04/20 15:26:52 wiz Exp $
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Copyright (c) 1999-2010 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
.\" All rights reserved.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
.\" by Hubert Feyrer <hubert@feyrer.de>.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
.\" are met:
|
||||
.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
|
||||
.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
|
||||
.\" This product includes software developed by the NetBSD
|
||||
.\" Foundation, Inc. and its contributors.
|
||||
.\" 4. Neither the name of The NetBSD Foundation nor the names of its
|
||||
.\" contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived
|
||||
.\" from this software without specific prior written permission.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
.\" ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
.\" TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
.\" PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
.\" POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.Dd December 14, 2012
|
||||
.Dt PKG_ADMIN 1
|
||||
.Os
|
||||
.Sh NAME
|
||||
.Nm pkg_admin
|
||||
.Nd perform various administrative tasks to the pkg system
|
||||
.Sh SYNOPSIS
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
.Op Fl bqSVv
|
||||
.Op Fl C Ar config
|
||||
.Op Fl d Ar lsdir
|
||||
.Op Fl K Ar pkg_dbdir
|
||||
.Op Fl s Ar sfx_pattern
|
||||
.Ar command Op args ...
|
||||
.Sh DESCRIPTION
|
||||
This command performs various administrative tasks around the
|
||||
.Nx
|
||||
Packages System.
|
||||
.Sh OPTIONS
|
||||
The following command-line options are supported:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent
|
||||
.It Fl b
|
||||
Print only the base names when matching package names for
|
||||
.Cm lsall
|
||||
and
|
||||
.Cm lsbest .
|
||||
.It Fl C Ar config
|
||||
Read the configuration file from
|
||||
.Ar config
|
||||
instead of the system default.
|
||||
.It Fl d Ar lsdir
|
||||
Set
|
||||
.Ar lsdir
|
||||
as the path to the directory in which to find matching package names for
|
||||
.Cm lsall
|
||||
and
|
||||
.Cm lsbest .
|
||||
.It Fl K Ar pkg_dbdir
|
||||
Override the value of the
|
||||
.Dv PKG_DBDIR
|
||||
configuration option with the value
|
||||
.Ar pkg_dbdir .
|
||||
.It Fl q
|
||||
Perform checks in a quiet manner.
|
||||
In normal operation,
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
prints a
|
||||
.Sq \&.
|
||||
to standard output to indicate progress.
|
||||
This option suppresses this progress indicator.
|
||||
.It Fl S
|
||||
Set the shell glob pattern for package suffixes when matching package
|
||||
names for
|
||||
.Cm lsall
|
||||
and
|
||||
.Cm lsbest
|
||||
to be the null suffix.
|
||||
.It Fl s Ar sfx_pattern
|
||||
Set the shell glob pattern for package suffixes when matching package
|
||||
names for
|
||||
.Cm lsall
|
||||
and
|
||||
.Cm lsbest .
|
||||
The default pattern is ".t[bg]z".
|
||||
.It Fl V
|
||||
Print version number and exit.
|
||||
.It Fl v
|
||||
Be more verbose.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
The following commands are supported:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent
|
||||
.It Cm add Ar pkg ...
|
||||
For each listed package, write the absolute pathnames of the files listed in
|
||||
its
|
||||
.Pa +CONTENTS
|
||||
file together with the package they belong to into the package database.
|
||||
This should be used only by
|
||||
.Xr pkg_view 1 .
|
||||
.It Cm audit Oo Fl es Oc Oo Fl t Ar type Oc Oo Ar pkg Oc ...
|
||||
Check the listed installed packages for vulnerabilities.
|
||||
If no package is given, check all installed packages.
|
||||
If
|
||||
.Fl e
|
||||
is given, override the
|
||||
.Dv CHECK_END_OF_LIFE
|
||||
option from
|
||||
.Xr pkg_install.conf 5
|
||||
with
|
||||
.Qq Li yes .
|
||||
If
|
||||
.Fl s
|
||||
is given, check the signature of the pkg-vulnerabilities file before using it.
|
||||
.Fl t
|
||||
restricts the reported vulnerabilities to type
|
||||
.Ar type .
|
||||
.It Cm audit-pkg Oo Fl es Oc Oo Fl t Ar type Oc Oo Ar pkg Oc ...
|
||||
Like
|
||||
.Cm audit ,
|
||||
but check only the given package names or patterns.
|
||||
.It Cm audit-batch Oo Fl es Oc Oo Fl t Ar type Oc Oo Ar pkg-list Oc ...
|
||||
Like
|
||||
.Cm audit-pkg ,
|
||||
but read the package names or patterns one per line from the given files.
|
||||
.It Cm audit-history Oo Fl s Oc Oo Fl t Ar type Oc Oo Ar pkgbase Oc ...
|
||||
Print all vulnerabilities for the given base package names.
|
||||
.It Cm check Op Ar pkg ...
|
||||
Use this command to check the files belonging to some or all of the
|
||||
packages installed on the local machine against the checksum
|
||||
which was recorded in the
|
||||
.Pa +CONTENTS
|
||||
files at package installation time.
|
||||
Symbolic links also have their integrity checked against the recorded
|
||||
value at package installation time.
|
||||
If no additional argument is given, the files of all installed packages
|
||||
are checked, else only the named packages will be checked (wildcards can
|
||||
be used here, see
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1 ) .
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
The packages'
|
||||
.Pa +CONTENTS
|
||||
files will be parsed and the
|
||||
checksum will be checked for every file found.
|
||||
A warning message is printed if the expected checksum differs from the
|
||||
checksum of the file on disk.
|
||||
Symbolic links are also checked, ensuring that the targets on disk are
|
||||
the same as the contents recorded at package installation time.
|
||||
.It Cm check-license Ar condition
|
||||
Check if
|
||||
.Ar condition
|
||||
can be fulfilled with the currently set of accepted licenses.
|
||||
Prints either yes or no to stdout if the condition can be parsed,
|
||||
otherwise it exits with error.
|
||||
.It Cm check-pkg-vulnerabilities Oo Fl s Oc Ar file
|
||||
Check format and hashes in the pkg-vulnerabilities file
|
||||
.Ar file .
|
||||
If
|
||||
.Fl s
|
||||
is given, also check the embedded signature.
|
||||
.It Cm check-signature Ar file ...
|
||||
Reports if
|
||||
.Ar file
|
||||
is a correctly signed package.
|
||||
.It Cm check-single-license Ar license
|
||||
Check if
|
||||
.Ar license
|
||||
is a valid license name and if it is in the set of acceptable licenses.
|
||||
Prints either yes or no to stdout if the condition can be parsed,
|
||||
otherwise it exits with error.
|
||||
.It Cm config-var Ar variable
|
||||
Print the current value of
|
||||
.Ar variable
|
||||
as used after parsing the configuration file.
|
||||
.It Cm delete Ar pkg ...
|
||||
For each listed package, remove all file entries in the package database that
|
||||
belong to the package.
|
||||
This should be used only by
|
||||
.Xr pkg_view 1 .
|
||||
.It Cm dump
|
||||
Dump the contents of the package database, similar to
|
||||
.Cm pkg_info -F .
|
||||
Columns are printed for the key field used in the pkgdb - the filename -,
|
||||
and the data field - the package the file belongs to.
|
||||
.It Cm fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities Oo Fl su Oc
|
||||
Fetch a new pkg-vulnerabilities file, check the format and if
|
||||
.Fl s
|
||||
is given the signature.
|
||||
If all checks are passed, write it to pkgdb.
|
||||
If
|
||||
.Fl u
|
||||
is given, the fetch is conditional and the file transfer is only done if
|
||||
the remote version is newer than the one in pkgdb.
|
||||
.It Cm findbest Ar pattern ...
|
||||
Search the entries of
|
||||
.Dv PKG_PATH
|
||||
for packages matching
|
||||
.Ar pattern .
|
||||
Print the URL of the best matching package to stdout for each pattern.
|
||||
If a pattern is not matched, it is skipped and the command will return
|
||||
a failure.
|
||||
.It Cm lsall Ar /dir/pkgpattern
|
||||
.It Cm lsbest Ar /dir/pkgpattern
|
||||
List all/best package matching pattern in the given directory
|
||||
.Pa /dir .
|
||||
If the
|
||||
.Fl d
|
||||
flag is given, then that directory path overrides
|
||||
.Pa /dir .
|
||||
Can be used to work around limitations of /bin/sh and other
|
||||
filename globbing mechanisms.
|
||||
This option implements matching of
|
||||
pkg-wildcards against arbitrary files and directories, useful mainly in
|
||||
the build system itself.
|
||||
See
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1
|
||||
for a description of the pattern.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
Example:
|
||||
.Bd -literal
|
||||
yui# cd /usr/pkgsrc/packages/i386ELF/All/
|
||||
yui# ls unzip*
|
||||
unzip-5.40.tgz unzip-5.41.tgz
|
||||
yui# pkg_admin lsall 'unzip*'
|
||||
/usr/pkgsrc/packages/i386ELF/All/unzip-5.40.tgz
|
||||
/usr/pkgsrc/packages/i386ELF/All/unzip-5.41.tgz
|
||||
yui# pkg_admin lsall 'unzip\*[Ge]5.40'
|
||||
/usr/pkgsrc/packages/i386ELF/All/unzip-5.40.tgz
|
||||
/usr/pkgsrc/packages/i386ELF/All/unzip-5.41.tgz
|
||||
yui# pkg_admin lsall 'unzip\*[Ge]5.41'
|
||||
/usr/pkgsrc/packages/i386ELF/All/unzip-5.41.tgz
|
||||
yui# pkg_admin lsbest 'unzip\*[Ge]5.40'
|
||||
/usr/pkgsrc/packages/i386ELF/All/unzip-5.41.tgz
|
||||
yui# pkg_admin lsall /usr/pkgsrc/packages/i386ELF/All/'{mit,unproven}-pthread*'
|
||||
/usr/pkgsrc/packages/i386ELF/All/mit-pthreads-1.60b6.tgz
|
||||
/usr/pkgsrc/packages/i386ELF/All/unproven-pthreads-0.15.tgz
|
||||
.Ed
|
||||
.It Cm pmatch Ar pattern Ar pkg
|
||||
Returns true if
|
||||
.Ar pkg
|
||||
matches
|
||||
.Ar pattern ,
|
||||
otherwise returns false.
|
||||
.It Cm rebuild
|
||||
Rebuild the package database mapping from scratch, using the
|
||||
.Pa +CONTENTS
|
||||
files of the installed packages.
|
||||
This option is only intended for recovery after system crashes
|
||||
during package installation and removal.
|
||||
.It Cm rebuild-tree
|
||||
Rebuild the +REQUIRED_BY files from scratch by reresolving all dependencies.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
This option is intended to be used for fixing inconsistencies between
|
||||
the records of depending and depended-on packages, such as can arise
|
||||
by the use of
|
||||
.Cm pkg_delete -f .
|
||||
.It Cm set Ar variable=value pkg ...
|
||||
Set variable with information about the installed package.
|
||||
Use
|
||||
.Cm unset
|
||||
to remove a variable.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
Packages that are not installed directly by the user but pulled in as
|
||||
dependencies are marked by setting
|
||||
.Dq automatic=YES .
|
||||
.It Cm gpg-sign-package pkg spkg
|
||||
Sign the binary package
|
||||
.Ar pkg
|
||||
using GPG and write the result to
|
||||
.Ar spkg .
|
||||
.It Cm x509-sign-package pkg spkg key cert
|
||||
Sign the binary package
|
||||
.Ar pkg
|
||||
using the key
|
||||
.Ar key
|
||||
and the certificate
|
||||
.Ar cert ,
|
||||
using
|
||||
.Ar spkg
|
||||
as output file.
|
||||
.It Cm unset Ar variable pkg ...
|
||||
Remove an installation variable.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Sh ENVIRONMENT
|
||||
See
|
||||
.Xr pkg_install.conf 5
|
||||
for options, that can also be specified using the environment.
|
||||
.Sh FILES
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width /var/db/pkg/pkgdb.byfile.db -compact
|
||||
.It Pa /var/db/pkg/pkgdb.byfile.db
|
||||
.It Pa /var/db/pkg/\*[Lt]pkg\*[Gt]/+CONTENTS
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Sh SEE ALSO
|
||||
.Xr pkg_add 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_create 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_delete 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_view 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_install.conf 5 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkgsrc 7
|
||||
.Sh HISTORY
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
command first appeared in
|
||||
.Nx 1.4 .
|
||||
.Sh AUTHORS
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
command was written by Hubert Feyrer.
|
114
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/bpm/bpm.1
vendored
Normal file
114
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/bpm/bpm.1
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,114 @@
|
|||
.\" $NetBSD: bpm.1,v 1.4 2013/07/20 21:40:04 wiz Exp $ */
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Copyright (c) 2003,2009 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
.\" All rights reserved.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
.\" by Alistair Crooks (agc@NetBSD.org)
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
.\" are met:
|
||||
.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
.\" ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
.\" TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
.\" PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
.\" POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.Dd August 3, 2007
|
||||
.Dt BPM 1
|
||||
.Os
|
||||
.Sh NAME
|
||||
.Nm bpm
|
||||
.Nd menu-based binary package manager
|
||||
.Sh SYNOPSIS
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
.Op Fl hnVv
|
||||
.Op Fl b Ar baseURL
|
||||
.Op Fl m Ar machine
|
||||
.Op Fl r Ar release
|
||||
.Op Fl w Ar seconds
|
||||
.Sh DESCRIPTION
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
command is used to locate and install binary packages from any
|
||||
reachable URL.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
The following command-line options are supported:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent
|
||||
.It Fl b Ar baseURL
|
||||
Specify a base URL from which to download binary packages.
|
||||
The default URL is
|
||||
.Pa ftp://ftp.NetBSD.org/pub/pkgsrc/packages .
|
||||
.It Fl h
|
||||
Print a help message and then exit.
|
||||
.It Fl m Ar machine
|
||||
Use
|
||||
.Ar machine
|
||||
as the machine architecture to be used, instead of that returned by
|
||||
.Xr uname 1 .
|
||||
.It Fl n
|
||||
Don't actually execute the commands to add the package.
|
||||
.It Fl r Ar release
|
||||
Use
|
||||
.Ar release
|
||||
as the operating system release to be used, instead of that returned by
|
||||
.Xr uname 1 .
|
||||
.It Fl V
|
||||
Print version number and exit.
|
||||
.It Fl v
|
||||
Turn on verbose output.
|
||||
.It Fl w Ar seconds
|
||||
The number of
|
||||
.Ar seconds
|
||||
to wait after displaying an error message and returning to
|
||||
normal menu operations.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
provides a menu-based binary package manager for
|
||||
.Nx .
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
first connects to the URL using
|
||||
.Xr ftp 1 ,
|
||||
and displays a list of categories for which binary packages exist.
|
||||
If no categories are displayed, it could
|
||||
be that the machine architecture or operating system release string
|
||||
have been wrongly interpreted, and that it will be necessary to override
|
||||
this values by means of the command line options.
|
||||
Within a category, a list of packages will be displayed, and by selecting
|
||||
one using the number assigned to it, the package will be downloaded
|
||||
automatically, and installed, using the
|
||||
.Xr pkg_add 1
|
||||
utility.
|
||||
It is also possible to change the category currently being examined,
|
||||
and to quit from the utility, simply by selecting the appropriate choices
|
||||
on the menu.
|
||||
.Sh ENVIRONMENT
|
||||
The environment variables which govern the behavior of
|
||||
.Xr ftp 1
|
||||
and
|
||||
.Xr pkg_add 1
|
||||
are valid for
|
||||
.Nm .
|
||||
.Sh SEE ALSO
|
||||
.Xr ftp 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_add 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr uname 1
|
||||
.Sh AUTHORS
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
utility was written by
|
||||
.An Alistair Crooks Aq Mt agc@NetBSD.org .
|
220
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/bpm/bpm.sh.in
vendored
Normal file
220
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/bpm/bpm.sh.in
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,220 @@
|
|||
#! /bin/sh
|
||||
#
|
||||
# $NetBSD: bpm.sh.in,v 1.3 2012/02/21 18:36:16 wiz Exp $
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Copyright (c) 2003,2009 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
# All rights reserved.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
# by Alistair Crooks (agc@NetBSD.org)
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
# are met:
|
||||
# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
# ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
# TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
# PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
# BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
# CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
# SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
# INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
# CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
# ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
# POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
#
|
||||
|
||||
die()
|
||||
{
|
||||
echo >&2 "$@"
|
||||
exit 1
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
check_prog()
|
||||
{
|
||||
_var="$1"; _name="$2"
|
||||
|
||||
eval _tmp=\"\$$_var\"
|
||||
if [ "x$_tmp" != "x" ]; then
|
||||
# Variable is already set (by the user, for example)
|
||||
return 0
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
for _d in `echo $PATH | tr ':' ' '`; do
|
||||
if [ -x "$_d/$_name" ]; then
|
||||
# Program found
|
||||
eval $_var=\""$_d/$_name"\"
|
||||
return 1
|
||||
fi
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
die "$_name not found in path."
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
check_prog awkprog awk
|
||||
check_prog echoprog echo
|
||||
check_prog ftpprog ftp
|
||||
check_prog idprog id
|
||||
check_prog moreprog more
|
||||
check_prog pkg_addprog pkg_add
|
||||
check_prog rmprog rm
|
||||
check_prog sedprog sed
|
||||
check_prog suprog su
|
||||
check_prog unameprog uname
|
||||
|
||||
# print version and exit
|
||||
version() {
|
||||
$pkg_addprog -V
|
||||
exit 0
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
# temporary files
|
||||
tmpcategories=/tmp/categories.$$
|
||||
tmppackages=/tmp/packages.$$
|
||||
|
||||
# some base parameters
|
||||
base=ftp://ftp.NetBSD.org/pub/pkgsrc/packages
|
||||
release=`${unameprog} -r | ${sedprog} -e 's/_STABLE//'`
|
||||
machine=`${unameprog} -m`
|
||||
|
||||
sleepsecs=1
|
||||
|
||||
doit=""
|
||||
|
||||
while [ $# -gt 0 ]; do
|
||||
case $1 in
|
||||
-V) version ;;
|
||||
-b) base=$2; shift ;;
|
||||
-h) ${echoprog} "$0 [-b BaseURL] [-h] [-m machine] [-n] [-r release] [-v] [-w secs]"; exit 0;;
|
||||
-m) machine=$2; shift ;;
|
||||
-n) doit=":" ;;
|
||||
-r) release=$2; shift ;;
|
||||
-v) set -x ;;
|
||||
-w) sleepsecs=$2; shift ;;
|
||||
*) break ;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
shift
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
category=""
|
||||
|
||||
while true; do
|
||||
# if we don't have a packages file, then we need to choose a category
|
||||
case "$category" in
|
||||
"") # get possible categories
|
||||
if [ ! -f $tmpcategories ]; then
|
||||
${echoprog} "Downloading package categories from ${base}..."
|
||||
${echoprog} "** QUIT" > $tmpcategories
|
||||
${echoprog} ls | ${ftpprog} ${base}/${release}/${machine}/ 2>/dev/null | \
|
||||
${awkprog} 'NF == 9 { if ($9 != "All") print $9 }' >> $tmpcategories
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
# check for bad release numbering
|
||||
# - it usually shows with 0 categories being displayed
|
||||
${awkprog} 'END { if (NR == 1) { print "\n\n\n*** No categories found - is the OS release set properly? ***\n\n\n" } }' < $tmpcategories
|
||||
|
||||
# display possible categories
|
||||
${awkprog} '{ print NR ". " $0 }' < $tmpcategories | ${moreprog}
|
||||
|
||||
# read a category number from the user
|
||||
${echoprog} -n "Please type the category number: "
|
||||
read choice
|
||||
|
||||
# validate user's choice
|
||||
case "$choice" in
|
||||
0|1) ${rmprog} -f $tmpcategories $tmppackages; exit 0 ;;
|
||||
[2-9]|[0-9]*) category=`${awkprog} 'NR == '$choice' { print }' < $tmpcategories` ;;
|
||||
*) category="" ;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
case "$category" in
|
||||
"") ${echoprog} "No such category \"$choice\""
|
||||
sleep $sleepsecs
|
||||
continue
|
||||
;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
# get possible packages
|
||||
${echoprog} ""
|
||||
${echoprog} "Downloading package names from ${base}/${category}..."
|
||||
${echoprog} "** QUIT" > $tmppackages
|
||||
${echoprog} "** Change category" >> $tmppackages
|
||||
${echoprog} ls | ${ftpprog} ${base}/${release}/${machine}/${category}/ 2>/dev/null \
|
||||
| ${awkprog} 'NF == 11 { print $9 }' >> $tmppackages
|
||||
;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
# display possible packages
|
||||
${awkprog} '{ print NR ". " $0 }' < $tmppackages | ${moreprog}
|
||||
|
||||
# read a package number from the user
|
||||
${echoprog} -n "Please type the package number: "
|
||||
read choice
|
||||
|
||||
# validate user's choice
|
||||
case "$choice" in
|
||||
1) ${rmprog} -f $tmppackages $tmpcategories; exit 0 ;;
|
||||
2) category=""; continue ;; # no package to install - choose new category
|
||||
[3-9]|[0-9]*) package=`${awkprog} 'NR == '$choice' { print }' < $tmppackages` ;;
|
||||
*) package="" ;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
case "$package" in
|
||||
"") ${echoprog} "No such package \"$choice\""
|
||||
sleep $sleepsecs
|
||||
continue
|
||||
;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
# check it's not already installed
|
||||
pkgbase=`${echoprog} ${package} | ${sedprog} -e 's|-[0-9].*||'`
|
||||
installed=`pkg_info -e $pkgbase`
|
||||
case "$installed" in
|
||||
"") ;;
|
||||
*) ${echoprog} "$package selected, but $installed already installed"
|
||||
sleep $sleepsecs
|
||||
continue
|
||||
;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
# Tell people what we're doing
|
||||
${echoprog} ""
|
||||
${echoprog} "Adding package ${base}/${release}/${machine}/${category}/${package}"
|
||||
|
||||
cmd="env PKG_PATH=${base}/${release}/${machine}/All ${pkg_addprog} ${package}"
|
||||
|
||||
# check if we need to become root for this
|
||||
if [ `${idprog} -u` != 0 ]; then
|
||||
${echoprog} "Becoming root@`/bin/hostname` to add a binary package"
|
||||
${echoprog} -n "`${echoprog} ${suprog} | $awkprog '{ print $1 }'` "
|
||||
$doit ${suprog} root -c "$cmd"
|
||||
success=$?
|
||||
else
|
||||
$doit $cmd
|
||||
success=$?
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
# give feedback after adding the package
|
||||
case $success in
|
||||
0) ${echoprog} "$package successfully installed" ;;
|
||||
*) ${echoprog} "Problems when installing $package - please try again" ;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
${echoprog} ""
|
||||
${echoprog} -n "[Q]uit, [C]hange category, [I]nstall another package: "
|
||||
read choice
|
||||
|
||||
case "$choice" in
|
||||
[Qq]) break ;;
|
||||
[Cc]) category="" ;;
|
||||
[Ii]) ;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
${rmprog} -f $tmpcategories $tmppackages
|
||||
|
||||
exit 0
|
422
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/build.c
vendored
Normal file
422
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/build.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,422 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: build.c,v 1.1.1.8 2010/04/23 20:54:07 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: build.c,v 1.1.1.8 2010/04/23 20:54:07 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2007 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This code was developed as part of Google's Summer of Code 2007 program.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is the main body of the create module.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
#include "create.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_GRP_H
|
||||
#include <grp.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_PWD_H
|
||||
#include <pwd.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_UNISTD_H
|
||||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_FCNTL_H
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <archive.h>
|
||||
#include <archive_entry.h>
|
||||
|
||||
static struct memory_file *contents_file;
|
||||
static struct memory_file *comment_file;
|
||||
static struct memory_file *desc_file;
|
||||
static struct memory_file *install_file;
|
||||
static struct memory_file *deinstall_file;
|
||||
static struct memory_file *display_file;
|
||||
static struct memory_file *build_version_file;
|
||||
static struct memory_file *build_info_file;
|
||||
static struct memory_file *size_pkg_file;
|
||||
static struct memory_file *size_all_file;
|
||||
static struct memory_file *preserve_file;
|
||||
static struct memory_file *views_file;
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
write_meta_file(struct memory_file *file, struct archive *archive)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct archive_entry *entry;
|
||||
|
||||
entry = archive_entry_new();
|
||||
archive_entry_set_pathname(entry, file->name);
|
||||
archive_entry_copy_stat(entry, &file->st);
|
||||
|
||||
archive_entry_set_uname(entry, file->owner);
|
||||
archive_entry_set_gname(entry, file->group);
|
||||
|
||||
if (archive_write_header(archive, entry))
|
||||
errx(2, "cannot write to archive: %s", archive_error_string(archive));
|
||||
|
||||
archive_write_data(archive, file->data, file->len);
|
||||
|
||||
archive_entry_free(entry);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
write_entry(struct archive *archive, struct archive_entry *entry)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char buf[16384];
|
||||
const char *name;
|
||||
int fd;
|
||||
off_t len;
|
||||
ssize_t buf_len;
|
||||
|
||||
if (archive_entry_pathname(entry) == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("entry with NULL path");
|
||||
return;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (archive_write_header(archive, entry)) {
|
||||
errx(2, "cannot write %s to archive: %s",
|
||||
archive_entry_pathname(entry),
|
||||
archive_error_string(archive));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Only regular files can have data. */
|
||||
if (archive_entry_filetype(entry) != AE_IFREG ||
|
||||
archive_entry_size(entry) == 0) {
|
||||
archive_entry_free(entry);
|
||||
return;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
name = archive_entry_pathname(entry);
|
||||
|
||||
if ((fd = open(name, O_RDONLY)) == -1)
|
||||
err(2, "cannot open data file %s", name);
|
||||
|
||||
len = archive_entry_size(entry);
|
||||
|
||||
while (len > 0) {
|
||||
buf_len = (len > (off_t)sizeof(buf)) ? (ssize_t)sizeof(buf) : (ssize_t)len;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((buf_len = read(fd, buf, buf_len)) == 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
else if (buf_len < 0)
|
||||
err(2, "cannot read from %s", name);
|
||||
|
||||
archive_write_data(archive, buf, (size_t)buf_len);
|
||||
len -= buf_len;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
close(fd);
|
||||
|
||||
archive_entry_free(entry);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
write_normal_file(const char *name, struct archive *archive,
|
||||
struct archive_entry_linkresolver *resolver,
|
||||
const char *owner, const char *group)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char buf[16384];
|
||||
ssize_t buf_len;
|
||||
struct archive_entry *entry, *sparse_entry;
|
||||
struct stat st;
|
||||
|
||||
if (lstat(name, &st) == -1)
|
||||
err(2, "lstat failed for file %s", name);
|
||||
|
||||
entry = archive_entry_new();
|
||||
archive_entry_set_pathname(entry, name);
|
||||
archive_entry_copy_stat(entry, &st);
|
||||
|
||||
if (owner != NULL) {
|
||||
uid_t uid;
|
||||
|
||||
archive_entry_set_uname(entry, owner);
|
||||
if (uid_from_user(owner, &uid) == -1)
|
||||
errx(2, "user %s unknown", owner);
|
||||
archive_entry_set_uid(entry, uid);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
archive_entry_set_uname(entry, user_from_uid(st.st_uid, 1));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (group != NULL) {
|
||||
gid_t gid;
|
||||
|
||||
archive_entry_set_gname(entry, group);
|
||||
if (gid_from_group(group, &gid) == -1)
|
||||
errx(2, "group %s unknown", group);
|
||||
archive_entry_set_gid(entry, gid);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
archive_entry_set_gname(entry, group_from_gid(st.st_gid, 1));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if ((st.st_mode & S_IFMT) == S_IFLNK) {
|
||||
buf_len = readlink(name, buf, sizeof buf);
|
||||
if (buf_len < 0)
|
||||
err(2, "cannot read symlink %s", name);
|
||||
buf[buf_len] = '\0';
|
||||
archive_entry_set_symlink(entry, buf);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
archive_entry_linkify(resolver, &entry, &sparse_entry);
|
||||
|
||||
if (entry != NULL)
|
||||
write_entry(archive, entry);
|
||||
if (sparse_entry != NULL)
|
||||
write_entry(archive, sparse_entry);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
make_dist(const char *pkg, const char *suffix, const package_t *plist)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *archive_name;
|
||||
const char *owner, *group;
|
||||
const plist_t *p;
|
||||
struct archive *archive;
|
||||
struct archive_entry *entry, *sparse_entry;
|
||||
struct archive_entry_linkresolver *resolver;
|
||||
char *initial_cwd;
|
||||
|
||||
archive = archive_write_new();
|
||||
archive_write_set_format_pax_restricted(archive);
|
||||
if ((resolver = archive_entry_linkresolver_new()) == NULL)
|
||||
errx(2, "cannot create link resolver");
|
||||
archive_entry_linkresolver_set_strategy(resolver,
|
||||
archive_format(archive));
|
||||
|
||||
if (CompressionType == NULL) {
|
||||
if (strcmp(suffix, "tbz") == 0 ||
|
||||
strcmp(suffix, "tar.bz2") == 0)
|
||||
CompressionType = "bzip2";
|
||||
else if (strcmp(suffix, "tgz") == 0 ||
|
||||
strcmp(suffix, "tar.gz") == 0)
|
||||
CompressionType = "gzip";
|
||||
else
|
||||
CompressionType = "none";
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (strcmp(CompressionType, "bzip2") == 0)
|
||||
archive_write_set_compression_bzip2(archive);
|
||||
else if (strcmp(CompressionType, "gzip") == 0)
|
||||
archive_write_set_compression_gzip(archive);
|
||||
else if (strcmp(CompressionType, "xz") == 0)
|
||||
archive_write_set_compression_xz(archive);
|
||||
else if (strcmp(CompressionType, "none") == 0)
|
||||
archive_write_set_compression_none(archive);
|
||||
else
|
||||
errx(1, "Unspported compression type for -F: %s",
|
||||
CompressionType);
|
||||
|
||||
archive_name = xasprintf("%s.%s", pkg, suffix);
|
||||
|
||||
if (archive_write_open_file(archive, archive_name))
|
||||
errx(2, "cannot create archive: %s", archive_error_string(archive));
|
||||
|
||||
free(archive_name);
|
||||
|
||||
owner = DefaultOwner;
|
||||
group = DefaultGroup;
|
||||
|
||||
write_meta_file(contents_file, archive);
|
||||
write_meta_file(comment_file, archive);
|
||||
write_meta_file(desc_file, archive);
|
||||
|
||||
if (Install)
|
||||
write_meta_file(install_file, archive);
|
||||
if (DeInstall)
|
||||
write_meta_file(deinstall_file, archive);
|
||||
if (Display)
|
||||
write_meta_file(display_file, archive);
|
||||
if (BuildVersion)
|
||||
write_meta_file(build_version_file, archive);
|
||||
if (BuildInfo)
|
||||
write_meta_file(build_info_file, archive);
|
||||
if (SizePkg)
|
||||
write_meta_file(size_pkg_file, archive);
|
||||
if (SizeAll)
|
||||
write_meta_file(size_all_file, archive);
|
||||
if (Preserve)
|
||||
write_meta_file(preserve_file, archive);
|
||||
if (create_views)
|
||||
write_meta_file(views_file, archive);
|
||||
|
||||
initial_cwd = getcwd(NULL, 0);
|
||||
|
||||
for (p = plist->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
if (p->type == PLIST_FILE) {
|
||||
write_normal_file(p->name, archive, resolver, owner, group);
|
||||
} else if (p->type == PLIST_CWD) {
|
||||
chdir(p->name);
|
||||
} else if (p->type == PLIST_IGNORE) {
|
||||
p = p->next;
|
||||
} else if (p->type == PLIST_CHOWN) {
|
||||
if (p->name != NULL)
|
||||
owner = p->name;
|
||||
else
|
||||
owner = DefaultOwner;
|
||||
} else if (p->type == PLIST_CHGRP) {
|
||||
if (p->name != NULL)
|
||||
group = p->name;
|
||||
else
|
||||
group = DefaultGroup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
entry = NULL;
|
||||
archive_entry_linkify(resolver, &entry, &sparse_entry);
|
||||
while (entry != NULL) {
|
||||
write_entry(archive, entry);
|
||||
entry = NULL;
|
||||
archive_entry_linkify(resolver, &entry, &sparse_entry);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
archive_entry_linkresolver_free(resolver);
|
||||
|
||||
if (archive_write_close(archive))
|
||||
errx(2, "cannot finish archive: %s", archive_error_string(archive));
|
||||
archive_write_finish(archive);
|
||||
|
||||
free(initial_cwd);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static struct memory_file *
|
||||
load_and_add(package_t *plist, const char *input_name,
|
||||
const char *target_name, mode_t perm)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct memory_file *file;
|
||||
|
||||
file = load_memory_file(input_name, target_name, DefaultOwner,
|
||||
DefaultGroup, perm);
|
||||
add_plist(plist, PLIST_IGNORE, NULL);
|
||||
add_plist(plist, PLIST_FILE, target_name);
|
||||
|
||||
return file;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static struct memory_file *
|
||||
make_and_add(package_t *plist, const char *target_name,
|
||||
char *content, mode_t perm)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct memory_file *file;
|
||||
|
||||
file = make_memory_file(target_name, content, strlen(content),
|
||||
DefaultOwner, DefaultGroup, perm);
|
||||
add_plist(plist, PLIST_IGNORE, NULL);
|
||||
add_plist(plist, PLIST_FILE, target_name);
|
||||
|
||||
return file;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
pkg_build(const char *pkg, const char *full_pkg, const char *suffix,
|
||||
package_t *plist)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *plist_buf;
|
||||
size_t plist_len;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Now put the release specific items in */
|
||||
add_plist(plist, PLIST_CWD, ".");
|
||||
comment_file = make_and_add(plist, COMMENT_FNAME, Comment, 0444);
|
||||
desc_file = make_and_add(plist, DESC_FNAME, Desc, 0444);
|
||||
|
||||
if (Install) {
|
||||
install_file = load_and_add(plist, Install, INSTALL_FNAME,
|
||||
0555);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (DeInstall) {
|
||||
deinstall_file = load_and_add(plist, DeInstall,
|
||||
DEINSTALL_FNAME, 0555);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Display) {
|
||||
display_file = load_and_add(plist, Display,
|
||||
DISPLAY_FNAME, 0444);
|
||||
add_plist(plist, PLIST_DISPLAY, DISPLAY_FNAME);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (BuildVersion) {
|
||||
build_version_file = load_and_add(plist, BuildVersion,
|
||||
BUILD_VERSION_FNAME, 0444);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (BuildInfo) {
|
||||
build_info_file = load_and_add(plist, BuildInfo,
|
||||
BUILD_INFO_FNAME, 0444);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (SizePkg) {
|
||||
size_pkg_file = load_and_add(plist, SizePkg,
|
||||
SIZE_PKG_FNAME, 0444);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (SizeAll) {
|
||||
size_all_file = load_and_add(plist, SizeAll,
|
||||
SIZE_ALL_FNAME, 0444);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Preserve) {
|
||||
preserve_file = load_and_add(plist, Preserve,
|
||||
PRESERVE_FNAME, 0444);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (create_views)
|
||||
views_file = make_and_add(plist, VIEWS_FNAME, xstrdup(""), 0444);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Finally, write out the packing list */
|
||||
stringify_plist(plist, &plist_buf, &plist_len, realprefix);
|
||||
contents_file = make_memory_file(CONTENTS_FNAME, plist_buf, plist_len,
|
||||
DefaultOwner, DefaultGroup, 0644);
|
||||
|
||||
/* And stick it into a tar ball */
|
||||
make_dist(pkg, suffix, plist);
|
||||
|
||||
return TRUE; /* Success */
|
||||
}
|
77
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/create.h
vendored
Normal file
77
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/create.h
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,77 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: create.h,v 1.1.1.5 2009/11/05 18:39:02 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/* from FreeBSD Id: create.h,v 1.13 1997/10/08 07:46:19 charnier Exp */
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Include and define various things wanted by the create command.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _INST_CREATE_H_INCLUDE
|
||||
#define _INST_CREATE_H_INCLUDE
|
||||
|
||||
struct memory_file {
|
||||
struct stat st;
|
||||
const char *name;
|
||||
const char *owner;
|
||||
const char *group;
|
||||
mode_t mode;
|
||||
|
||||
char *data;
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
extern char *Prefix;
|
||||
extern char *Comment;
|
||||
extern char *Desc;
|
||||
extern char *Display;
|
||||
extern char *Install;
|
||||
extern char *DeInstall;
|
||||
extern char *Contents;
|
||||
extern char *Pkgdeps;
|
||||
extern char *BuildPkgdeps;
|
||||
extern char *Pkgcfl;
|
||||
extern char *BuildVersion;
|
||||
extern char *BuildInfo;
|
||||
extern char *SizePkg;
|
||||
extern char *SizeAll;
|
||||
extern char *Preserve;
|
||||
extern char *realprefix;
|
||||
extern char *DefaultOwner;
|
||||
extern char *DefaultGroup;
|
||||
extern const char *CompressionType;
|
||||
extern int PlistOnly;
|
||||
extern int RelativeLinks;
|
||||
extern int update_pkgdb;
|
||||
extern int create_views;
|
||||
|
||||
void check_list(package_t *, const char *);
|
||||
void copy_plist(char *, package_t *);
|
||||
|
||||
struct memory_file
|
||||
*load_memory_file(const char *, const char *,
|
||||
const char *, const char *, mode_t);
|
||||
struct memory_file
|
||||
*make_memory_file(const char *, void *, size_t,
|
||||
const char *, const char *, mode_t);
|
||||
void free_memory_file(struct memory_file *);
|
||||
|
||||
int pkg_perform(const char *);
|
||||
int pkg_build(const char *, const char *, const char *, package_t *plist);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _INST_CREATE_H_INCLUDE */
|
217
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/main.c
vendored
Normal file
217
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/main.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,217 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: main.c,v 1.1.1.7 2010/01/30 21:33:31 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: main.c,v 1.1.1.7 2010/01/30 21:33:31 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is the create module.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
#include "create.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static const char Options[] = "B:C:D:EF:I:K:L:OP:S:T:UVb:c:d:f:g:i:k:ln:p:r:s:u:v";
|
||||
|
||||
char *Prefix = NULL;
|
||||
char *Comment = NULL;
|
||||
char *Desc = NULL;
|
||||
char *Display = NULL;
|
||||
char *Install = NULL;
|
||||
char *DeInstall = NULL;
|
||||
char *Contents = NULL;
|
||||
char *Pkgdeps = NULL;
|
||||
char *BuildPkgdeps = NULL;
|
||||
char *Pkgcfl = NULL;
|
||||
char *BuildVersion = NULL;
|
||||
char *BuildInfo = NULL;
|
||||
char *SizePkg = NULL;
|
||||
char *SizeAll = NULL;
|
||||
char *Preserve = NULL;
|
||||
char *DefaultOwner = NULL;
|
||||
char *DefaultGroup = NULL;
|
||||
char *realprefix = NULL;
|
||||
const char *CompressionType = NULL;
|
||||
int update_pkgdb = 1;
|
||||
int create_views = 0;
|
||||
int PlistOnly = 0;
|
||||
int RelativeLinks = 0;
|
||||
Boolean File2Pkg = FALSE;
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
usage(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
fprintf(stderr,
|
||||
"usage: pkg_create [-ElOUVv] [-B build-info-file] [-b build-version-file]\n"
|
||||
" [-C cpkgs] [-D displayfile] [-F compression] \n"
|
||||
" [-I realprefix] [-i iscript]\n"
|
||||
" [-K pkg_dbdir] [-k dscript]\n"
|
||||
" [-n preserve-file] [-P dpkgs] [-p prefix] [-r rscript]\n"
|
||||
" [-S size-all-file] [-s size-pkg-file]\n"
|
||||
" [-T buildpkgs] [-u owner] [-g group]\n"
|
||||
" -c comment -d description -f packlist\n"
|
||||
" pkg-name\n");
|
||||
exit(1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
main(int argc, char **argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int ch;
|
||||
|
||||
setprogname(argv[0]);
|
||||
while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, Options)) != -1)
|
||||
switch (ch) {
|
||||
case 'v':
|
||||
Verbose = TRUE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'E':
|
||||
create_views = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'F':
|
||||
CompressionType = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'I':
|
||||
realprefix = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'O':
|
||||
PlistOnly = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'U':
|
||||
update_pkgdb = 0;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'p':
|
||||
Prefix = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 's':
|
||||
SizePkg = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'S':
|
||||
SizeAll = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'f':
|
||||
Contents = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'c':
|
||||
Comment = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'd':
|
||||
Desc = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'g':
|
||||
DefaultGroup = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'i':
|
||||
Install = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'K':
|
||||
pkgdb_set_dir(optarg, 3);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'k':
|
||||
DeInstall = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'l':
|
||||
RelativeLinks = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'L':
|
||||
warnx("Obsolete -L option ignored");
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'u':
|
||||
DefaultOwner = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'D':
|
||||
Display = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'n':
|
||||
Preserve = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'P':
|
||||
Pkgdeps = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'T':
|
||||
BuildPkgdeps = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'C':
|
||||
Pkgcfl = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'b':
|
||||
BuildVersion = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'B':
|
||||
BuildInfo = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'V':
|
||||
show_version();
|
||||
/* NOTREACHED */
|
||||
|
||||
case '?':
|
||||
default:
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
argc -= optind;
|
||||
argv += optind;
|
||||
|
||||
pkg_install_config();
|
||||
|
||||
if (argc == 0) {
|
||||
warnx("missing package name");
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (argc != 1) {
|
||||
warnx("only one package name allowed");
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkg_perform(*argv))
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
if (Verbose) {
|
||||
if (PlistOnly)
|
||||
warnx("package registration failed");
|
||||
else
|
||||
warnx("package creation failed");
|
||||
}
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
244
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/perform.c
vendored
Normal file
244
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/perform.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,244 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: perform.c,v 1.1.1.5 2009/11/05 18:39:02 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: perform.c,v 1.1.1.5 2009/11/05 18:39:02 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is the main body of the create module.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
#include "create.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_FCNTL_H
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_UNISTD_H
|
||||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
sanity_check(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (!Comment)
|
||||
errx(2, "required package comment string is missing (-c comment)");
|
||||
if (!Desc)
|
||||
errx(2, "required package description string is missing (-d desc)");
|
||||
if (!Contents)
|
||||
errx(2, "required package contents list is missing (-f [-]file)");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
register_depends(package_t *plist, char *deps, int build_only)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *cp;
|
||||
|
||||
if (Verbose && !PlistOnly) {
|
||||
if (build_only)
|
||||
printf("Registering build depends:");
|
||||
else
|
||||
printf("Registering depends:");
|
||||
}
|
||||
while (deps) {
|
||||
cp = strsep(&deps, " \t\n");
|
||||
if (*cp) {
|
||||
char *best_installed;
|
||||
best_installed = find_best_matching_installed_pkg(cp);
|
||||
if (best_installed != NULL) {
|
||||
add_plist(plist, PLIST_BLDDEP, best_installed);
|
||||
if (Verbose && !PlistOnly && build_only)
|
||||
printf(" %s", cp);
|
||||
} else
|
||||
warnx("No matching package installed for %s", cp);
|
||||
free(best_installed);
|
||||
if (!build_only) {
|
||||
add_plist(plist, PLIST_PKGDEP, cp);
|
||||
if (Verbose && !PlistOnly)
|
||||
printf(" %s", cp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Verbose && !PlistOnly)
|
||||
printf(".\n");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Expect "fname" to point at a file, and read it into
|
||||
* the buffer returned.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static char *
|
||||
fileGetContents(char *fname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *contents;
|
||||
struct stat sb;
|
||||
int fd;
|
||||
|
||||
if (stat(fname, &sb) == FAIL) {
|
||||
errx(2, "can't stat '%s'", fname);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
contents = xmalloc((size_t) (sb.st_size) + 1);
|
||||
fd = open(fname, O_RDONLY, 0);
|
||||
if (fd == FAIL) {
|
||||
errx(2, "unable to open '%s' for reading", fname);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (read(fd, contents, (size_t) sb.st_size) != (ssize_t) sb.st_size) {
|
||||
errx(2, "short read on '%s' - did not get %lld bytes",
|
||||
fname, (long long) sb.st_size);
|
||||
}
|
||||
close(fd);
|
||||
contents[(size_t) sb.st_size] = '\0';
|
||||
return contents;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Get a string parameter as a file spec or as a "contents follow -" spec
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void
|
||||
get_dash_string(char **s)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (**s == '-')
|
||||
*s = xstrdup(*s + 1);
|
||||
else
|
||||
*s = fileGetContents(*s);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
pkg_perform(const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *cp;
|
||||
FILE *pkg_in;
|
||||
package_t plist;
|
||||
const char *full_pkg, *suffix;
|
||||
char *allocated_pkg;
|
||||
int retval;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Break the package name into base and desired suffix (if any) */
|
||||
if ((cp = strrchr(pkg, '.')) != NULL) {
|
||||
allocated_pkg = xmalloc(cp - pkg + 1);
|
||||
memcpy(allocated_pkg, pkg, cp - pkg);
|
||||
allocated_pkg[cp - pkg] = '\0';
|
||||
suffix = cp + 1;
|
||||
full_pkg = pkg;
|
||||
pkg = allocated_pkg;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
allocated_pkg = NULL;
|
||||
full_pkg = pkg;
|
||||
suffix = "tgz";
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Preliminary setup */
|
||||
sanity_check();
|
||||
if (Verbose && !PlistOnly)
|
||||
printf("Creating package %s\n", pkg);
|
||||
get_dash_string(&Comment);
|
||||
get_dash_string(&Desc);
|
||||
if (IS_STDIN(Contents))
|
||||
pkg_in = stdin;
|
||||
else {
|
||||
pkg_in = fopen(Contents, "r");
|
||||
if (!pkg_in)
|
||||
errx(2, "unable to open contents file '%s' for input", Contents);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
plist.head = plist.tail = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Stick the dependencies, if any, at the top */
|
||||
if (Pkgdeps)
|
||||
register_depends(&plist, Pkgdeps, 0);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Put the build dependencies after the dependencies.
|
||||
* This works due to the evaluation order in pkg_add.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
if (BuildPkgdeps)
|
||||
register_depends(&plist, BuildPkgdeps, 1);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Put the conflicts directly after the dependencies, if any */
|
||||
if (Pkgcfl) {
|
||||
if (Verbose && !PlistOnly)
|
||||
printf("Registering conflicts:");
|
||||
while (Pkgcfl) {
|
||||
cp = strsep(&Pkgcfl, " \t\n");
|
||||
if (*cp) {
|
||||
add_plist(&plist, PLIST_PKGCFL, cp);
|
||||
if (Verbose && !PlistOnly)
|
||||
printf(" %s", cp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Verbose && !PlistOnly)
|
||||
printf(".\n");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Slurp in the packing list */
|
||||
append_plist(&plist, pkg_in);
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkg_in != stdin)
|
||||
fclose(pkg_in);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Prefix should override the packing list */
|
||||
if (Prefix) {
|
||||
delete_plist(&plist, FALSE, PLIST_CWD, NULL);
|
||||
add_plist_top(&plist, PLIST_CWD, Prefix);
|
||||
}
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Run down the list and see if we've named it, if not stick in a name
|
||||
* at the top.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
if (find_plist(&plist, PLIST_NAME) == NULL) {
|
||||
add_plist_top(&plist, PLIST_NAME, basename_of(pkg));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Make first "real contents" pass over it */
|
||||
check_list(&plist, basename_of(pkg));
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* We're just here for to dump out a revised plist for the FreeBSD ports
|
||||
* hack. It's not a real create in progress.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
if (PlistOnly) {
|
||||
write_plist(&plist, stdout, realprefix);
|
||||
retval = TRUE;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
#ifdef BOOTSTRAP
|
||||
warnx("Package building is not supported in bootstrap mode");
|
||||
retval = FALSE;
|
||||
#else
|
||||
retval = pkg_build(pkg, full_pkg, suffix, &plist);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Cleanup */
|
||||
free(Comment);
|
||||
free(Desc);
|
||||
free_plist(&plist);
|
||||
|
||||
free(allocated_pkg);
|
||||
|
||||
return retval;
|
||||
}
|
504
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/pkg_create.1
vendored
Normal file
504
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/pkg_create.1
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,504 @@
|
|||
.\" $NetBSD: pkg_create.1,v 1.1.1.8 2010/04/23 20:54:08 joerg Exp $
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintenance
|
||||
.\" of non-core utilities.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
.\" are met:
|
||||
.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" @(#)pkg_create.1
|
||||
.\" from FreeBSD Id: pkg_create.1,v 1.19 1997/05/02 22:00:05 max Exp
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" hacked up by John Kohl for NetBSD--fixed a few bugs, extended keywords,
|
||||
.\" added dependency tracking, etc.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" [jkh] Took John's changes back and made some additional extensions for
|
||||
.\" better integration with FreeBSD's new ports collection.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.Dd January 20, 2010
|
||||
.Dt PKG_CREATE 1
|
||||
.Os
|
||||
.Sh NAME
|
||||
.Nm pkg_create
|
||||
.Nd a utility for creating software package distributions
|
||||
.Sh SYNOPSIS
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
.Op Fl ElOUVv
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl B Ar build-info-file
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl b Ar build-version-file
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl C Ar cpkgs
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl D Ar displayfile
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl F Ar compression
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl g Ar group
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl I Ar realprefix
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl i Ar iscript
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl K Ar pkg_dbdir
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl k Ar dscript
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl n Ar preserve-file
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl P Ar dpkgs
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl T Ar buildpkgs
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl p Ar prefix
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl S Ar size-all-file
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl s Ar size-pkg-file
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl t Ar template
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Op Fl u Ar owner
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Fl c Ar comment
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Fl d Ar description
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Bk -words
|
||||
.Fl f Ar packlist
|
||||
.Ek
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name
|
||||
.Sh DESCRIPTION
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
command is used to create packages that will subsequently be fed to
|
||||
one of the package extraction/info utilities.
|
||||
The input description and command line arguments for the creation of a
|
||||
package are not really meant to be human-generated, though it is easy
|
||||
enough to do so.
|
||||
It is more expected that you will use a front-end tool for
|
||||
the job rather than muddling through it yourself.
|
||||
Nonetheless, a short description of the input syntax is included in this
|
||||
document.
|
||||
.Sh OPTIONS
|
||||
The following command line options are supported:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent
|
||||
.It Fl B Ar build-info-file
|
||||
Install the file
|
||||
.Ar build-info-file
|
||||
so that users of binary packages can see what
|
||||
.Xr make 1
|
||||
definitions
|
||||
were used to control the build when creating the
|
||||
binary package.
|
||||
This allows various build definitions to be retained in a binary package
|
||||
and viewed wherever it is installed, using
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1 .
|
||||
.It Fl b Ar build-version-file
|
||||
Install the file
|
||||
.Ar build-version-file
|
||||
so that users of binary packages can see what versions of
|
||||
the files used to control the build were used when creating the
|
||||
binary package.
|
||||
This allows some fine-grained version control information to be retained
|
||||
in a binary package and viewed wherever it is installed, using
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1 .
|
||||
.It Fl C Ar cpkgs
|
||||
Set the initial package conflict list to
|
||||
.Ar cpkgs .
|
||||
This is assumed to be a whitespace separated list of package names
|
||||
and is meant as a convenient shorthand for specifying multiple
|
||||
.Cm @pkgcfl
|
||||
directives in the packing list (see PACKING LIST DETAILS section below).
|
||||
.It Fl c Ar [-]desc
|
||||
Fetch package
|
||||
.Pq one line description
|
||||
from file
|
||||
.Ar desc
|
||||
or, if preceded by
|
||||
.Cm - ,
|
||||
the argument itself.
|
||||
This string should also give some idea of which version of the product
|
||||
(if any) the package represents.
|
||||
.It Fl D Ar displayfile
|
||||
Display the file after installing the package.
|
||||
Useful for things like legal notices on almost-free software, etc.
|
||||
.It Fl d Ar [-]desc
|
||||
Fetch long description for package from file
|
||||
.Ar desc
|
||||
or, if preceded by
|
||||
.Cm - ,
|
||||
the argument itself.
|
||||
.It Fl E
|
||||
Add an empty views file to the package.
|
||||
.It Fl F Ar compression
|
||||
Use
|
||||
.Ar compression
|
||||
as compression algorithm.
|
||||
This overrides the heuristic to guess the compression type from the
|
||||
output name.
|
||||
Currently supported values are bzip2, gzip, none and xz.
|
||||
.It Fl f Ar packlist
|
||||
Fetch
|
||||
.Pq packing list
|
||||
for package from the file
|
||||
.Ar packlist
|
||||
or
|
||||
.Cm stdin
|
||||
if
|
||||
.Ar packlist
|
||||
is a
|
||||
.Cm -
|
||||
(dash).
|
||||
.It Fl g Ar group
|
||||
Make
|
||||
.Ar group
|
||||
the default group ownership instead of extracting it from the file system.
|
||||
.It Fl I Ar realprefix
|
||||
Provide the real prefix, as opposed to the staging prefix, for use in
|
||||
staged installations of packages.
|
||||
.It Fl i Ar iscript
|
||||
Set
|
||||
.Ar iscript
|
||||
to be the install procedure for the package.
|
||||
This can be any executable program (or shell script).
|
||||
It will be invoked automatically when the package is later installed.
|
||||
.It Fl K Ar pkg_dbdir
|
||||
Override the value of the
|
||||
.Dv PKG_DBDIR
|
||||
configuration option with the value
|
||||
.Ar pkg_dbdir .
|
||||
.It Fl k Ar dscript
|
||||
Set
|
||||
.Ar dscript
|
||||
to be the de-install procedure for the package.
|
||||
This can be any executable program (or shell script).
|
||||
It will be invoked automatically
|
||||
when the package is later (if ever) de-installed.
|
||||
.It Fl l
|
||||
Check that any symbolic links which are to be placed in the package are
|
||||
relative to the current prefix.
|
||||
This means using
|
||||
.Xr unlink 2
|
||||
and
|
||||
.Xr symlink 2
|
||||
to remove and re-link
|
||||
any symbolic links which are targeted at full path names.
|
||||
.It Fl n Ar preserve-file
|
||||
The file is used to denote that the package should not be deleted.
|
||||
This is intended for use where the deletion of packages may present
|
||||
a bootstrap problem.
|
||||
.It Fl O
|
||||
Go into a
|
||||
.Pq packing list only
|
||||
mode.
|
||||
This is used to do
|
||||
.Pq fake pkg_add
|
||||
operations when a package is installed.
|
||||
In such cases, it is necessary to know what the final, adjusted packing
|
||||
list will look like.
|
||||
.It Fl P Ar dpkgs
|
||||
Set the initial package dependency list to
|
||||
.Ar dpkgs .
|
||||
This is assumed to be a whitespace separated list of package names
|
||||
and is meant as a convenient shorthand for specifying multiple
|
||||
.Cm @pkgdep
|
||||
directives in the packing list (see PACKING LIST DETAILS section below).
|
||||
In addition, the exact versions of the packages referred to in the
|
||||
.Ar dpkgs
|
||||
list will be added to the packing list in the form of
|
||||
.Cm @blddep
|
||||
directives.
|
||||
.It Fl T Ar buildpkgs
|
||||
The exact versions of the packages referred to in the
|
||||
.Ar buildpkgs
|
||||
list will be added to the packing list in the form of
|
||||
.Cm @blddep
|
||||
directives.
|
||||
This directives are stored after those created by the
|
||||
.Fl P
|
||||
option.
|
||||
.Ar buildpkgs
|
||||
is assumed to be a whitespace separated list of package names.
|
||||
.It Fl p Ar prefix
|
||||
Set
|
||||
.Ar prefix
|
||||
as the initial directory
|
||||
.Pq base
|
||||
to start from in selecting files for
|
||||
the package.
|
||||
.It Fl S Ar size-all-file
|
||||
Store the given file for later querying with the
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1
|
||||
.Fl S
|
||||
flag.
|
||||
The file is expected to contain the size (in bytes) of all files of
|
||||
this package plus any required packages added up and stored as a
|
||||
ASCII string, terminated by a newline.
|
||||
.It Fl s Ar size-pkg-file
|
||||
Store the given file for later querying with the
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1
|
||||
.Fl s
|
||||
flag.
|
||||
The file is expected to contain the size (in bytes) of all files of
|
||||
this package added up and stored as a ASCII string, terminated by a newline.
|
||||
.It Fl t Ar template
|
||||
Use
|
||||
.Ar template
|
||||
as the input to
|
||||
.Xr mktemp 3 .
|
||||
By default, this is the string
|
||||
.Pa /tmp/instmp.XXXXXX ,
|
||||
but it may be necessary to override it in the situation where
|
||||
space in your
|
||||
.Pa /tmp
|
||||
directory is limited.
|
||||
Be sure to leave some number of
|
||||
.Sq X
|
||||
characters for
|
||||
.Xr mktemp 3
|
||||
to fill in with a unique ID.
|
||||
.It Fl U
|
||||
Do not update the package file database with any file information.
|
||||
.It Fl u Ar owner
|
||||
Make
|
||||
.Ar owner
|
||||
the default owner instead of extracting it from the file system.
|
||||
.It Fl V
|
||||
Print version number and exit.
|
||||
.It Fl v
|
||||
Turn on verbose output.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Sh PACKING LIST DETAILS
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Pq packing list
|
||||
format (see
|
||||
.Fl f )
|
||||
is fairly simple, being
|
||||
nothing more than a single column of filenames to include in the
|
||||
package.
|
||||
However, since absolute pathnames are generally a bad idea
|
||||
for a package that could be installed potentially anywhere, there is
|
||||
another method of specifying where things are supposed to go
|
||||
and, optionally, what ownership and mode information they should be
|
||||
installed with.
|
||||
This is done by embedding specialized command sequences
|
||||
in the packing list.
|
||||
Briefly described, these sequences are:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent -compact
|
||||
.It Cm @cwd Ar directory
|
||||
Set the internal directory pointer to point to
|
||||
.Ar directory .
|
||||
All subsequent filenames will be assumed relative to this directory.
|
||||
Note:
|
||||
.Cm @cd
|
||||
is also an alias for this command.
|
||||
.It Cm @src Ar directory
|
||||
This command is supported for compatibility only.
|
||||
It was formerly used to override
|
||||
.Cm @cwd
|
||||
during package creation.
|
||||
.It Cm @exec Ar command
|
||||
Execute
|
||||
.Ar command
|
||||
as part of the unpacking process.
|
||||
If
|
||||
.Ar command
|
||||
contains any of the following sequences somewhere in it, they will
|
||||
be expanded inline.
|
||||
For the following examples, assume that
|
||||
.Cm @cwd
|
||||
is set to
|
||||
.Pa /usr/local
|
||||
and the last extracted file was
|
||||
.Pa bin/emacs .
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent -compact
|
||||
.It Cm "\&%F"
|
||||
Expands to the last filename extracted (as specified), in the example case
|
||||
.Pa bin/emacs
|
||||
.It Cm "\&%D"
|
||||
Expand to the current directory prefix, as set with
|
||||
.Cm @cwd ,
|
||||
in the example case
|
||||
.Pa /usr/local .
|
||||
.It Cm "\&%B"
|
||||
Expand to the
|
||||
.Pq basename
|
||||
of the fully qualified filename, that
|
||||
is the current directory prefix, plus the last filespec, minus
|
||||
the trailing filename.
|
||||
In the example case, that would be
|
||||
.Pa /usr/local/bin .
|
||||
.It Cm "\&%f"
|
||||
Expand to the
|
||||
.Pq filename
|
||||
part of the fully qualified name, or
|
||||
the converse of
|
||||
.Cm \&%B ,
|
||||
being in the example case,
|
||||
.Pa emacs .
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.It Cm @unexec Ar command
|
||||
Execute
|
||||
.Ar command
|
||||
as part of the deinstallation process.
|
||||
Expansion of special
|
||||
.Cm \&%
|
||||
sequences is the same as for
|
||||
.Cm @exec .
|
||||
This command is not executed during the package add, as
|
||||
.Cm @exec
|
||||
is, but rather when the package is deleted.
|
||||
This is useful for deleting links and other ancillary files that were created
|
||||
as a result of adding the package, but not directly known to the package's
|
||||
table of contents (and hence not automatically removable).
|
||||
The advantage of using
|
||||
.Cm @unexec
|
||||
over a deinstallation script is that you can use the
|
||||
.Pq special sequence expansion
|
||||
to get at files regardless of where they've
|
||||
been potentially redirected (see
|
||||
.Fl p ) .
|
||||
.It Cm @mode Ar mode
|
||||
Set default permission for all subsequently extracted files to
|
||||
.Ar mode .
|
||||
Format is the same as that used by the
|
||||
.Cm chmod
|
||||
command (well, considering that it's later handed off to it, that's
|
||||
no surprise).
|
||||
Use without an arg to set back to default (extraction) permissions.
|
||||
.It Cm @option Ar option
|
||||
Set internal package options, the only currently supported one
|
||||
being
|
||||
.Ar preserve ,
|
||||
which tells pkg_add to move any existing files out of the way,
|
||||
preserving the previous contents (which are also resurrected on
|
||||
pkg_delete, so caveat emptor).
|
||||
.It Cm @owner Ar user
|
||||
Set default ownership for all subsequently extracted files to
|
||||
.Ar user .
|
||||
Use without an arg to set back to default (extraction)
|
||||
ownership.
|
||||
.It Cm @group Ar group
|
||||
Set default group ownership for all subsequently extracted files to
|
||||
.Ar group .
|
||||
Use without an arg to set back to default (extraction)
|
||||
group ownership.
|
||||
.It Cm @comment Ar string
|
||||
Embed a comment in the packing list.
|
||||
Useful in trying to document some particularly hairy sequence that
|
||||
may trip someone up later.
|
||||
.It Cm @ignore
|
||||
Used internally to tell extraction to ignore the next file (don't
|
||||
copy it anywhere), as it's used for some special purpose.
|
||||
.It Cm @name Ar name
|
||||
Set the name of the package.
|
||||
This is mandatory and is usually put at the top.
|
||||
This name is potentially different than the name of the file it came in,
|
||||
and is used when keeping track of the package for later deinstallation.
|
||||
Note that
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
will derive this field from the
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name
|
||||
and add it automatically if none is given.
|
||||
.It Cm @pkgdir Ar name
|
||||
Declare directory
|
||||
.Pa name
|
||||
as managed.
|
||||
If it does not exist at installation time, it is created.
|
||||
If this directory is no longer referenced by packages and the last
|
||||
file or directory in it is deleted, the directory is removed as well.
|
||||
.It Cm @dirrm Ar name
|
||||
This command is supported for compatibility only.
|
||||
If directory
|
||||
.Pa name
|
||||
exists, it will be deleted at deinstall time.
|
||||
.It Cm @display Ar name
|
||||
Declare
|
||||
.Pa name
|
||||
as the file to be displayed at install time (see
|
||||
.Fl D
|
||||
above).
|
||||
.It Cm @pkgdep Ar pkgname
|
||||
Declare a dependency on the
|
||||
.Ar pkgname
|
||||
package.
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Ar pkgname
|
||||
package must be installed before this package may be
|
||||
installed, and this package must be deinstalled before the
|
||||
.Ar pkgname
|
||||
package is deinstalled.
|
||||
Multiple
|
||||
.Cm @pkgdep
|
||||
directives may be used if the package depends on multiple other packages.
|
||||
.It Cm @blddep Ar pkgname
|
||||
Declare that this package was built with the exact version
|
||||
of
|
||||
.Ar pkgname
|
||||
(since the
|
||||
.Cm @pkgdep
|
||||
directive may contain wildcards or relational
|
||||
package version information).
|
||||
.It Cm @pkgcfl Ar pkgcflname
|
||||
Declare a conflict with the
|
||||
.Ar pkgcflname
|
||||
package, as the two packages contain references to the same files,
|
||||
and so cannot co-exist on the same system.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Sh ENVIRONMENT
|
||||
See
|
||||
.Xr pkg_install.conf 5
|
||||
for options, that can also be specified using the environment.
|
||||
.Sh SEE ALSO
|
||||
.Xr pkg_add 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_admin 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_delete 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_install.conf 5
|
||||
.Xr pkgsrc 7
|
||||
.Sh HISTORY
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
command first appeared in
|
||||
.Fx .
|
||||
.Sh AUTHORS
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent -compact
|
||||
.It Jordan Hubbard
|
||||
most of the work
|
||||
.It John Kohl
|
||||
refined it for
|
||||
.Nx
|
||||
.It Hubert Feyrer
|
||||
.Nx
|
||||
wildcard dependency processing, pkgdb, pkg size recording etc.
|
||||
.El
|
211
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/pl.c
vendored
Normal file
211
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/pl.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,211 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: pl.c,v 1.1.1.4 2009/11/05 18:39:03 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: pl.c,v 1.1.1.4 2009/11/05 18:39:03 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Routines for dealing with the packing list.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
#include "create.h"
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef NETBSD
|
||||
#include <nbcompat/md5.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#include <md5.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Check that any symbolic link is relative to the prefix
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void
|
||||
CheckSymlink(char *name, char *prefix, size_t prefixcc)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char newtgt[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
char oldtgt[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
char *slash;
|
||||
int slashc;
|
||||
int cc;
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((cc = readlink(name, oldtgt, sizeof(oldtgt) - 1)) > 0) {
|
||||
oldtgt[cc] = 0;
|
||||
if (strncmp(oldtgt, prefix, prefixcc) == 0 && oldtgt[prefixcc] == '/') {
|
||||
for (slashc = 0, slash = &name[prefixcc + 1]; (slash = strchr(slash, '/')) != (char *) NULL; slash++, slashc++) {
|
||||
}
|
||||
for (cc = i = 0; i < slashc; i++) {
|
||||
strlcpy(&newtgt[cc], "../", sizeof(newtgt) - cc);
|
||||
cc += 3;
|
||||
}
|
||||
strlcpy(&newtgt[cc], &oldtgt[prefixcc + 1], sizeof(newtgt) - cc);
|
||||
(void) fprintf(stderr, "Full pathname symlink `%s' is target of `%s' - adjusting to `%s'\n", oldtgt, name, newtgt);
|
||||
if (unlink(name) != 0) {
|
||||
warn("can't unlink `%s'", name);
|
||||
} else if (symlink(newtgt, name) != 0) {
|
||||
warn("can't symlink `%s' called `%s'", newtgt, name);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Check a list for files that require preconversion
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
check_list(package_t *pkg, const char *PkgName)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct stat st;
|
||||
plist_t *tmp;
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
char buf[ChecksumHeaderLen + LegibleChecksumLen];
|
||||
char target[MaxPathSize + SymlinkHeaderLen];
|
||||
char name[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
char *cwd = NULL;
|
||||
char *pkgname = NULL;
|
||||
int cc;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Open Package Database for writing */
|
||||
if (update_pkgdb && !pkgdb_open(ReadWrite))
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "can't open pkgdb");
|
||||
|
||||
for (p = pkg->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
switch (p->type) {
|
||||
case PLIST_CWD:
|
||||
cwd = p->name;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_NAME:
|
||||
pkgname = p->name;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_IGNORE:
|
||||
p = p->next;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGDIR:
|
||||
if (cwd == NULL)
|
||||
errx(2, "@pkgdir without preceding @cwd found");
|
||||
if (pkgname == NULL)
|
||||
errx(2, "@pkgdir without preceding @name found");
|
||||
if (update_pkgdb) {
|
||||
add_pkgdir(pkgname, cwd, p->name);
|
||||
/* mkdir_p(cwd, p->name); */
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_FILE:
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* pkgdb handling - usually, we enter files
|
||||
* into the pkgdb as soon as they hit the disk,
|
||||
* but as they are present before pkg_create
|
||||
* starts, it's ok to do this somewhere here
|
||||
*/
|
||||
if (cwd == NULL)
|
||||
errx(2, "file without preceding @cwd found");
|
||||
if (update_pkgdb) {
|
||||
char *s, t[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
|
||||
(void) snprintf(t, sizeof(t), "%s%s%s",
|
||||
cwd,
|
||||
(strcmp(cwd, "/") == 0) ? "" : "/",
|
||||
p->name);
|
||||
|
||||
s = pkgdb_retrieve(t);
|
||||
if (s && PlistOnly)
|
||||
warnx("Overwriting %s - "
|
||||
"pkg %s bogus/conflicting?", t, s);
|
||||
else {
|
||||
pkgdb_store(t, PkgName);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* prepend DESTDIR if set? - HF */
|
||||
(void) snprintf(name, sizeof(name), "%s%s%s",
|
||||
cwd,
|
||||
(strcmp(cwd, "/") == 0) ? "" : "/",
|
||||
p->name);
|
||||
if (lstat(name, &st) < 0) {
|
||||
warnx("can't stat `%s'", name);
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
switch (st.st_mode & S_IFMT) {
|
||||
case S_IFDIR:
|
||||
warnx("Warning - directory `%s' in PLIST", name);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case S_IFLNK:
|
||||
if (RelativeLinks) {
|
||||
CheckSymlink(name, cwd, strlen(cwd));
|
||||
}
|
||||
(void) strlcpy(target, SYMLINK_HEADER,
|
||||
sizeof(target));
|
||||
if ((cc = readlink(name, &target[SymlinkHeaderLen],
|
||||
sizeof(target) - SymlinkHeaderLen - 1)) < 0) {
|
||||
warnx("can't readlink `%s'", name);
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
target[SymlinkHeaderLen + cc] = 0x0;
|
||||
tmp = new_plist_entry();
|
||||
tmp->name = xstrdup(target);
|
||||
tmp->type = PLIST_COMMENT;
|
||||
tmp->next = p->next;
|
||||
tmp->prev = p;
|
||||
if (p == pkg->tail) {
|
||||
pkg->tail = tmp;
|
||||
}
|
||||
p->next = tmp;
|
||||
p = tmp;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case S_IFCHR:
|
||||
warnx("Warning - char special device `%s' in PLIST", name);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case S_IFBLK:
|
||||
warnx("Warning - block special device `%s' in PLIST", name);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
(void) strlcpy(buf, CHECKSUM_HEADER,
|
||||
sizeof(buf));
|
||||
if (MD5File(name, &buf[ChecksumHeaderLen]) != (char *) NULL) {
|
||||
tmp = new_plist_entry();
|
||||
tmp->name = xstrdup(buf);
|
||||
tmp->type = PLIST_COMMENT; /* PLIST_MD5 - HF */
|
||||
tmp->next = p->next;
|
||||
tmp->prev = p;
|
||||
if (p == pkg->tail) {
|
||||
pkg->tail = tmp;
|
||||
}
|
||||
p->next = tmp;
|
||||
p = tmp;
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (update_pkgdb) {
|
||||
pkgdb_close();
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
163
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/util.c
vendored
Normal file
163
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/create/util.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,163 @@
|
|||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2007 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_STAT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/stat.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_PWD_H
|
||||
#include <grp.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_PWD_H
|
||||
#include <pwd.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_TIME_H
|
||||
#include <time.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_UNISTD_H
|
||||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_FCNTL_H
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
#include "create.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
update_ids(struct memory_file *file)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (file->owner != NULL) {
|
||||
uid_t uid;
|
||||
|
||||
if (uid_from_user(file->owner, &uid) == -1)
|
||||
errx(2, "user %s unknown", file->owner);
|
||||
file->st.st_uid = uid;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
file->owner = user_from_uid(file->st.st_uid, 1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (file->group != NULL) {
|
||||
gid_t gid;
|
||||
|
||||
if (gid_from_group(file->group, &gid) == -1)
|
||||
errx(2, "group %s unknown", file->group);
|
||||
file->group = file->group;
|
||||
file->st.st_gid = gid;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
file->group = group_from_gid(file->st.st_gid, 1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct memory_file *
|
||||
make_memory_file(const char *archive_name, void *data, size_t len,
|
||||
const char *owner, const char *group, mode_t mode)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct memory_file *file;
|
||||
|
||||
file = xmalloc(sizeof(*file));
|
||||
file->name = archive_name;
|
||||
file->owner = owner;
|
||||
file->group = group;
|
||||
file->data = data;
|
||||
file->len = len;
|
||||
|
||||
memset(&file->st, 0, sizeof(file->st));
|
||||
|
||||
file->st.st_atime = file->st.st_ctime = file->st.st_mtime = time(NULL);
|
||||
|
||||
file->st.st_nlink = 1;
|
||||
file->st.st_size = len;
|
||||
file->st.st_mode = mode | S_IFREG;
|
||||
|
||||
update_ids(file);
|
||||
|
||||
return file;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct memory_file *
|
||||
load_memory_file(const char *disk_name,
|
||||
const char *archive_name, const char *owner, const char *group,
|
||||
mode_t mode)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct memory_file *file;
|
||||
int fd;
|
||||
|
||||
file = xmalloc(sizeof(*file));
|
||||
file->name = archive_name;
|
||||
file->owner = owner;
|
||||
file->group = group;
|
||||
file->mode = mode;
|
||||
|
||||
fd = open(disk_name, O_RDONLY);
|
||||
if (fd == -1)
|
||||
err(2, "cannot open file %s", disk_name);
|
||||
if (fstat(fd, &file->st) == -1)
|
||||
err(2, "cannot stat file %s", disk_name);
|
||||
|
||||
update_ids(file);
|
||||
|
||||
if ((file->st.st_mode & S_IFMT) != S_IFREG)
|
||||
errx(1, "meta data file %s is not regular file", disk_name);
|
||||
if (file->st.st_size > SSIZE_MAX)
|
||||
errx(2, "meta data file too large: %s", disk_name);
|
||||
file->data = xmalloc(file->st.st_size);
|
||||
|
||||
if (read(fd, file->data, file->st.st_size) != file->st.st_size)
|
||||
err(2, "cannot read file into memory %s", disk_name);
|
||||
|
||||
file->len = file->st.st_size;
|
||||
|
||||
close(fd);
|
||||
|
||||
return file;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
free_memory_file(struct memory_file *file)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (file != NULL) {
|
||||
free(file->data);
|
||||
free(file);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
300
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/delete/pkg_delete.1
vendored
Normal file
300
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/delete/pkg_delete.1
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,300 @@
|
|||
.\" $NetBSD: pkg_delete.1,v 1.1.1.8 2010/04/23 20:54:08 joerg Exp $
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintenance
|
||||
.\" of non-core utilities.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
.\" are met:
|
||||
.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" from FreeBSD: @(#)pkg_delete.1
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.Dd January 20, 2010
|
||||
.Dt PKG_DELETE 1
|
||||
.Os
|
||||
.Sh NAME
|
||||
.Nm pkg_delete
|
||||
.Nd a utility for deleting previously installed software package distributions
|
||||
.Sh SYNOPSIS
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
.Op Fl ADFfkNnORrVv
|
||||
.Op Fl K Ar pkg_dbdir
|
||||
.Op Fl P Ar destdir
|
||||
.Op Fl p Ar prefix
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name ...
|
||||
.Sh DESCRIPTION
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
command is used to delete packages that have been previously installed
|
||||
with the
|
||||
.Xr pkg_add 1
|
||||
command.
|
||||
The given packages are sorted, so that the dependencies needed by a
|
||||
package are deleted after the package.
|
||||
Before any action is executed,
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
checks for packages that are marked as
|
||||
.Cm preserved
|
||||
or have depending packages left.
|
||||
If the
|
||||
.Fl k
|
||||
flag is given, preserved packages are skipped and not removed.
|
||||
Unless the
|
||||
.Fl f
|
||||
flag is given,
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
stops on the first error.
|
||||
.Sh WARNING
|
||||
.Bf -emphasis
|
||||
Since the
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
command may execute scripts or programs provided by a package file,
|
||||
your system may be susceptible to
|
||||
.Dq Trojan horses
|
||||
or other subtle
|
||||
attacks from miscreants who create dangerous package files.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
You are advised to verify the competence and identity of those who
|
||||
provide installable package files.
|
||||
For extra protection, examine all the package control files in the
|
||||
package record directory
|
||||
.Pa \*[Lt]PKG_DBDIR\*[Gt]/\*[Lt]pkg-name\*[Gt]/ ) .
|
||||
Pay particular
|
||||
attention to any
|
||||
.Pa +INSTALL
|
||||
or
|
||||
.Pa +DEINSTALL
|
||||
files, and inspect the
|
||||
.Pa +CONTENTS
|
||||
file for
|
||||
.Cm @cwd ,
|
||||
.Cm @mode
|
||||
(check for setuid),
|
||||
.Cm @dirrm ,
|
||||
.Cm @exec ,
|
||||
and
|
||||
.Cm @unexec
|
||||
directives, and/or use the
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1
|
||||
command to examine the installed package control files.
|
||||
.Ef
|
||||
.Sh OPTIONS
|
||||
The following command line options are supported:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent
|
||||
.It Ar pkg-name ...
|
||||
The named packages are deinstalled, wildcards can be used, see
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1 .
|
||||
If no version is given, the one currently installed
|
||||
will be removed.
|
||||
If the
|
||||
.Fl F
|
||||
flag is given, one or more (absolute) filenames may be specified and
|
||||
the package database will be consulted for the package to which the
|
||||
given file belongs.
|
||||
These packages are then deinstalled.
|
||||
.It Fl A
|
||||
Recursively remove all automatically installed packages that were needed
|
||||
by the given packages and are no longer required.
|
||||
Does not remove manually installed packages; see also the
|
||||
.Fl R
|
||||
flag.
|
||||
.It Fl D
|
||||
If a deinstallation script exists for a given package, do not execute it.
|
||||
.It Fl F
|
||||
Any
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name
|
||||
given will be interpreted as pathname which is
|
||||
subsequently transformed in a (real) package name via the package
|
||||
database.
|
||||
That way, packages can be deleted by giving a filename
|
||||
instead of the package-name.
|
||||
.It Fl f
|
||||
Force removal of the package, even if a dependency is recorded or the
|
||||
deinstall script fails.
|
||||
This might break the package database; see
|
||||
.Xr pkg_admin 1
|
||||
on how to repair it.
|
||||
.It Fl ff
|
||||
Force removal of the package, even if the package is marked as a
|
||||
.Cm preserved
|
||||
package.
|
||||
Note that this is a dangerous operation.
|
||||
See also the
|
||||
.Fl k
|
||||
option.
|
||||
.It Fl K Ar pkg_dbdir
|
||||
Override the value of the
|
||||
.Dv PKG_DBDIR
|
||||
configuration option with the value
|
||||
.Ar pkg_dbdir .
|
||||
.It Fl k
|
||||
Silently skip all packages that are marked as
|
||||
.Cm preserved .
|
||||
.It Fl N
|
||||
Remove the package's registration and its entries from the package database,
|
||||
but leave the files installed.
|
||||
Don't run any deinstall scripts or
|
||||
.Cm @unexec
|
||||
lines either.
|
||||
.It Fl n
|
||||
Don't actually deinstall a package, just report the steps that
|
||||
would be taken.
|
||||
.It Fl O
|
||||
Only delete the package's entries from the package database; do not
|
||||
touch the package or its files itself.
|
||||
.It Fl P Ar destdir
|
||||
Prefix all file and directory names with
|
||||
.Ar destdir .
|
||||
For packages without install scripts this has the same behavior as
|
||||
using
|
||||
.Xr chroot 8 .
|
||||
.It Fl p Ar prefix
|
||||
Set
|
||||
.Ar prefix
|
||||
as the directory in which to delete files from any installed packages
|
||||
which do not explicitly set theirs.
|
||||
For most packages, the prefix will
|
||||
be set automatically to the installed location by
|
||||
.Xr pkg_add 1 .
|
||||
.It Fl R
|
||||
Recursively remove all packages that were needed by the given packages
|
||||
and are no longer required.
|
||||
This option overrides the
|
||||
.Fl A
|
||||
flag.
|
||||
.It Fl r
|
||||
Recursively remove all packages that require one of the packages given.
|
||||
.It Fl V
|
||||
Print version number and exit.
|
||||
.It Fl v
|
||||
Turn on verbose output.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Sh TECHNICAL DETAILS
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
does pretty much what it says.
|
||||
It examines installed package records in
|
||||
.Pa \*[Lt]PKG_DBDIR\*[Gt]/\*[Lt]pkg-name\*[Gt] ,
|
||||
deletes the package contents, and finally removes the package records.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
If a package is required by other installed packages,
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
will list those dependent packages and refuse to delete the package
|
||||
(unless the
|
||||
.Fl f
|
||||
option is given).
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
If a package has been marked as a
|
||||
.Cm preserved
|
||||
package, it will not be able to be deleted
|
||||
(unless more than one occurrence of the
|
||||
.Fl f
|
||||
option is given).
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
If a filename is given instead of a package name, the package of which
|
||||
the given file belongs to can be deleted if the
|
||||
.Fl F
|
||||
flag is given.
|
||||
The filename needs to be absolute, see the output produced by the
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1
|
||||
.Fl aF
|
||||
command.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
If a
|
||||
.Cm deinstall
|
||||
script exists for the package, it is executed before and after
|
||||
any files are removed.
|
||||
It is this script's responsibility to clean up any additional messy details
|
||||
around the package's installation, since all
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
knows how to do is delete the files created in the original distribution.
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Ic deinstall
|
||||
script is called as:
|
||||
.Bd -filled -offset indent -compact
|
||||
.Cm deinstall
|
||||
.Aq Ar pkg-name
|
||||
.Ar VIEW-DEINSTALL
|
||||
.Ed
|
||||
before removing the package from a view, and as:
|
||||
.Bd -filled -offset indent -compact
|
||||
.Cm deinstall
|
||||
.Aq Ar pkg-name
|
||||
.Ar DEINSTALL
|
||||
.Ed
|
||||
before deleting all files and as:
|
||||
.Bd -filled -offset indent -compact
|
||||
.Cm deinstall
|
||||
.Aq Ar pkg-name
|
||||
.Ar POST-DEINSTALL
|
||||
.Ed
|
||||
after deleting them.
|
||||
Passing the keywords
|
||||
.Ar VIEW-DEINSTALL ,
|
||||
.Ar DEINSTALL ,
|
||||
and
|
||||
.Ar POST-DEINSTALL
|
||||
lets you potentially write only one program/script that handles all
|
||||
aspects of installation and deletion.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
All scripts are called with the environment variable
|
||||
.Ev PKG_PREFIX
|
||||
set to the installation prefix (see the
|
||||
.Fl p
|
||||
option above).
|
||||
This allows a package author to write a script
|
||||
that reliably performs some action on the directory where the package
|
||||
is installed, even if the user might have changed it by specifying the
|
||||
.Fl p
|
||||
option when running
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
or
|
||||
.Xr pkg_add 1 .
|
||||
The scripts are also called with the
|
||||
.Ev PKG_METADATA_DIR
|
||||
environment variable set to the location of the
|
||||
.Pa +*
|
||||
meta-data files, and with the
|
||||
.Ev PKG_REFCOUNT_DBDIR
|
||||
environment variable set to the location of the package reference counts
|
||||
database directory.
|
||||
If the
|
||||
.Fl P
|
||||
flag was given to
|
||||
.Nm ,
|
||||
.Ev PKG_DESTDIR
|
||||
will be set to
|
||||
.Ar destdir .
|
||||
.Sh ENVIRONMENT
|
||||
See
|
||||
.Xr pkg_install.conf 5
|
||||
for options, that can also be specified using the environment.
|
||||
.Sh SEE ALSO
|
||||
.Xr pkg_add 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_admin 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_create 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_install.conf 5
|
||||
.Xr pkgsrc 7
|
||||
.Sh AUTHORS
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent -compact
|
||||
.It "Jordan Hubbard"
|
||||
most of the work
|
||||
.It "John Kohl"
|
||||
refined it for
|
||||
.Nx
|
||||
.It "Hubert Feyrer"
|
||||
.Nx
|
||||
wildcard dependency processing, pkgdb, recursive "down"
|
||||
delete, etc.
|
||||
.It Joerg Sonnenberger
|
||||
Rewrote most of the code to compute correct order of deinstallation
|
||||
and to improve error handling.
|
||||
.El
|
928
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/delete/pkg_delete.c
vendored
Normal file
928
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/delete/pkg_delete.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,928 @@
|
|||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2009 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2003 Johnny Lam <jlam@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: pkg_delete.c,v 1.1.1.8 2012/02/19 17:46:46 tron Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static const char *pkgdb;
|
||||
static const char *destdir;
|
||||
static const char *prefix;
|
||||
|
||||
static int keep_preserve;
|
||||
static int no_deinstall;
|
||||
static int find_by_filename;
|
||||
static int unregister_only;
|
||||
static int pkgdb_update_only;
|
||||
static int delete_recursive;
|
||||
static int delete_new_leaves;
|
||||
static int delete_automatic_leaves;
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
usage(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
fprintf(stderr, "usage: pkg_delete [-DFfkNnORrVv] [-K pkg_dbdir]"
|
||||
" [-P destdir] [-p prefix] pkg-name ...\n");
|
||||
exit(1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
add_by_filename(lpkg_head_t *pkgs, const char *filename)
|
||||
{
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp;
|
||||
char *s;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((s = pkgdb_retrieve(filename)) == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("No matching package for file `%s' in pkgdb", filename);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* XXX Verify that pkgdb is consistent? Trust it for now... */
|
||||
|
||||
lpp = alloc_lpkg(s);
|
||||
TAILQ_INSERT_TAIL(pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
add_by_pattern(lpkg_head_t *pkgs, const char *pattern)
|
||||
{
|
||||
switch (add_installed_pkgs_by_pattern(pattern, pkgs)) {
|
||||
case 0:
|
||||
warnx("No package matching `%s' found", pattern);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
case -1:
|
||||
warnx("Error while iterating package database for `%s'",
|
||||
pattern);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* The argument is either a fixed package name or an absolute path.
|
||||
* The latter is recognized for legacy compatibility and must point
|
||||
* into the package database.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
add_by_pkgname(lpkg_head_t *pkgs, char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *s;
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp;
|
||||
size_t l;
|
||||
const char *orig_pkg = pkg;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkg[0] == '/') {
|
||||
l = strlen(pkgdb);
|
||||
if (strncmp(pkg, pkgdb, l) || pkg[l] != '/') {
|
||||
warnx("Absolute path is not relative to "
|
||||
"package database, skipping: %s", pkg);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
pkg += l + 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
l = strcspn(pkg, "/");
|
||||
if (pkg[l + strspn(pkg + l, "/")] != '\0') {
|
||||
warnx("`%s' is not a package name, skipping", orig_pkg);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
pkg[l] = '\0';
|
||||
|
||||
s = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, CONTENTS_FNAME);
|
||||
if (fexists(s)) {
|
||||
free(s);
|
||||
lpp = alloc_lpkg(pkg);
|
||||
TAILQ_INSERT_TAIL(pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(s);
|
||||
|
||||
switch (add_installed_pkgs_by_basename(pkg, pkgs)) {
|
||||
case 0:
|
||||
warnx("No matching package for basename `%s' of `%s'",
|
||||
pkg, orig_pkg);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
case -1:
|
||||
warnx("Error expanding basename `%s' of `%s'",
|
||||
pkg, orig_pkg);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Evaluate +REQUIRED_BY. This function is used for four different
|
||||
* tasks:
|
||||
* 0: check if no depending packages remain
|
||||
* 1: like 0, but prepend the depending packages to pkgs if they exist
|
||||
* 2: print remaining packages to stderr
|
||||
* 3: check all and at least one depending packages have been removed
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
process_required_by(const char *pkg, lpkg_head_t *pkgs,
|
||||
lpkg_head_t *sorted_pkgs, int action)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char line[MaxPathSize], *eol, *fname;
|
||||
FILE *fp;
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp;
|
||||
int got_match, got_miss;
|
||||
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, REQUIRED_BY_FNAME);
|
||||
if (!fexists(fname)) {
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if ((fp = fopen(fname, "r")) == NULL) {
|
||||
warn("Failed to open `%s'", fname);
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
|
||||
got_match = 0;
|
||||
got_miss = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
while (fgets(line, sizeof(line), fp)) {
|
||||
if ((eol = strrchr(line, '\n')) != NULL)
|
||||
*eol = '\0';
|
||||
TAILQ_FOREACH(lpp, sorted_pkgs, lp_link) {
|
||||
if (strcmp(lpp->lp_name, line) == 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (lpp != NULL) {
|
||||
got_match = 1;
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
got_miss = 1;
|
||||
if (pkgs) {
|
||||
TAILQ_FOREACH(lpp, pkgs, lp_link) {
|
||||
if (strcmp(lpp->lp_name, line) == 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (lpp != NULL)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
switch (action) {
|
||||
case 0:
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
case 1:
|
||||
lpp = alloc_lpkg(line);
|
||||
TAILQ_INSERT_HEAD(pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 2:
|
||||
fprintf(stderr, "\t%s\n", line);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 3:
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
|
||||
return (action == 3 ? got_match : got_miss);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Main function to order the patterns from the command line and
|
||||
* add the subtrees for -r processing as needed.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The first part ensures that all packages are listed at most once
|
||||
* in pkgs. Afterwards the list is scanned for packages without depending
|
||||
* packages. Each such package is moved to sorted_pkgs in order.
|
||||
* If -r is given, all dependencies are inserted at the head of pkgs.
|
||||
* The loop has to continue as long as progress is made. This can happen
|
||||
* either because another package has been added to pkgs due to recursion
|
||||
* (head of pkgs changed) or because a package has no more depending packages
|
||||
* (tail of sorted_pkgs changed).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If no progress is made, the remaining packages are moved to sorted_pkgs
|
||||
* and an error is returned for the !Force case.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
sort_and_recurse(lpkg_head_t *pkgs, lpkg_head_t *sorted_pkgs)
|
||||
{
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp, *lpp2, *lpp_next, *lpp_old_tail, *lpp_old_head;
|
||||
int rv;
|
||||
|
||||
TAILQ_FOREACH_SAFE(lpp, pkgs, lp_link, lpp_next) {
|
||||
TAILQ_FOREACH(lpp2, pkgs, lp_link) {
|
||||
if (lpp != lpp2 &&
|
||||
strcmp(lpp->lp_name, lpp2->lp_name) == 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (lpp2 == NULL)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
TAILQ_REMOVE(pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
free_lpkg(lpp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
while (!TAILQ_EMPTY(pkgs)) {
|
||||
lpp_old_tail = TAILQ_LAST(sorted_pkgs, _lpkg_head_t);
|
||||
lpp_old_head = TAILQ_FIRST(pkgs);
|
||||
|
||||
TAILQ_FOREACH_SAFE(lpp, pkgs, lp_link, lpp_next) {
|
||||
rv = process_required_by(lpp->lp_name, pkgs,
|
||||
sorted_pkgs, delete_recursive ? 1 : 0);
|
||||
if (rv)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
TAILQ_REMOVE(pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
TAILQ_INSERT_TAIL(sorted_pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (lpp_old_tail == TAILQ_LAST(sorted_pkgs, _lpkg_head_t) &&
|
||||
lpp_old_head == TAILQ_FIRST(pkgs))
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (TAILQ_EMPTY(pkgs))
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
while (!TAILQ_EMPTY(pkgs)) {
|
||||
lpp = TAILQ_FIRST(pkgs);
|
||||
TAILQ_REMOVE(pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
fprintf(stderr,
|
||||
"Package `%s' is still required by other packages:\n",
|
||||
lpp->lp_name);
|
||||
process_required_by(lpp->lp_name, NULL, sorted_pkgs, 2);
|
||||
if (Force) {
|
||||
TAILQ_INSERT_TAIL(sorted_pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
} else
|
||||
free_lpkg(lpp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return !Force;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct find_leaves_data {
|
||||
lpkg_head_t *pkgs;
|
||||
int progress;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Iterator for finding leaf packages.
|
||||
* Packages that are marked as not for deletion are not considered as
|
||||
* leaves. For all other packages it is checked if at least one package
|
||||
* that depended on them is to be removed AND no depending package remains.
|
||||
* If that is the case, the package is appended to the sorted list.
|
||||
* As this package can't have depending packages left, the topological order
|
||||
* remains consistent.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
find_new_leaves_iter(const char *pkg, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *fname;
|
||||
struct find_leaves_data *data = cookie;
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp;
|
||||
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, PRESERVE_FNAME);
|
||||
if (fexists(fname)) {
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
|
||||
if (delete_automatic_leaves && !delete_new_leaves &&
|
||||
!is_automatic_installed(pkg))
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Check whether this package is already on the list first. */
|
||||
TAILQ_FOREACH(lpp, data->pkgs, lp_link) {
|
||||
if (strcmp(lpp->lp_name, pkg) == 0)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (process_required_by(pkg, NULL, data->pkgs, 3) == 1) {
|
||||
lpp = alloc_lpkg(pkg);
|
||||
TAILQ_INSERT_TAIL(data->pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
data->progress = 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Iterate over all installed packages and look for new leaf packages.
|
||||
* As long as the loop adds one new leaf package, processing continues.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void
|
||||
find_new_leaves(lpkg_head_t *pkgs)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct find_leaves_data data;
|
||||
|
||||
data.pkgs = pkgs;
|
||||
do {
|
||||
data.progress = 0;
|
||||
iterate_pkg_db(find_new_leaves_iter, &data);
|
||||
} while (data.progress);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Check that no entry on the package list is marked as not for deletion.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
find_preserve_pkgs(lpkg_head_t *pkgs)
|
||||
{
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp, *lpp_next;
|
||||
char *fname;
|
||||
int found_preserve;
|
||||
|
||||
found_preserve = 0;
|
||||
TAILQ_FOREACH_SAFE(lpp, pkgs, lp_link, lpp_next) {
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(lpp->lp_name, PRESERVE_FNAME);
|
||||
if (!fexists(fname)) {
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
if (keep_preserve) {
|
||||
TAILQ_REMOVE(pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
free_lpkg(lpp);
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (!found_preserve)
|
||||
warnx("The following packages are marked as not "
|
||||
"for deletion:");
|
||||
found_preserve = 1;
|
||||
fprintf(stderr, "\t%s\n", lpp->lp_name);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (!found_preserve)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
if (Force == 0 || (!unregister_only && Force == 1))
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
fprintf(stderr, "...but will delete them anyway\n");
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Remove package from view. This is calling pkg_deinstall again.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
remove_pkg_from_view(const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char line[MaxPathSize], *fname, *eol;
|
||||
FILE *fp;
|
||||
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, VIEWS_FNAME);
|
||||
if (isemptyfile(fname)) {
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((fp = fopen(fname, "r")) == NULL) {
|
||||
warn("Unable to open `%s', aborting", fname);
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
while (fgets(line, sizeof(line), fp) != NULL) {
|
||||
if ((eol = strrchr(line, '\n')) != NULL)
|
||||
*eol = '\0';
|
||||
if (Verbose || Fake)
|
||||
printf("Deleting package `%s' instance from `%s' view\n",
|
||||
pkg, line);
|
||||
if (Fake)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (fexec_skipempty(BINDIR "/pkg_delete", "-K", line,
|
||||
Fake ? "-n" : "",
|
||||
(Force > 1) ? "-f" : "",
|
||||
(Force > 0) ? "-f" : "",
|
||||
pkg, NULL) != 0) {
|
||||
warnx("Unable to delete package `%s' from view `%s'",
|
||||
pkg, line);
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Run the +DEINSTALL script. Depending on whether this is
|
||||
* a depoted package and whether this pre- or post-deinstall phase,
|
||||
* different arguments are passed down.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
run_deinstall_script(const char *pkg, int do_postdeinstall)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *target, *text;
|
||||
char *fname, *fname2, *pkgdir;
|
||||
int rv;
|
||||
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, DEINSTALL_FNAME);
|
||||
if (!fexists(fname)) {
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
fname2 = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, DEPOT_FNAME);
|
||||
if (fexists(fname2)) {
|
||||
if (do_postdeinstall) {
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
free(fname2);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
target = "VIEW-DEINSTALL";
|
||||
text = "view deinstall";
|
||||
} else if (do_postdeinstall) {
|
||||
target = "POST-DEINSTALL";
|
||||
text = "post-deinstall";
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
target = "DEINSTALL";
|
||||
text = "deinstall";
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(fname2);
|
||||
|
||||
if (Fake) {
|
||||
printf("Would execute %s script with argument %s now\n",
|
||||
text, target);
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
pkgdir = pkgdb_pkg_dir(pkg);
|
||||
if (chmod(fname, 0555))
|
||||
warn("chmod of `%s' failed", fname);
|
||||
rv = fcexec(pkgdir, fname, pkg, target, NULL);
|
||||
if (rv)
|
||||
warnx("%s script returned error status", text);
|
||||
free(pkgdir);
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return rv;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Copy lines from fname to fname_tmp, filtering out lines equal to text.
|
||||
* Afterwards rename fname_tmp to fname;
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
remove_line(const char *fname, const char *fname_tmp, const char *text)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *fp, *fp_out;
|
||||
char line[MaxPathSize], *eol;
|
||||
int rv;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((fp = fopen(fname, "r")) == NULL) {
|
||||
warn("Unable to open `%s'", fname);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((fp_out = fopen(fname_tmp, "w")) == NULL) {
|
||||
warn("Unable to open `%s'", fname_tmp);
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
while (fgets(line, sizeof(line), fp) != NULL) {
|
||||
if ((eol = strrchr(line, '\n')) != NULL)
|
||||
*eol = '\0';
|
||||
if (strcmp(line, text) == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
fprintf(fp_out, "%s\n", line);
|
||||
}
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
|
||||
if (fclose(fp_out) == EOF) {
|
||||
remove(fname_tmp);
|
||||
warnx("Failure while closing `%s' temp file", fname_tmp);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (rename(fname_tmp, fname) == -1) {
|
||||
warn("Unable to rename `%s' to `%s'", fname_tmp, fname);
|
||||
rv = 1;
|
||||
} else
|
||||
rv = 0;
|
||||
remove(fname_tmp);
|
||||
|
||||
return rv;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Unregister the package from the depot it is registered in.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
remove_pkg_from_depot(const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *fp;
|
||||
char line[MaxPathSize], *eol;
|
||||
char *fname, *fname2;
|
||||
int rv;
|
||||
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, DEPOT_FNAME);
|
||||
if (isemptyfile(fname)) {
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (Verbose)
|
||||
printf("Attempting to remove the `%s' registration "
|
||||
"on package `%s'\n", fname, pkg);
|
||||
|
||||
if (Fake) {
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if ((fp = fopen(fname, "r")) == NULL) {
|
||||
warn("Unable to open `%s' file", fname);
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (fgets(line, sizeof(line), fp) == NULL) {
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
warnx("Empty depot file `%s'", fname);
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((eol = strrchr(line, '\n')) != NULL)
|
||||
*eol = '\0';
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, VIEWS_FNAME);
|
||||
fname2 = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, VIEWS_FNAME_TMP);
|
||||
rv = remove_line(fname, fname2, line);
|
||||
free(fname2);
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
|
||||
return rv;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* remove_depend is used as iterator function below.
|
||||
* The passed-in package name should be removed from the
|
||||
* +REQUIRED_BY list of the dependency. Such an entry
|
||||
* can miss in a fully correct package database, if the pattern
|
||||
* matches more than one package.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
remove_depend(const char *cur_pkg, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *pkg = cookie;
|
||||
char *fname, *fname2;
|
||||
int rv;
|
||||
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(cur_pkg, REQUIRED_BY_FNAME);
|
||||
if (isemptyfile(fname)) {
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
fname2 = pkgdb_pkg_file(cur_pkg, REQUIRED_BY_FNAME_TMP);
|
||||
|
||||
rv = remove_line(fname, fname2, pkg);
|
||||
|
||||
free(fname2);
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
|
||||
return rv;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
remove_pkg(const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *fp;
|
||||
char *fname, *pkgdir;
|
||||
package_t plist;
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
int is_depoted_pkg, rv, late_error;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkgdb_update_only)
|
||||
return pkgdb_remove_pkg(pkg) ? 0 : 1;
|
||||
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, CONTENTS_FNAME);
|
||||
if (!fexists(fname)) {
|
||||
warnx("package `%s' is not installed, `%s' missing", pkg, fname);
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
|
||||
/* +REQUIRED_BY and +PRESERVE already checked */
|
||||
if (remove_pkg_from_view(pkg))
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* The views related code has bad error handling, if e.g.
|
||||
* the deinstall script fails, the package remains unregistered.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, CONTENTS_FNAME);
|
||||
if ((fp = fopen(fname, "r")) == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("Failed to open `%s'", fname);
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
read_plist(&plist, fp);
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* If a prefix has been provided, remove the first @cwd and
|
||||
* prepend that prefix. This allows removing packages without
|
||||
* @cwd if really necessary. pkg_admin rebuild is likely needed
|
||||
* afterwards though.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
if (prefix) {
|
||||
delete_plist(&plist, FALSE, PLIST_CWD, NULL);
|
||||
add_plist_top(&plist, PLIST_CWD, prefix);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((p = find_plist(&plist, PLIST_CWD)) == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("Package `%s' doesn't have a prefix", pkg);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (find_plist(&plist, PLIST_NAME) == NULL) {
|
||||
/* Cheat a bit to allow removal of such bad packages. */
|
||||
warnx("Package `%s' doesn't have a name", pkg);
|
||||
add_plist_top(&plist, PLIST_NAME, pkg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
setenv(PKG_REFCOUNT_DBDIR_VNAME, config_pkg_refcount_dbdir, 1);
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_dir(pkg);
|
||||
setenv(PKG_METADATA_DIR_VNAME, fname, 1);
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
setenv(PKG_PREFIX_VNAME, p->name, 1);
|
||||
|
||||
if (!no_deinstall && !unregister_only) {
|
||||
if (run_deinstall_script(pkg, 0) && !Force)
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
late_error = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (Fake)
|
||||
printf("Attempting to delete package `%s'\n", pkg);
|
||||
else if (delete_package(FALSE, &plist, unregister_only,
|
||||
destdir) == FAIL) {
|
||||
warnx("couldn't entirely delete package `%s'", pkg);
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* XXX It could be nice to error out here explicitly,
|
||||
* XXX but this is problematic for missing or changed files.
|
||||
* XXX At least the inability to remove files at all should
|
||||
* XXX be handled though.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Past the point of no return. Files are gone, all that is left
|
||||
* is cleaning up registered dependencies and removing the meta data.
|
||||
* Errors in the remaining part are counted, but don't stop the
|
||||
* processing.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, DEPOT_FNAME);
|
||||
if (fexists(fname)) {
|
||||
late_error |= remove_pkg_from_depot(pkg);
|
||||
/* XXX error checking */
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
for (p = plist.head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
if (p->type != PLIST_PKGDEP)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (Verbose)
|
||||
printf("Attempting to remove dependency "
|
||||
"on package `%s'\n", p->name);
|
||||
if (Fake)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
match_installed_pkgs(p->name, remove_depend,
|
||||
__UNCONST(pkg));
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
|
||||
free_plist(&plist);
|
||||
|
||||
if (!no_deinstall && !unregister_only)
|
||||
late_error |= run_deinstall_script(pkg, 1);
|
||||
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, VIEWS_FNAME);
|
||||
if (fexists(fname))
|
||||
is_depoted_pkg = TRUE;
|
||||
else
|
||||
is_depoted_pkg = FALSE;
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
|
||||
if (Fake)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Kill the pkgdb subdirectory. The files have been removed, so
|
||||
* this is way beyond the point of no return.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
pkgdir = pkgdb_pkg_dir(pkg);
|
||||
(void) remove_files(pkgdir, "+*");
|
||||
rv = 1;
|
||||
if (isemptydir(pkgdir)&& rmdir(pkgdir) == 0)
|
||||
rv = 0;
|
||||
else if (is_depoted_pkg)
|
||||
warnx("Depot directory `%s' is not empty", pkgdir);
|
||||
else if (!Force)
|
||||
warnx("Couldn't remove package directory in `%s'", pkgdir);
|
||||
else if (recursive_remove(pkgdir, 1))
|
||||
warn("Couldn't remove package directory `%s'", pkgdir);
|
||||
else
|
||||
warnx("Package directory `%s' forcefully removed", pkgdir);
|
||||
free(pkgdir);
|
||||
|
||||
return rv | late_error;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
main(int argc, char *argv[])
|
||||
{
|
||||
lpkg_head_t pkgs, sorted_pkgs;
|
||||
int ch, r, has_error;
|
||||
unsigned long bad_count;
|
||||
|
||||
TAILQ_INIT(&pkgs);
|
||||
TAILQ_INIT(&sorted_pkgs);
|
||||
|
||||
setprogname(argv[0]);
|
||||
while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "ADFfK:kNnOP:p:RrVv")) != -1) {
|
||||
switch (ch) {
|
||||
case 'A':
|
||||
delete_automatic_leaves = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'D':
|
||||
no_deinstall = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'F':
|
||||
find_by_filename = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'f':
|
||||
++Force;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'K':
|
||||
pkgdb_set_dir(optarg, 3);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'k':
|
||||
keep_preserve = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'N':
|
||||
unregister_only = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'n':
|
||||
Fake = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'O':
|
||||
pkgdb_update_only = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'P':
|
||||
destdir = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'p':
|
||||
prefix = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'R':
|
||||
delete_new_leaves = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'r':
|
||||
delete_recursive = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 'V':
|
||||
show_version();
|
||||
/* NOTREACHED */
|
||||
case 'v':
|
||||
++Verbose;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
pkg_install_config();
|
||||
|
||||
pkgdb = xstrdup(pkgdb_get_dir());
|
||||
|
||||
if (destdir != NULL) {
|
||||
char *pkgdbdir;
|
||||
|
||||
pkgdbdir = xasprintf("%s/%s", destdir, pkgdb);
|
||||
pkgdb_set_dir(pkgdbdir, 4);
|
||||
free(pkgdbdir);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
argc -= optind;
|
||||
argv += optind;
|
||||
|
||||
if (argc == 0) {
|
||||
if (find_by_filename)
|
||||
warnx("Missing filename(s)");
|
||||
else
|
||||
warnx("Missing package name(s)");
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (Fake)
|
||||
r = pkgdb_open(ReadOnly);
|
||||
else
|
||||
r = pkgdb_open(ReadWrite);
|
||||
|
||||
if (!r)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Opening pkgdb failed");
|
||||
|
||||
/* First, process all command line options. */
|
||||
|
||||
has_error = 0;
|
||||
for (; argc != 0; --argc, ++argv) {
|
||||
if (find_by_filename)
|
||||
has_error |= add_by_filename(&pkgs, *argv);
|
||||
else if (ispkgpattern(*argv))
|
||||
has_error |= add_by_pattern(&pkgs, *argv);
|
||||
else
|
||||
has_error |= add_by_pkgname(&pkgs, *argv);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (has_error && !Force) {
|
||||
pkgdb_close();
|
||||
return EXIT_FAILURE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Second, reorder and recursive if necessary. */
|
||||
|
||||
if (sort_and_recurse(&pkgs, &sorted_pkgs)) {
|
||||
pkgdb_close();
|
||||
return EXIT_FAILURE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Third, add leaves if necessary. */
|
||||
|
||||
if (delete_new_leaves || delete_automatic_leaves)
|
||||
find_new_leaves(&sorted_pkgs);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Now that all packages to remove are known, check
|
||||
* if all are removable. After that, start the actual
|
||||
* removal.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
if (find_preserve_pkgs(&sorted_pkgs)) {
|
||||
pkgdb_close();
|
||||
return EXIT_FAILURE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
setenv(PKG_REFCOUNT_DBDIR_VNAME, pkgdb_refcount_dir(), 1);
|
||||
|
||||
bad_count = 0;
|
||||
while (!TAILQ_EMPTY(&sorted_pkgs)) {
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp;
|
||||
|
||||
lpp = TAILQ_FIRST(&sorted_pkgs);
|
||||
TAILQ_REMOVE(&sorted_pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
if (remove_pkg(lpp->lp_name)) {
|
||||
++bad_count;
|
||||
if (!Force)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free_lpkg(lpp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
pkgdb_close();
|
||||
|
||||
if (Force && bad_count && Verbose)
|
||||
warnx("Removal of %lu packages failed", bad_count);
|
||||
|
||||
return bad_count > 0 ? EXIT_FAILURE : EXIT_SUCCESS;
|
||||
}
|
134
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/info/info.h
vendored
Normal file
134
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/info/info.h
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,134 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: info.h,v 1.1.1.5 2009/10/07 13:19:42 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/* from FreeBSD Id: info.h,v 1.10 1997/02/22 16:09:40 peter Exp */
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 23 August 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Include and define various things wanted by the info command.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _INST_INFO_H_INCLUDE
|
||||
#define _INST_INFO_H_INCLUDE
|
||||
|
||||
struct pkg_meta {
|
||||
char *meta_contents;
|
||||
char *meta_comment;
|
||||
char *meta_desc;
|
||||
char *meta_mtree;
|
||||
char *meta_build_version;
|
||||
char *meta_build_info;
|
||||
char *meta_size_pkg;
|
||||
char *meta_size_all;
|
||||
char *meta_required_by;
|
||||
char *meta_display;
|
||||
char *meta_install;
|
||||
char *meta_deinstall;
|
||||
char *meta_preserve;
|
||||
char *meta_views;
|
||||
char *meta_installed_info;
|
||||
int is_installed;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef MAXINDEXSIZE
|
||||
#define MAXINDEXSIZE 60
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef MAXNAMESIZE
|
||||
#define MAXNAMESIZE 20
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define SHOW_COMMENT 0x00001
|
||||
#define SHOW_DESC 0x00002
|
||||
#define SHOW_PLIST 0x00004
|
||||
#define SHOW_INSTALL 0x00008
|
||||
#define SHOW_DEINSTALL 0x00010
|
||||
#define SHOW_PREFIX 0x00040
|
||||
#define SHOW_INDEX 0x00080
|
||||
#define SHOW_FILES 0x00100
|
||||
#define SHOW_DISPLAY 0x00200
|
||||
#define SHOW_REQBY 0x00400
|
||||
#define SHOW_MTREE 0x00800
|
||||
#define SHOW_BUILD_VERSION 0x01000
|
||||
#define SHOW_BUILD_INFO 0x02000
|
||||
#define SHOW_DEPENDS 0x04000
|
||||
#define SHOW_PKG_SIZE 0x08000
|
||||
#define SHOW_ALL_SIZE 0x10000
|
||||
#define SHOW_BLD_DEPENDS 0x20000
|
||||
#define SHOW_BI_VAR 0x40000
|
||||
#define SHOW_SUMMARY 0x80000
|
||||
#define SHOW_FULL_REQBY 0x100000
|
||||
|
||||
enum which {
|
||||
WHICH_ALL,
|
||||
WHICH_USER,
|
||||
WHICH_LIST
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
extern int Flags;
|
||||
extern enum which Which;
|
||||
extern Boolean File2Pkg;
|
||||
extern Boolean Quiet;
|
||||
extern const char *InfoPrefix;
|
||||
extern const char *BuildInfoVariable;
|
||||
extern lpkg_head_t pkgs;
|
||||
|
||||
int CheckForPkg(const char *);
|
||||
int CheckForBestPkg(const char *);
|
||||
|
||||
void show_file(const char *, const char *, Boolean);
|
||||
void show_var(const char *, const char *);
|
||||
void show_plist(const char *, package_t *, pl_ent_t);
|
||||
void show_files(const char *, package_t *);
|
||||
void show_depends(const char *, package_t *);
|
||||
void show_bld_depends(const char *, package_t *);
|
||||
void show_index(const char *, const char *);
|
||||
void show_summary(struct pkg_meta *, package_t *, const char *);
|
||||
void show_list(lpkg_head_t *, const char *);
|
||||
|
||||
int pkg_perform(lpkg_head_t *);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _INST_INFO_H_INCLUDE */
|
328
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/info/main.c
vendored
Normal file
328
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/info/main.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,328 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: main.c,v 1.1.1.9 2013/04/20 15:26:53 wiz Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: main.c,v 1.1.1.9 2013/04/20 15:26:53 wiz Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is the add module.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_IOCTL_H
|
||||
#include <sys/ioctl.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
#include "info.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static const char Options[] = ".aBbcDde:E:fFhIiK:kLl:mNnpQ:qrRsSuvVX";
|
||||
|
||||
int Flags = 0;
|
||||
enum which Which = WHICH_LIST;
|
||||
Boolean File2Pkg = FALSE;
|
||||
Boolean Quiet = FALSE;
|
||||
const char *InfoPrefix = "";
|
||||
const char *BuildInfoVariable = "";
|
||||
lpkg_head_t pkgs;
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
usage(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
fprintf(stderr, "%s\n%s\n%s\n%s\n",
|
||||
"usage: pkg_info [-BbcDdFfhIikLmNnpqRrSsVvX] [-E pkg-name] [-e pkg-name]",
|
||||
" [-K pkg_dbdir] [-l prefix] pkg-name ...",
|
||||
" pkg_info [-a | -u] [flags]",
|
||||
" pkg_info [-Q variable] pkg-name ...");
|
||||
exit(1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
main(int argc, char **argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *CheckPkg = NULL;
|
||||
char *BestCheckPkg = NULL;
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp;
|
||||
int ch;
|
||||
int rc;
|
||||
|
||||
setprogname(argv[0]);
|
||||
while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, Options)) != -1)
|
||||
switch (ch) {
|
||||
case '.': /* for backward compatibility */
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'a':
|
||||
Which = WHICH_ALL;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'B':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_BUILD_INFO;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'b':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_BUILD_VERSION;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'c':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_COMMENT;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'D':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_DISPLAY;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'd':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_DESC;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'E':
|
||||
BestCheckPkg = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'e':
|
||||
CheckPkg = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'f':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_PLIST;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'F':
|
||||
File2Pkg = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'I':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_INDEX;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'i':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_INSTALL;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'K':
|
||||
pkgdb_set_dir(optarg, 3);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'k':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_DEINSTALL;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'L':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_FILES;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'l':
|
||||
InfoPrefix = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'm':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_MTREE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'N':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_BLD_DEPENDS;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'n':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_DEPENDS;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'p':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_PREFIX;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'Q':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_BI_VAR;
|
||||
BuildInfoVariable = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'q':
|
||||
Quiet = TRUE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'r':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_FULL_REQBY;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'R':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_REQBY;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 's':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_PKG_SIZE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'S':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_ALL_SIZE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'u':
|
||||
Which = WHICH_USER;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'v':
|
||||
Verbose = TRUE;
|
||||
/* Reasonable definition of 'everything' */
|
||||
Flags = SHOW_COMMENT | SHOW_DESC | SHOW_PLIST | SHOW_INSTALL |
|
||||
SHOW_DEINSTALL | SHOW_DISPLAY | SHOW_MTREE |
|
||||
SHOW_REQBY | SHOW_BLD_DEPENDS | SHOW_DEPENDS | SHOW_PKG_SIZE | SHOW_ALL_SIZE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'V':
|
||||
show_version();
|
||||
/* NOTREACHED */
|
||||
|
||||
case 'X':
|
||||
Flags |= SHOW_SUMMARY;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'h':
|
||||
case '?':
|
||||
default:
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
/* NOTREACHED */
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
argc -= optind;
|
||||
argv += optind;
|
||||
|
||||
pkg_install_config();
|
||||
|
||||
if (argc == 0 && !Flags && !CheckPkg) {
|
||||
/* No argument or relevant flags specified - assume -I */
|
||||
Flags = SHOW_INDEX;
|
||||
/* assume -a if neither -u nor -a is given */
|
||||
if (Which == WHICH_LIST)
|
||||
Which = WHICH_ALL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (CheckPkg != NULL && BestCheckPkg != NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("-E and -e are mutally exlusive");
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (argc != 0 && CheckPkg != NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("can't give any additional arguments to -e");
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (argc != 0 && BestCheckPkg != NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("can't give any additional arguments to -E");
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (argc != 0 && Which != WHICH_LIST) {
|
||||
warnx("can't use both -a/-u and package name");
|
||||
usage();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Set some reasonable defaults */
|
||||
if (!Flags)
|
||||
Flags = SHOW_COMMENT | SHOW_DESC | SHOW_REQBY
|
||||
| SHOW_DEPENDS | SHOW_DISPLAY;
|
||||
|
||||
/* -Fe /filename -> change CheckPkg to real packagename */
|
||||
if (CheckPkg) {
|
||||
if (File2Pkg) {
|
||||
char *s;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!pkgdb_open(ReadOnly))
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "cannot open pkgdb");
|
||||
|
||||
s = pkgdb_retrieve(CheckPkg);
|
||||
|
||||
if (s == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "No matching pkg for %s.", CheckPkg);
|
||||
CheckPkg = xstrdup(s);
|
||||
|
||||
pkgdb_close();
|
||||
}
|
||||
return CheckForPkg(CheckPkg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (BestCheckPkg)
|
||||
return CheckForBestPkg(BestCheckPkg);
|
||||
|
||||
TAILQ_INIT(&pkgs);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Get all the remaining package names, if any */
|
||||
if (File2Pkg && Which == WHICH_LIST)
|
||||
if (!pkgdb_open(ReadOnly)) {
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "cannot open pkgdb");
|
||||
}
|
||||
while (*argv) {
|
||||
/* pkgdb: if -F flag given, don't add pkgnames to the "pkgs"
|
||||
* queue but rather resolve the given filenames to pkgnames
|
||||
* using pkgdb_retrieve, then add them. */
|
||||
if (File2Pkg) {
|
||||
char *s;
|
||||
|
||||
s = pkgdb_retrieve(*argv);
|
||||
|
||||
if (s) {
|
||||
lpp = alloc_lpkg(s);
|
||||
TAILQ_INSERT_TAIL(&pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
} else
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "No matching pkg for %s.", *argv);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
if (ispkgpattern(*argv)) {
|
||||
switch (add_installed_pkgs_by_pattern(*argv, &pkgs)) {
|
||||
case 0:
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "No matching pkg for %s.", *argv);
|
||||
case -1:
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Error during search in pkgdb for %s", *argv);
|
||||
}
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
const char *dbdir;
|
||||
|
||||
dbdir = pkgdb_get_dir();
|
||||
if (**argv == '/' && strncmp(*argv, dbdir, strlen(dbdir)) == 0) {
|
||||
*argv += strlen(dbdir) + 1;
|
||||
if ((*argv)[strlen(*argv) - 1] == '/') {
|
||||
(*argv)[strlen(*argv) - 1] = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
lpp = alloc_lpkg(*argv);
|
||||
TAILQ_INSERT_TAIL(&pkgs, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
argv++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (File2Pkg)
|
||||
pkgdb_close();
|
||||
|
||||
/* If no packages, yelp */
|
||||
if (TAILQ_FIRST(&pkgs) == NULL && Which == WHICH_LIST && !CheckPkg)
|
||||
warnx("missing package name(s)"), usage();
|
||||
|
||||
rc = pkg_perform(&pkgs);
|
||||
exit(rc);
|
||||
/* NOTREACHED */
|
||||
}
|
665
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/info/perform.c
vendored
Normal file
665
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/info/perform.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,665 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: perform.c,v 1.1.1.13 2010/02/20 04:41:55 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_QUEUE_H
|
||||
#include <sys/queue.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_WAIT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/wait.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: perform.c,v 1.1.1.13 2010/02/20 04:41:55 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 23 Aug 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is the main body of the info module.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
#include "info.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_TYPES_H
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_STAT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/stat.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef BOOTSTRAP
|
||||
#include <archive.h>
|
||||
#include <archive_entry.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERRNO_H
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_FCNTL_H
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SIGNAL_H
|
||||
#include <signal.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_DIRENT_H
|
||||
#include <dirent.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_CTYPE_H
|
||||
#include <ctype.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#define LOAD_CONTENTS (1 << 0)
|
||||
#define LOAD_COMMENT (1 << 1)
|
||||
#define LOAD_DESC (1 << 2)
|
||||
#define LOAD_INSTALL (1 << 3)
|
||||
#define LOAD_DEINSTALL (1 << 4)
|
||||
#define LOAD_DISPLAY (1 << 5)
|
||||
#define LOAD_MTREE (1 << 6)
|
||||
#define LOAD_BUILD_VERSION (1 << 7)
|
||||
#define LOAD_BUILD_INFO (1 << 8)
|
||||
#define LOAD_SIZE_PKG (1 << 9)
|
||||
#define LOAD_SIZE_ALL (1 << 10)
|
||||
#define LOAD_PRESERVE (1 << 11)
|
||||
#define LOAD_VIEWS (1 << 12)
|
||||
#define LOAD_REQUIRED_BY (1 << 13)
|
||||
#define LOAD_INSTALLED_INFO (1 << 14)
|
||||
|
||||
static const struct pkg_meta_desc {
|
||||
size_t entry_offset;
|
||||
const char *entry_filename;
|
||||
int entry_mask;
|
||||
int required_file;
|
||||
} pkg_meta_descriptors[] = {
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_contents), CONTENTS_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_CONTENTS, 1},
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_comment), COMMENT_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_COMMENT, 1 },
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_desc), DESC_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_DESC, 1 },
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_install), INSTALL_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_INSTALL, 0 },
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_deinstall), DEINSTALL_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_DEINSTALL, 0 },
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_display), DISPLAY_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_DISPLAY, 0 },
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_mtree), MTREE_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_MTREE, 0 },
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_build_version), BUILD_VERSION_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_BUILD_VERSION, 0 },
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_build_info), BUILD_INFO_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_BUILD_INFO, 0 },
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_size_pkg), SIZE_PKG_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_SIZE_PKG, 0 },
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_size_all), SIZE_ALL_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_SIZE_ALL, 0 },
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_preserve), PRESERVE_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_PRESERVE, 0 },
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_views), VIEWS_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_VIEWS, 0 },
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_required_by), REQUIRED_BY_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_REQUIRED_BY, 0 },
|
||||
{ offsetof(struct pkg_meta, meta_installed_info), INSTALLED_INFO_FNAME,
|
||||
LOAD_INSTALLED_INFO, 0 },
|
||||
{ 0, NULL, 0, 0 },
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static int desired_meta_data;
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
free_pkg_meta(struct pkg_meta *meta)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const struct pkg_meta_desc *descr;
|
||||
|
||||
for (descr = pkg_meta_descriptors; descr->entry_filename; ++descr)
|
||||
free(*(char **)((char *)meta + descr->entry_offset));
|
||||
|
||||
free(meta);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef BOOTSTRAP
|
||||
static struct pkg_meta *
|
||||
read_meta_data_from_archive(struct archive *archive,
|
||||
struct archive_entry *entry)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct pkg_meta *meta;
|
||||
const char *fname;
|
||||
const struct pkg_meta_desc *descr, *last_descr;
|
||||
char **target;
|
||||
int64_t size;
|
||||
int r, found_required;
|
||||
|
||||
found_required = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
meta = xcalloc(1, sizeof(*meta));
|
||||
|
||||
last_descr = 0;
|
||||
if (entry != NULL) {
|
||||
r = ARCHIVE_OK;
|
||||
goto has_entry;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
while ((r = archive_read_next_header(archive, &entry)) == ARCHIVE_OK) {
|
||||
has_entry:
|
||||
fname = archive_entry_pathname(entry);
|
||||
|
||||
for (descr = pkg_meta_descriptors; descr->entry_filename;
|
||||
++descr) {
|
||||
if (strcmp(descr->entry_filename, fname) == 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (descr->entry_filename == NULL)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
if (descr->required_file)
|
||||
++found_required;
|
||||
|
||||
target = (char **)((char *)meta + descr->entry_offset);
|
||||
if (*target)
|
||||
errx(2, "duplicate entry, package corrupt");
|
||||
if (descr < last_descr)
|
||||
warnx("misordered package, continuing");
|
||||
else
|
||||
last_descr = descr;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((descr->entry_mask & desired_meta_data) == 0) {
|
||||
if (archive_read_data_skip(archive))
|
||||
errx(2, "cannot read package meta data");
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
size = archive_entry_size(entry);
|
||||
if (size > SSIZE_MAX - 1)
|
||||
errx(2, "package meta data too large to process");
|
||||
*target = xmalloc(size + 1);
|
||||
if (archive_read_data(archive, *target, size) != size)
|
||||
errx(2, "cannot read package meta data");
|
||||
(*target)[size] = '\0';
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
for (descr = pkg_meta_descriptors; descr->entry_filename; ++descr) {
|
||||
if (descr->required_file)
|
||||
--found_required;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
meta->is_installed = 0;
|
||||
if (found_required != 0 || (r != ARCHIVE_OK && r != ARCHIVE_EOF)) {
|
||||
free_pkg_meta(meta);
|
||||
meta = NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return meta;
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
static struct pkg_meta *
|
||||
read_meta_data_from_pkgdb(const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct pkg_meta *meta;
|
||||
const struct pkg_meta_desc *descr;
|
||||
char **target;
|
||||
char *fname;
|
||||
int fd;
|
||||
struct stat st;
|
||||
|
||||
meta = xcalloc(1, sizeof(*meta));
|
||||
|
||||
for (descr = pkg_meta_descriptors; descr->entry_filename; ++descr) {
|
||||
if ((descr->entry_mask & desired_meta_data) == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, descr->entry_filename);
|
||||
fd = open(fname, O_RDONLY, 0);
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
if (fd == -1) {
|
||||
if (errno == ENOENT && descr->required_file == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
err(2, "cannot read meta data file %s of package %s",
|
||||
descr->entry_filename, pkg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
target = (char **)((char *)meta + descr->entry_offset);
|
||||
|
||||
if (fstat(fd, &st) == -1)
|
||||
err(2, "cannot stat meta data");
|
||||
if ((st.st_mode & S_IFMT) != S_IFREG)
|
||||
errx(1, "meta data is not regular file");
|
||||
if (st.st_size > SSIZE_MAX - 1)
|
||||
err(2, "meta data file too large to process");
|
||||
*target = xmalloc(st.st_size + 1);
|
||||
if (read(fd, *target, st.st_size) != st.st_size)
|
||||
err(2, "cannot read meta data");
|
||||
(*target)[st.st_size] = '\0';
|
||||
close(fd);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
meta->is_installed = 1;
|
||||
|
||||
return meta;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
build_full_reqby(lpkg_head_t *reqby, struct pkg_meta *meta, int limit)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *iter, *eol, *next;
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp;
|
||||
struct pkg_meta *meta_dep;
|
||||
|
||||
if (limit == 65536)
|
||||
errx(1, "Cycle in the dependency tree, bailing out");
|
||||
|
||||
if (meta->is_installed == 0 || meta->meta_required_by == NULL)
|
||||
return;
|
||||
|
||||
for (iter = meta->meta_required_by; *iter != '\0'; iter = next) {
|
||||
eol = iter + strcspn(iter, "\n");
|
||||
if (*eol == '\n')
|
||||
next = eol + 1;
|
||||
else
|
||||
next = eol;
|
||||
if (iter == eol)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
TAILQ_FOREACH(lpp, reqby, lp_link) {
|
||||
if (strlen(lpp->lp_name) + iter != eol)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (memcmp(lpp->lp_name, iter, eol - iter) == 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (lpp != NULL)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
*eol = '\0';
|
||||
lpp = alloc_lpkg(iter);
|
||||
if (next != eol)
|
||||
*eol = '\n';
|
||||
|
||||
meta_dep = read_meta_data_from_pkgdb(lpp->lp_name);
|
||||
if (meta_dep == NULL)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
build_full_reqby(reqby, meta_dep, limit + 1);
|
||||
free_pkg_meta(meta_dep);
|
||||
|
||||
TAILQ_INSERT_HEAD(reqby, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static lfile_head_t files;
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
pkg_do(const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct pkg_meta *meta;
|
||||
int code = 0;
|
||||
const char *binpkgfile = NULL;
|
||||
char *pkgdir;
|
||||
|
||||
if (IS_URL(pkg) || (fexists(pkg) && isfile(pkg))) {
|
||||
#ifdef BOOTSTRAP
|
||||
errx(2, "Binary packages not supported during bootstrap");
|
||||
#else
|
||||
struct archive *archive;
|
||||
struct archive_entry *entry;
|
||||
char *archive_name, *pkgname;
|
||||
|
||||
archive = open_archive(pkg, &archive_name);
|
||||
if (archive == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("can't find package `%s', skipped", pkg);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
pkgname = NULL;
|
||||
entry = NULL;
|
||||
pkg_verify_signature(archive_name, &archive, &entry, &pkgname);
|
||||
if (archive == NULL)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
free(pkgname);
|
||||
|
||||
meta = read_meta_data_from_archive(archive, entry);
|
||||
archive_read_finish(archive);
|
||||
if (!IS_URL(pkg))
|
||||
binpkgfile = pkg;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* It's not an uninstalled package, try and find it among the
|
||||
* installed
|
||||
*/
|
||||
pkgdir = pkgdb_pkg_dir(pkg);
|
||||
if (!fexists(pkgdir) || !(isdir(pkgdir) || islinktodir(pkgdir))) {
|
||||
switch (add_installed_pkgs_by_basename(pkg, &pkgs)) {
|
||||
case 1:
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
case 0:
|
||||
/* No match */
|
||||
warnx("can't find package `%s'", pkg);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
case -1:
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Error during search in pkgdb for %s", pkg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(pkgdir);
|
||||
meta = read_meta_data_from_pkgdb(pkg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (meta == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("invalid package `%s' skipped", pkg);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Index is special info type that has to override all others to make
|
||||
* any sense.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_INDEX) {
|
||||
char tmp[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
|
||||
(void) snprintf(tmp, sizeof(tmp), "%-19s ", pkg);
|
||||
show_index(meta->meta_comment, tmp);
|
||||
} else if (Flags & SHOW_BI_VAR) {
|
||||
if (strcspn(BuildInfoVariable, "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ")
|
||||
== strlen(BuildInfoVariable)) {
|
||||
if (meta->meta_installed_info)
|
||||
show_var(meta->meta_installed_info, BuildInfoVariable);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
if (meta->meta_build_info)
|
||||
show_var(meta->meta_build_info, BuildInfoVariable);
|
||||
else
|
||||
warnx("Build information missing");
|
||||
}
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
package_t plist;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Read the contents list */
|
||||
parse_plist(&plist, meta->meta_contents);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Start showing the package contents */
|
||||
if (!Quiet && !(Flags & SHOW_SUMMARY)) {
|
||||
printf("%sInformation for %s:\n\n", InfoPrefix, pkg);
|
||||
if (meta->meta_preserve) {
|
||||
printf("*** PACKAGE MAY NOT BE DELETED ***\n");
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_SUMMARY) {
|
||||
show_summary(meta, &plist, binpkgfile);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_COMMENT) {
|
||||
show_file(meta->meta_comment, "Comment:\n", TRUE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_DEPENDS) {
|
||||
show_depends("Requires:\n", &plist);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_BLD_DEPENDS) {
|
||||
show_bld_depends("Built using:\n", &plist);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((Flags & SHOW_REQBY) && meta->meta_required_by) {
|
||||
show_file(meta->meta_required_by, "Required by:\n", TRUE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((Flags & SHOW_FULL_REQBY) && meta->is_installed) {
|
||||
lpkg_head_t reqby;
|
||||
TAILQ_INIT(&reqby);
|
||||
build_full_reqby(&reqby, meta, 0);
|
||||
show_list(&reqby, "Full required by list:\n");
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_DESC) {
|
||||
show_file(meta->meta_desc, "Description:\n", TRUE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((Flags & SHOW_DISPLAY) && meta->meta_display) {
|
||||
show_file(meta->meta_display, "Install notice:\n",
|
||||
TRUE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_PLIST) {
|
||||
show_plist("Packing list:\n", &plist, PLIST_SHOW_ALL);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((Flags & SHOW_INSTALL) && meta->meta_install) {
|
||||
show_file(meta->meta_install, "Install script:\n",
|
||||
TRUE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((Flags & SHOW_DEINSTALL) && meta->meta_deinstall) {
|
||||
show_file(meta->meta_deinstall, "De-Install script:\n",
|
||||
TRUE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((Flags & SHOW_MTREE) && meta->meta_mtree) {
|
||||
show_file(meta->meta_mtree, "mtree file:\n", TRUE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_PREFIX) {
|
||||
show_plist("Prefix(s):\n", &plist, PLIST_CWD);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_FILES) {
|
||||
show_files("Files:\n", &plist);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((Flags & SHOW_BUILD_VERSION) && meta->meta_build_version) {
|
||||
show_file(meta->meta_build_version, "Build version:\n",
|
||||
TRUE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_BUILD_INFO) {
|
||||
if (meta->meta_build_info) {
|
||||
show_file(meta->meta_build_info, "Build information:\n",
|
||||
TRUE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (meta->meta_installed_info) {
|
||||
show_file(meta->meta_installed_info, "Installed information:\n",
|
||||
TRUE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((Flags & SHOW_PKG_SIZE) && meta->meta_size_pkg) {
|
||||
show_file(meta->meta_size_pkg, "Size of this package in bytes: ",
|
||||
TRUE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((Flags & SHOW_ALL_SIZE) && meta->meta_size_all) {
|
||||
show_file(meta->meta_size_all, "Size in bytes including required pkgs: ",
|
||||
TRUE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (!Quiet && !(Flags & SHOW_SUMMARY)) {
|
||||
if (meta->meta_preserve) {
|
||||
printf("*** PACKAGE MAY NOT BE DELETED ***\n\n");
|
||||
}
|
||||
puts(InfoPrefix);
|
||||
}
|
||||
free_plist(&plist);
|
||||
}
|
||||
free_pkg_meta(meta);
|
||||
return code;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct print_matching_arg {
|
||||
const char *pattern;
|
||||
int got_match;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
print_matching_pkg(const char *pkgname, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct print_matching_arg *arg= cookie;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkg_match(arg->pattern, pkgname)) {
|
||||
if (!Quiet)
|
||||
puts(pkgname);
|
||||
arg->got_match = 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Returns 0 if at least one package matching pkgname.
|
||||
* Returns 1 otherwise.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If -q was not specified, print all matching packages to stdout.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
CheckForPkg(const char *pkgname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct print_matching_arg arg;
|
||||
|
||||
arg.pattern = pkgname;
|
||||
arg.got_match = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (iterate_pkg_db(print_matching_pkg, &arg) == -1) {
|
||||
warnx("cannot iterate pkgdb");
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (arg.got_match == 0 && !ispkgpattern(pkgname)) {
|
||||
char *pattern;
|
||||
|
||||
pattern = xasprintf("%s-[0-9]*", pkgname);
|
||||
|
||||
arg.pattern = pattern;
|
||||
arg.got_match = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (iterate_pkg_db(print_matching_pkg, &arg) == -1) {
|
||||
free(pattern);
|
||||
warnx("cannot iterate pkgdb");
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(pattern);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (arg.got_match)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
else
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Returns 0 if at least one package matching pkgname.
|
||||
* Returns 1 otherwise.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If -q was not specified, print best match to stdout.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
CheckForBestPkg(const char *pkgname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *pattern, *best_match;
|
||||
|
||||
best_match = find_best_matching_installed_pkg(pkgname);
|
||||
if (best_match == NULL) {
|
||||
if (ispkgpattern(pkgname))
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
|
||||
pattern = xasprintf("%s-[0-9]*", pkgname);
|
||||
best_match = find_best_matching_installed_pkg(pattern);
|
||||
free(pattern);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (best_match == NULL)
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
if (!Quiet)
|
||||
puts(best_match);
|
||||
free(best_match);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
perform_single_pkg(const char *pkg, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int *err_cnt = cookie;
|
||||
|
||||
if (Which == WHICH_ALL || !is_automatic_installed(pkg))
|
||||
*err_cnt += pkg_do(pkg);
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
pkg_perform(lpkg_head_t *pkghead)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int err_cnt = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
TAILQ_INIT(&files);
|
||||
|
||||
desired_meta_data = 0;
|
||||
if ((Flags & (SHOW_INDEX | SHOW_BI_VAR)) == 0)
|
||||
desired_meta_data |= LOAD_PRESERVE;
|
||||
if ((Flags & (SHOW_INDEX | SHOW_BI_VAR)) == 0)
|
||||
desired_meta_data |= LOAD_CONTENTS;
|
||||
if (Flags & (SHOW_COMMENT | SHOW_INDEX | SHOW_SUMMARY))
|
||||
desired_meta_data |= LOAD_COMMENT;
|
||||
if (Flags & (SHOW_BI_VAR | SHOW_BUILD_INFO | SHOW_SUMMARY))
|
||||
desired_meta_data |= LOAD_BUILD_INFO | LOAD_INSTALLED_INFO;
|
||||
if (Flags & (SHOW_SUMMARY | SHOW_PKG_SIZE))
|
||||
desired_meta_data |= LOAD_SIZE_PKG;
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_ALL_SIZE)
|
||||
desired_meta_data |= LOAD_SIZE_ALL;
|
||||
if (Flags & (SHOW_SUMMARY | SHOW_DESC))
|
||||
desired_meta_data |= LOAD_DESC;
|
||||
if (Flags & (SHOW_REQBY | SHOW_FULL_REQBY))
|
||||
desired_meta_data |= LOAD_REQUIRED_BY;
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_DISPLAY)
|
||||
desired_meta_data |= LOAD_DISPLAY;
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_INSTALL)
|
||||
desired_meta_data |= LOAD_INSTALL;
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_DEINSTALL)
|
||||
desired_meta_data |= LOAD_DEINSTALL;
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_MTREE)
|
||||
desired_meta_data |= LOAD_MTREE;
|
||||
if (Flags & SHOW_BUILD_VERSION)
|
||||
desired_meta_data |= LOAD_BUILD_VERSION;
|
||||
|
||||
if (Which != WHICH_LIST) {
|
||||
if (File2Pkg) {
|
||||
/* Show all files with the package they belong to */
|
||||
if (pkgdb_dump() == -1)
|
||||
err_cnt = 1;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
if (iterate_pkg_db(perform_single_pkg, &err_cnt) == -1)
|
||||
err_cnt = 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
/* Show info on individual pkg(s) */
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp;
|
||||
|
||||
while ((lpp = TAILQ_FIRST(pkghead)) != NULL) {
|
||||
TAILQ_REMOVE(pkghead, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
err_cnt += pkg_do(lpp->lp_name);
|
||||
free_lpkg(lpp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
return err_cnt;
|
||||
}
|
349
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/info/pkg_info.1
vendored
Normal file
349
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/info/pkg_info.1
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,349 @@
|
|||
.\" $NetBSD: pkg_info.1,v 1.1.1.6 2013/04/20 15:26:53 wiz Exp $
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintenance
|
||||
.\" of non-core utilities.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
.\" are met:
|
||||
.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" @(#)pkg_info.1
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.Dd December 14, 2012
|
||||
.Dt PKG_INFO 1
|
||||
.Os
|
||||
.Sh NAME
|
||||
.Nm pkg_info
|
||||
.Nd a utility for displaying information on software packages
|
||||
.Sh SYNOPSIS
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
.Op Fl BbcDdFfhIikLmNnpqRrSsVvX
|
||||
.Op Fl E Ar pkg-name
|
||||
.Op Fl e Ar pkg-name
|
||||
.Op Fl K Ar pkg_dbdir
|
||||
.Op Fl l Ar prefix
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name ...
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
.Op Fl a | Fl u
|
||||
.Op flags
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
.Op Fl Q Ar variable
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name ...
|
||||
.Sh DESCRIPTION
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
command is used to dump out information for packages, which may be either
|
||||
packed up in files or already installed on the system with the
|
||||
.Xr pkg_create 1
|
||||
command.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name
|
||||
may be the name of an installed package (with our without version), a
|
||||
pattern matching several installed packages (see the
|
||||
.Sx PACKAGE WILDCARDS
|
||||
section for a description of possible patterns),
|
||||
the pathname to a
|
||||
binary package, a filename belonging to an installed
|
||||
package (with
|
||||
.Fl F ) ,
|
||||
or a URL to an FTP-available package.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
The following command line options are available:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent
|
||||
.It Fl a
|
||||
Show information for all currently installed packages.
|
||||
See also
|
||||
.Fl u .
|
||||
When neither
|
||||
.Fl a
|
||||
nor
|
||||
.Fl u
|
||||
is given, the former is assumed.
|
||||
.It Fl B
|
||||
Show some of the important definitions used when building
|
||||
the binary package (the
|
||||
.Dq Build information )
|
||||
for each package.
|
||||
Additionally, any installation information variables
|
||||
(lowercase) can be queried, too.
|
||||
In particular,
|
||||
.Ar automatic
|
||||
tells if a package was installed automatically
|
||||
as a dependency of another package.
|
||||
.It Fl b
|
||||
Show the
|
||||
.Nx
|
||||
RCS Id strings from the files used in the construction
|
||||
of the binary package (the
|
||||
.Dq Build version )
|
||||
for each package.
|
||||
These files are the package Makefile, any patch files, any checksum
|
||||
files, and the packing list file.
|
||||
.It Fl c
|
||||
Show the one-line comment field for each package.
|
||||
.It Fl D
|
||||
Show the install-message file (if any) for each package.
|
||||
.It Fl d
|
||||
Show the long-description field for each package.
|
||||
.It Fl E Ar pkg-name
|
||||
This option
|
||||
allows you to test for the existence of a given package.
|
||||
If a package identified by
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name
|
||||
is currently installed, return code is 0, otherwise 1.
|
||||
The name of the best matching package found installed is printed to
|
||||
stdout unless turned off using the
|
||||
.Fl q
|
||||
option.
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name
|
||||
can contain wildcards (see the
|
||||
.Sx PACKAGE WILDCARDS
|
||||
section below).
|
||||
.It Fl e Ar pkg-name
|
||||
This option
|
||||
allows you to test for the existence of a given package.
|
||||
If a package identified by
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name
|
||||
is currently installed, return code is 0, otherwise 1.
|
||||
The names of any package(s) found installed are printed to
|
||||
stdout unless turned off using the
|
||||
.Fl q
|
||||
option.
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name
|
||||
can contain wildcards (see the
|
||||
.Sx PACKAGE WILDCARDS
|
||||
section below).
|
||||
.It Fl F
|
||||
Interpret any
|
||||
.Ar pkg-name
|
||||
given as filename, and query information on the package that
|
||||
file belongs to.
|
||||
This can be used to query information on a per-file basis.
|
||||
See the
|
||||
.Sx TECHNICAL DETAILS
|
||||
section below for more information.
|
||||
.It Fl f
|
||||
Show the packing list instructions for each package.
|
||||
.It Fl h
|
||||
Print usage message and exit.
|
||||
.It Fl I
|
||||
Show the index entry for each package.
|
||||
This option is assumed when no arguments or relevant flags are specified.
|
||||
.It Fl i
|
||||
Show the install script (if any) for each package.
|
||||
.It Fl K Ar pkg_dbdir
|
||||
Override the value of the
|
||||
.Dv PKG_DBDIR
|
||||
configuration option with the value
|
||||
.Ar pkg_dbdir .
|
||||
.It Fl k
|
||||
Show the de-install script (if any) for each package.
|
||||
.It Fl L
|
||||
Show the files within each package.
|
||||
This is different from just viewing the packing list, since full pathnames
|
||||
for everything are generated.
|
||||
Files that were created dynamically during installation of the package
|
||||
are not listed.
|
||||
.It Fl l Ar prefix
|
||||
Prefix each information category header (see
|
||||
.Fl q )
|
||||
shown with
|
||||
.Ar prefix .
|
||||
This is primarily of use to front-end programs that want to request a
|
||||
lot of different information fields at once for a package, but don't
|
||||
necessary want the output intermingled in such a way that they can't
|
||||
organize it.
|
||||
This lets you add a special token to the start of each field.
|
||||
.It Fl m
|
||||
Show the mtree file (if any) for each package.
|
||||
.It Fl N
|
||||
Show which packages each package was built with (exact dependencies), if any.
|
||||
.It Fl n
|
||||
Show which packages each package needs (depends upon), if any.
|
||||
.It Fl p
|
||||
Show the installation prefix for each package.
|
||||
.It Fl Q Ar variable
|
||||
Show the definition of
|
||||
.Ar variable
|
||||
from the build information for each package.
|
||||
An empty string is returned if no such variable definition is found for
|
||||
the package(s).
|
||||
.It Fl q
|
||||
Be
|
||||
.Dq quiet
|
||||
in emitting report headers and such, just dump the
|
||||
raw info (basically, assume a non-human reading).
|
||||
.It Fl R
|
||||
For each package, show the packages that require it.
|
||||
.It Fl r
|
||||
For each package, show the packages that require it.
|
||||
Continue recursively to show all dependents.
|
||||
.It Fl S
|
||||
Show the size of this package and all the packages it requires,
|
||||
in bytes.
|
||||
.It Fl s
|
||||
Show the size of this package in bytes.
|
||||
The size is calculated by adding up the size of each file of the package.
|
||||
.It Fl u
|
||||
Show information for all user-installed packages:
|
||||
automatically installed packages (as dependencies
|
||||
of other packages) are not displayed.
|
||||
See also
|
||||
.Fl a .
|
||||
.It Fl V
|
||||
Print version number and exit.
|
||||
.It Fl v
|
||||
Turn on verbose output.
|
||||
.It Fl X
|
||||
Print summary information for each package.
|
||||
The summary format is
|
||||
described in
|
||||
.Xr pkg_summary 5 .
|
||||
Its primary use is to contain all information about the contents of a
|
||||
(remote) binary package repository needed by package managing software.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Sh TECHNICAL DETAILS
|
||||
Package info is either extracted from package files named on the
|
||||
command line, or from already installed package information
|
||||
in
|
||||
.Pa \*[Lt]PKG_DBDIR\*[Gt]/\*[Lt]pkg-name\*[Gt] .
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
When the
|
||||
.Fl F
|
||||
option is used,
|
||||
a filename can be given instead of a package name to query
|
||||
information on the (installed) package that file belongs to.
|
||||
The filename is resolved to a package name using the package database.
|
||||
The filename must be absolute, as in the output of
|
||||
.Dl pkg_info -aF .
|
||||
For example,
|
||||
.Dl pkg_info -eF /path/to/file
|
||||
can be used to display the package the given file belongs to, and
|
||||
.Dl pkg_info -LF /path/to/file
|
||||
can be used to display all files belonging to the package the given
|
||||
file belongs to.
|
||||
.Sh PACKAGE WILDCARDS
|
||||
In the places where a package name/version is expected, e.g., for the
|
||||
.Fl e
|
||||
option, several forms can be used.
|
||||
Either use a package name with or without version, or specify a
|
||||
package wildcard that gets matched against all installed packages.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
Package wildcards use
|
||||
.Xr fnmatch 3 .
|
||||
In addition,
|
||||
.Xr csh 1
|
||||
style {,} alternates have been implemented.
|
||||
Package version numbers can also be matched in a relational manner
|
||||
using the
|
||||
.Dq \*[Ge] ,
|
||||
.Dq \*[Le] ,
|
||||
.Dq \*[Gt] ,
|
||||
and
|
||||
.Dq \*[Lt]
|
||||
operators.
|
||||
For example,
|
||||
.Dl pkg_info -e 'name\*[Ge]1.3'
|
||||
will match versions 1.3 and later of the
|
||||
.Dq name
|
||||
package.
|
||||
(Make sure to use shell quoting.)
|
||||
Additionally, ranges can be defined, by giving both a lower bound
|
||||
.Po with
|
||||
.Dq \*[Gt]
|
||||
or
|
||||
.Dq \*[Ge]
|
||||
.Pc
|
||||
as well as an upper bound
|
||||
.Po with
|
||||
.Dq \*[Lt]
|
||||
or
|
||||
. Dq \*[Le]
|
||||
.Pc .
|
||||
The lower bound has to come first.
|
||||
For example,
|
||||
.Dl pkg_info -e 'name\*[Ge]1.3\*[Lt]2.0'
|
||||
will match versions 1.3 (inclusive) to 2.0 (exclusive) of package
|
||||
.Dq name .
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
The collating sequence of the various package version numbers is
|
||||
unusual, but strives to be consistent.
|
||||
The magic string
|
||||
.Dq alpha
|
||||
equates to
|
||||
.Dq alpha version ,
|
||||
and sorts before a beta version.
|
||||
The magic string
|
||||
.Dq beta
|
||||
equates to
|
||||
.Dq beta version ,
|
||||
and sorts before a release candidate.
|
||||
The magic string
|
||||
.Dq rc
|
||||
equates to
|
||||
.Dq release candidate ,
|
||||
and sorts before a release.
|
||||
The magic string
|
||||
.Dq pre ,
|
||||
short for
|
||||
.Dq pre-release ,
|
||||
is a synonym for
|
||||
.Dq rc .
|
||||
For example,
|
||||
.Dq name-1.3alpha2
|
||||
will sort before
|
||||
.Dq name-1.3beta1 ,
|
||||
and they both sort before
|
||||
.Dq name-1.3rc1 .
|
||||
Similarly,
|
||||
.Dq name-1.3rc3
|
||||
will sort before
|
||||
.Dq name-1.3 ,
|
||||
and after
|
||||
.Dq name-1.2.9 .
|
||||
The magic string
|
||||
.Dq pl
|
||||
equates to
|
||||
.Dq patch level ,
|
||||
and has the same value as a dot
|
||||
.Pq Sq \&.
|
||||
in the dewey-decimal ordering schemes,
|
||||
as does the underscore
|
||||
.Pq Sq _ .
|
||||
Additionally, alphabetic characters sort in the same place as
|
||||
their numeric counterparts, so that
|
||||
.Dq name-1.2e
|
||||
has the same sorting value as
|
||||
.Dq name-1.2.5 .
|
||||
.Sh ENVIRONMENT
|
||||
See
|
||||
.Xr pkg_install.conf 5
|
||||
for options, that can also be specified using the environment.
|
||||
.Sh SEE ALSO
|
||||
.Xr pkg_add 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_admin 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_create 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_delete 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_install.conf 5
|
||||
.Xr pkgsrc 7
|
||||
.Sh AUTHORS
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent -compact
|
||||
.It "Jordan Hubbard"
|
||||
most of the work
|
||||
.It "John Kohl"
|
||||
refined it for
|
||||
.Nx
|
||||
.It "Hubert Feyrer"
|
||||
.Nx
|
||||
wildcard dependency processing, pkgdb, depends displaying,
|
||||
pkg size display, and more.
|
||||
.El
|
430
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/info/show.c
vendored
Normal file
430
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/info/show.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,430 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: show.c,v 1.3 2012/02/21 18:36:16 wiz Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: show.c,v 1.3 2012/02/21 18:36:16 wiz Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 23 Aug 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Various display routines for the info module.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 1999-2008 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
* by Hubert Feyrer <hubert@feyrer.de>.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
* TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
* PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
* CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
* SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
* INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
* CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
* ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
* POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "defs.h"
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
#include "info.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* Structure to define entries for the "show table" */
|
||||
typedef struct show_t {
|
||||
pl_ent_t sh_type; /* type of entry */
|
||||
const char *sh_quiet; /* message when quiet */
|
||||
const char *sh_verbose; /* message when verbose */
|
||||
} show_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* The entries in this table must be ordered the same as
|
||||
* pl_ent_t constants
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static const show_t showv[] = {
|
||||
{PLIST_FILE, "", "\tFile: "},
|
||||
{PLIST_CWD, "@cwd ", "\tCWD to: "},
|
||||
{PLIST_CMD, "@exec ", "\tEXEC ''"},
|
||||
{PLIST_CHMOD, "@chmod ", "\tCHMOD to "},
|
||||
{PLIST_CHOWN, "@chown ", "\tCHOWN to "},
|
||||
{PLIST_CHGRP, "@chgrp ", "\tCHGRP to "},
|
||||
{PLIST_COMMENT, "@comment ", "\tComment: "},
|
||||
{PLIST_IGNORE, "@ignore", "Ignore next file:"},
|
||||
{PLIST_NAME, "@name ", "\tPackage name: "},
|
||||
{PLIST_UNEXEC, "@unexec ", "\tUNEXEC ''"},
|
||||
{PLIST_SRC, "@src: ", "\tSRC to: "},
|
||||
{PLIST_DISPLAY, "@display ", "\tInstall message file: "},
|
||||
{PLIST_PKGDEP, "@pkgdep ", "\tPackage depends on: "},
|
||||
{PLIST_DIR_RM, "@dirrm ", "\tObsolete deinstall directory removal hint: "},
|
||||
{PLIST_OPTION, "@option ", "\tPackage has option: "},
|
||||
{PLIST_PKGCFL, "@pkgcfl ", "\tPackage conflicts with: "},
|
||||
{PLIST_BLDDEP, "@blddep ", "\tPackage depends exactly on: "},
|
||||
{PLIST_PKGDIR, "@pkgdir ", "\tManaged directory: "},
|
||||
{-1, NULL, NULL}
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static int print_string_as_var(const char *, const char *);
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
show_file(const char *buf, const char *title, Boolean separator)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!Quiet)
|
||||
printf("%s%s", InfoPrefix, title);
|
||||
|
||||
len = strlen(buf);
|
||||
if (len == 0 || buf[len - 1] != '\n')
|
||||
puts(buf);
|
||||
else
|
||||
fputs(buf, stdout);
|
||||
|
||||
if (!Quiet || separator)
|
||||
printf("\n");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
show_var(const char *buf, const char *variable)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *value;
|
||||
|
||||
if (buf == NULL)
|
||||
return;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((value = var_get_memory(buf, variable)) != NULL) {
|
||||
(void) printf("%s\n", value);
|
||||
free(value);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
show_index(const char *buf, const char *title)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!Quiet)
|
||||
printf("%s%s", InfoPrefix, title);
|
||||
|
||||
len = strlen(buf);
|
||||
if (len == 0 || buf[len - 1] != '\n')
|
||||
puts(buf);
|
||||
else
|
||||
fputs(buf, stdout);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Show a packing list item type. If type is PLIST_SHOW_ALL, show all
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
show_plist(const char *title, package_t *plist, pl_ent_t type)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
Boolean ign;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!Quiet) {
|
||||
printf("%s%s", InfoPrefix, title);
|
||||
}
|
||||
for (ign = FALSE, p = plist->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
if (p->type == type || type == PLIST_SHOW_ALL) {
|
||||
switch (p->type) {
|
||||
case PLIST_FILE:
|
||||
printf("%s%s",
|
||||
Quiet ? showv[p->type].sh_quiet :
|
||||
showv[p->type].sh_verbose, p->name);
|
||||
if (ign) {
|
||||
if (!Quiet) {
|
||||
printf(" (ignored)");
|
||||
}
|
||||
ign = FALSE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_CHMOD:
|
||||
case PLIST_CHOWN:
|
||||
case PLIST_CHGRP:
|
||||
printf("%s%s",
|
||||
Quiet ? showv[p->type].sh_quiet :
|
||||
showv[p->type].sh_verbose,
|
||||
p->name ? p->name : "(clear default)");
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_IGNORE:
|
||||
printf("%s", Quiet ? showv[p->type].sh_quiet :
|
||||
showv[p->type].sh_verbose);
|
||||
ign = TRUE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_CWD:
|
||||
case PLIST_CMD:
|
||||
case PLIST_SRC:
|
||||
case PLIST_UNEXEC:
|
||||
case PLIST_COMMENT:
|
||||
case PLIST_NAME:
|
||||
case PLIST_DISPLAY:
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGDEP:
|
||||
case PLIST_DIR_RM:
|
||||
case PLIST_OPTION:
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGCFL:
|
||||
case PLIST_BLDDEP:
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGDIR:
|
||||
printf("%s%s",
|
||||
Quiet ? showv[p->type].sh_quiet :
|
||||
showv[p->type].sh_verbose,
|
||||
p->name ? p->name : "(null)");
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
warnx("unknown command type %d (%s)", p->type, p->name);
|
||||
}
|
||||
(void) fputc('\n', stdout);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Show all files in the packing list (except ignored ones)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
show_files(const char *title, package_t *plist)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
Boolean ign;
|
||||
const char *dir = ".";
|
||||
|
||||
if (!Quiet) {
|
||||
printf("%s%s", InfoPrefix, title);
|
||||
}
|
||||
for (ign = FALSE, p = plist->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
switch (p->type) {
|
||||
case PLIST_FILE:
|
||||
if (!ign) {
|
||||
printf("%s%s%s\n", dir,
|
||||
(strcmp(dir, "/") == 0) ? "" : "/", p->name);
|
||||
}
|
||||
ign = FALSE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_CWD:
|
||||
dir = p->name;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_IGNORE:
|
||||
ign = TRUE;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Show dependencies (packages this pkg requires)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
show_depends(const char *title, package_t *plist)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
int nodepends;
|
||||
|
||||
nodepends = 1;
|
||||
for (p = plist->head; p && nodepends; p = p->next) {
|
||||
switch (p->type) {
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGDEP:
|
||||
nodepends = 0;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (nodepends)
|
||||
return;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!Quiet) {
|
||||
printf("%s%s", InfoPrefix, title);
|
||||
}
|
||||
for (p = plist->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
switch (p->type) {
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGDEP:
|
||||
printf("%s\n", p->name);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
printf("\n");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Show exact dependencies (packages this pkg was built with)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
show_bld_depends(const char *title, package_t *plist)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
int nodepends;
|
||||
|
||||
nodepends = 1;
|
||||
for (p = plist->head; p && nodepends; p = p->next) {
|
||||
switch (p->type) {
|
||||
case PLIST_BLDDEP:
|
||||
nodepends = 0;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (nodepends)
|
||||
return;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!Quiet) {
|
||||
printf("%s%s", InfoPrefix, title);
|
||||
}
|
||||
for (p = plist->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
switch (p->type) {
|
||||
case PLIST_BLDDEP:
|
||||
printf("%s\n", p->name);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
printf("\n");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Show entry for pkg_summary.txt file.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
show_summary(struct pkg_meta *meta, package_t *plist, const char *binpkgfile)
|
||||
{
|
||||
static const char *bi_vars[] = {
|
||||
"PKGPATH",
|
||||
"CATEGORIES",
|
||||
"PROVIDES",
|
||||
"REQUIRES",
|
||||
"PKG_OPTIONS",
|
||||
"OPSYS",
|
||||
"OS_VERSION",
|
||||
"MACHINE_ARCH",
|
||||
"LICENSE",
|
||||
"HOMEPAGE",
|
||||
"PKGTOOLS_VERSION",
|
||||
"BUILD_DATE",
|
||||
"PREV_PKGPATH",
|
||||
"SUPERSEDES",
|
||||
NULL
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
struct stat st;
|
||||
|
||||
for (p = plist->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
switch (p->type) {
|
||||
case PLIST_NAME:
|
||||
printf("PKGNAME=%s\n", p->name);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGDEP:
|
||||
printf("DEPENDS=%s\n", p->name);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGCFL:
|
||||
printf("CONFLICTS=%s\n", p->name);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
default:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
print_string_as_var("COMMENT", meta->meta_comment);
|
||||
if (meta->meta_size_pkg)
|
||||
print_string_as_var("SIZE_PKG", meta->meta_size_pkg);
|
||||
|
||||
if (meta->meta_build_info)
|
||||
var_copy_list(meta->meta_build_info, bi_vars);
|
||||
else
|
||||
warnx("Build information missing");
|
||||
|
||||
if (binpkgfile != NULL && stat(binpkgfile, &st) == 0) {
|
||||
const char *base;
|
||||
|
||||
base = strrchr(binpkgfile, '/');
|
||||
if (base == NULL)
|
||||
base = binpkgfile;
|
||||
else
|
||||
base++;
|
||||
printf("FILE_NAME=%s\n", base);
|
||||
printf("FILE_SIZE=%" MY_PRIu64 "\n", (uint64_t)st.st_size);
|
||||
/* XXX: DIGETS */
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
print_string_as_var("DESCRIPTION", meta->meta_desc);
|
||||
putc('\n', stdout);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Print the contents of file fname as value of variable var to stdout.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
print_string_as_var(const char *var, const char *str)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *eol;
|
||||
|
||||
while ((eol = strchr(str, '\n')) != NULL) {
|
||||
printf("%s=%.*s\n", var, (int)(eol - str), str);
|
||||
str = eol + 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (*str)
|
||||
printf("%s=%s\n", var, str);
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
show_list(lpkg_head_t *pkghead, const char *title)
|
||||
{
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!Quiet)
|
||||
printf("%s%s", InfoPrefix, title);
|
||||
|
||||
while ((lpp = TAILQ_FIRST(pkghead)) != NULL) {
|
||||
TAILQ_REMOVE(pkghead, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
puts(lpp->lp_name);
|
||||
free_lpkg(lpp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (!Quiet)
|
||||
printf("\n");
|
||||
}
|
105
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/automatic.c
vendored
Normal file
105
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/automatic.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,105 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: automatic.c,v 1.1.1.2 2009/02/02 20:44:05 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2005 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
* by Dieter Baron and Thomas Klausner.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
* 3. Neither the name of The NetBSD Foundation nor the names of its
|
||||
* contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived
|
||||
* from this software without specific prior written permission.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
* TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
* PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
* CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
* SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
* INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
* CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
* ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
* POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: automatic.c,v 1.1.1.2 2009/02/02 20:44:05 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ASSERT_H
|
||||
#include <assert.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERRNO_H
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_FCNTL_H
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_STAT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/stat.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
Boolean
|
||||
is_automatic_installed(const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *filename, *value;
|
||||
Boolean ret;
|
||||
|
||||
assert(pkg[0] != '/');
|
||||
|
||||
filename = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, INSTALLED_INFO_FNAME);
|
||||
|
||||
value = var_get(filename, AUTOMATIC_VARNAME);
|
||||
|
||||
if (value && strcasecmp(value, "yes") == 0)
|
||||
ret = TRUE;
|
||||
else
|
||||
ret = FALSE;
|
||||
|
||||
free(value);
|
||||
free(filename);
|
||||
|
||||
return ret;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
mark_as_automatic_installed(const char *pkg, int value)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *filename;
|
||||
int retval;
|
||||
|
||||
assert(pkg[0] != '/');
|
||||
|
||||
filename = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkg, INSTALLED_INFO_FNAME);
|
||||
|
||||
retval = var_set(filename, AUTOMATIC_VARNAME, value ? "yes" : NULL);
|
||||
|
||||
free(filename);
|
||||
|
||||
return retval;
|
||||
}
|
196
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/config.h.in
vendored
Normal file
196
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/config.h.in
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,196 @@
|
|||
/* lib/config.h.in. Generated from configure.ac by autoheader. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <assert.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_ASSERT_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <ctype.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_CTYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <dirent.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_DIRENT_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <errno.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_ERRNO_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <err.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <fnctl.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_FNCTL_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <fnmatch.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_FNMATCH_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <glob.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_GLOB_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <grp.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_GRP_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <inttypes.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_INTTYPES_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the `db' library (-ldb). */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_LIBDB
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <limits.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_LIMITS_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <memory.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_MEMORY_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <pwd.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_PWD_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <signal.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_SIGNAL_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <stdarg.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_STDARG_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <stdint.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_STDINT_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <stdio.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_STDIO_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <stdlib.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <strings.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_STRINGS_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <string.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/cdefs.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/file.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_SYS_FILE_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/ioctl.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_SYS_IOCTL_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/param.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/queue.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_SYS_QUEUE_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/stat.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_SYS_STAT_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/time.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/types.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_SYS_TYPES_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/utsname.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_SYS_UTSNAME_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/wait.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_SYS_WAIT_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <time.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_TIME_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <unistd.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_UNISTD_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the `vfork' function. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_VFORK
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <vis.h> header file. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_VIS_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if the `z' modifider for printf is missing. */
|
||||
#undef MISSING_SIZE_T_SUPPORT
|
||||
|
||||
/* Defined when PRIu64 is missing or broken */
|
||||
#undef NEED_PRI_MACRO
|
||||
|
||||
/* Defined when to retain only the numeric OS version */
|
||||
#undef NUMERIC_VERSION_ONLY
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the address where bug reports for this package should be sent. */
|
||||
#undef PACKAGE_BUGREPORT
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the full name of this package. */
|
||||
#undef PACKAGE_NAME
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the full name and version of this package. */
|
||||
#undef PACKAGE_STRING
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the one symbol short name of this package. */
|
||||
#undef PACKAGE_TARNAME
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the home page for this package. */
|
||||
#undef PACKAGE_URL
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the version of this package. */
|
||||
#undef PACKAGE_VERSION
|
||||
|
||||
/* The size of `int', as computed by sizeof. */
|
||||
#undef SIZEOF_INT
|
||||
|
||||
/* The size of `long', as computed by sizeof. */
|
||||
#undef SIZEOF_LONG
|
||||
|
||||
/* The size of `long long', as computed by sizeof. */
|
||||
#undef SIZEOF_LONG_LONG
|
||||
|
||||
/* The size of `size_t', as computed by sizeof. */
|
||||
#undef SIZEOF_SIZE_T
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the ANSI C header files. */
|
||||
#undef STDC_HEADERS
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define for Solaris 2.5.1 so the uint32_t typedef from <sys/synch.h>,
|
||||
<pthread.h>, or <semaphore.h> is not used. If the typedef were allowed, the
|
||||
#define below would cause a syntax error. */
|
||||
#undef _UINT32_T
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define for Solaris 2.5.1 so the uint64_t typedef from <sys/synch.h>,
|
||||
<pthread.h>, or <semaphore.h> is not used. If the typedef were allowed, the
|
||||
#define below would cause a syntax error. */
|
||||
#undef _UINT64_T
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define for Solaris 2.5.1 so the uint8_t typedef from <sys/synch.h>,
|
||||
<pthread.h>, or <semaphore.h> is not used. If the typedef were allowed, the
|
||||
#define below would cause a syntax error. */
|
||||
#undef _UINT8_T
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the type of an unsigned integer type of width exactly 16 bits if
|
||||
such a type exists and the standard includes do not define it. */
|
||||
#undef uint16_t
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the type of an unsigned integer type of width exactly 32 bits if
|
||||
such a type exists and the standard includes do not define it. */
|
||||
#undef uint32_t
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the type of an unsigned integer type of width exactly 64 bits if
|
||||
such a type exists and the standard includes do not define it. */
|
||||
#undef uint64_t
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the type of an unsigned integer type of width exactly 8 bits if
|
||||
such a type exists and the standard includes do not define it. */
|
||||
#undef uint8_t
|
||||
|
||||
#if !HAVE_VFORK
|
||||
# define vfork fork
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef MISSING_SIZE_T_SUPPORT
|
||||
# define PRIzu "zu"
|
||||
#elif SIZEOF_SIZE_T == SIZEOF_INT
|
||||
# define PRIzu "u"
|
||||
#elif SIZEOF_SIZE_T == SIZEOF_LONG
|
||||
# define PRIzu "lu"
|
||||
#elif SIZEOF_SIZE_T == SIZEOF_LONG_LONG
|
||||
# define PRIzu "llu"
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# errror "Unknown size_t size"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
166
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/conflicts.c
vendored
Normal file
166
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/conflicts.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,166 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: conflicts.c,v 1.1.1.4 2010/01/30 21:33:43 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2007 Roland Illig <rillig@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* XXX: Reading the +CONTENTS files of all installed packages is
|
||||
* rather slow. Since this check is necessary to avoid conflicting
|
||||
* packages, it should not be removed.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* TODO: Put all the information that is currently in the +CONTENTS
|
||||
* files into one large file or another database.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: conflicts.c,v 1.1.1.4 2010/01/30 21:33:43 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "dewey.h"
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Data structure to keep the intermediate result of the conflict
|
||||
* search. ''pkgname'' is the package in question. The first
|
||||
* installed package that conflicts is filled into
|
||||
* ''conflicting_pkgname''. The pattern that leads to the conflict is
|
||||
* also filled in to help the user in deciding what to do with the
|
||||
* conflict.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
struct package_conflict {
|
||||
const char *pkgname;
|
||||
const char *skip_pkgname;
|
||||
char **conflicting_pkgname;
|
||||
char **conflicting_pattern;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static FILE *
|
||||
fopen_contents(const char *pkgname, const char *mode)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *fname;
|
||||
FILE *f;
|
||||
|
||||
fname = pkgdb_pkg_file(pkgname, CONTENTS_FNAME);
|
||||
f = fopen(fname, mode);
|
||||
if (f == NULL) {
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "%s", fname);
|
||||
/* NOTREACHED */
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(fname);
|
||||
return f;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
check_package_conflict(const char *pkgname, void *v)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct package_conflict *conflict = v;
|
||||
package_t pkg;
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
FILE *f;
|
||||
int rv;
|
||||
|
||||
if (conflict->skip_pkgname != NULL &&
|
||||
strcmp(conflict->skip_pkgname, pkgname) == 0)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
rv = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
f = fopen_contents(pkgname, "r");
|
||||
read_plist(&pkg, f);
|
||||
(void)fclose(f);
|
||||
|
||||
for (p = pkg.head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
if (p->type != PLIST_PKGCFL)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkg_match(p->name, conflict->pkgname) == 1) {
|
||||
*(conflict->conflicting_pkgname) = xstrdup(pkgname);
|
||||
*(conflict->conflicting_pattern) = xstrdup(p->name);
|
||||
rv = 1 /* nonzero, stop iterating */;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
free_plist(&pkg);
|
||||
return rv;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Checks if some installed package has a pkgcfl entry that matches
|
||||
* PkgName. If such an entry is found, the package name is returned in
|
||||
* inst_pkgname, the matching pattern in inst_pattern, and the function
|
||||
* returns a non-zero value. Otherwise, zero is returned and the result
|
||||
* variables are set to NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
some_installed_package_conflicts_with(const char *pkgname,
|
||||
const char *skip_pkgname, char **inst_pkgname, char **inst_pattern)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct package_conflict cfl;
|
||||
int rv;
|
||||
|
||||
cfl.pkgname = pkgname;
|
||||
cfl.skip_pkgname = skip_pkgname;
|
||||
*inst_pkgname = NULL;
|
||||
*inst_pattern = NULL;
|
||||
cfl.conflicting_pkgname = inst_pkgname;
|
||||
cfl.conflicting_pattern = inst_pattern;
|
||||
rv = iterate_pkg_db(check_package_conflict, &cfl);
|
||||
if (rv == -1) {
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Couldn't read list of installed packages.");
|
||||
/* NOTREACHED */
|
||||
}
|
||||
return *inst_pkgname != NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#if 0
|
||||
int main(int argc, char **argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *pkg, *patt;
|
||||
|
||||
if (some_installed_package_conflicts_with(argv[1], &pkg, &patt))
|
||||
printf("yes: package %s conflicts with %s, pattern %s\n", pkg, argv[1], patt);
|
||||
else
|
||||
printf("no\n");
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
75
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/defs.h
vendored
Normal file
75
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/defs.h
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,75 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: defs.h,v 1.3 2012/02/21 18:36:17 wiz Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 1999,2000,2009 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
* by Alistair Crooks (agc@NetBSD.org)
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
* TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
* PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
* CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
* SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
* INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
* CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
* ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
* POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef DEFS_H_
|
||||
#define DEFS_H_
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef MIN
|
||||
#define MIN(a,b) (((a) < (b)) ? (a) : (b))
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef MAX
|
||||
#define MAX(a,b) (((a) > (b)) ? (a) : (b))
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Some systems such as OpenBSD-3.6 do not provide PRIu64.
|
||||
* Others such as AIX-4.3.2 have a broken PRIu64 which includes
|
||||
* a leading "%".
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifdef NEED_PRI_MACRO
|
||||
# if SIZEOF_INT == 8
|
||||
# define MY_PRIu64 "u"
|
||||
# elif SIZEOF_LONG == 8
|
||||
# define MY_PRIu64 "lu"
|
||||
# elif SIZEOF_LONG_LONG == 8
|
||||
# define MY_PRIu64 "llu"
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# error "unable to find a suitable PRIu64"
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define MY_PRIu64 PRIu64
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* !DEFS_H_ */
|
320
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/dewey.c
vendored
Normal file
320
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/dewey.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,320 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: dewey.c,v 1.3 2009/03/08 14:53:16 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright © 2002 Alistair G. Crooks. All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
* 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote
|
||||
* products derived from this software without specific prior written
|
||||
* permission.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS
|
||||
* OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
|
||||
* WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
|
||||
* ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY
|
||||
* DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
|
||||
* DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
|
||||
* GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
* INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
|
||||
* WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
|
||||
* NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
|
||||
* SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CTYPE_H
|
||||
#include <ctype.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "defs.h"
|
||||
#include "dewey.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#define PKG_PATTERN_MAX 1024
|
||||
|
||||
/* do not modify these values, or things will NOT work */
|
||||
enum {
|
||||
Alpha = -3,
|
||||
Beta = -2,
|
||||
RC = -1,
|
||||
Dot = 0,
|
||||
Patch = 1
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* this struct defines a version number */
|
||||
typedef struct arr_t {
|
||||
unsigned c; /* # of version numbers */
|
||||
unsigned size; /* size of array */
|
||||
int *v; /* array of decimal numbers */
|
||||
int netbsd; /* any "nb" suffix */
|
||||
} arr_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/* this struct describes a test */
|
||||
typedef struct test_t {
|
||||
const char *s; /* string representation */
|
||||
unsigned len; /* length of string */
|
||||
int t; /* enumerated type of test */
|
||||
} test_t;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* the tests that are recognised. */
|
||||
const test_t tests[] = {
|
||||
{ "<=", 2, DEWEY_LE },
|
||||
{ "<", 1, DEWEY_LT },
|
||||
{ ">=", 2, DEWEY_GE },
|
||||
{ ">", 1, DEWEY_GT },
|
||||
{ "==", 2, DEWEY_EQ },
|
||||
{ "!=", 2, DEWEY_NE },
|
||||
{ NULL, 0, 0 }
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
const test_t modifiers[] = {
|
||||
{ "alpha", 5, Alpha },
|
||||
{ "beta", 4, Beta },
|
||||
{ "pre", 3, RC },
|
||||
{ "rc", 2, RC },
|
||||
{ "pl", 2, Dot },
|
||||
{ "_", 1, Dot },
|
||||
{ ".", 1, Dot },
|
||||
{ NULL, 0, 0 }
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* locate the test in the tests array */
|
||||
int
|
||||
dewey_mktest(int *op, const char *test)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const test_t *tp;
|
||||
|
||||
for (tp = tests ; tp->s ; tp++) {
|
||||
if (strncasecmp(test, tp->s, tp->len) == 0) {
|
||||
*op = tp->t;
|
||||
return tp->len;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* make a component of a version number.
|
||||
* '.' encodes as Dot which is '0'
|
||||
* '_' encodes as 'patch level', or 'Dot', which is 0.
|
||||
* 'pl' encodes as 'patch level', or 'Dot', which is 0.
|
||||
* 'alpha' encodes as 'alpha version', or Alpha, which is -3.
|
||||
* 'beta' encodes as 'beta version', or Beta, which is -2.
|
||||
* 'rc' encodes as 'release candidate', or RC, which is -1.
|
||||
* 'nb' encodes as 'netbsd version', which is used after all other tests
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
mkcomponent(arr_t *ap, const char *num)
|
||||
{
|
||||
static const char alphas[] = "abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz";
|
||||
const test_t *modp;
|
||||
int n;
|
||||
const char *cp;
|
||||
|
||||
if (ap->c == ap->size) {
|
||||
if (ap->size == 0) {
|
||||
ap->size = 62;
|
||||
if ((ap->v = malloc(ap->size * sizeof(int))) == NULL)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "mkver malloc failed");
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
ap->size *= 2;
|
||||
if ((ap->v = realloc(ap->v, ap->size * sizeof(int)))
|
||||
== NULL)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "mkver realloc failed");
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (isdigit((unsigned char)*num)) {
|
||||
for (cp = num, n = 0 ; isdigit((unsigned char)*num) ; num++) {
|
||||
n = (n * 10) + (*num - '0');
|
||||
}
|
||||
ap->v[ap->c++] = n;
|
||||
return (int)(num - cp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
for (modp = modifiers ; modp->s ; modp++) {
|
||||
if (strncasecmp(num, modp->s, modp->len) == 0) {
|
||||
ap->v[ap->c++] = modp->t;
|
||||
return modp->len;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (strncasecmp(num, "nb", 2) == 0) {
|
||||
for (cp = num, num += 2, n = 0 ; isdigit((unsigned char)*num) ; num++) {
|
||||
n = (n * 10) + (*num - '0');
|
||||
}
|
||||
ap->netbsd = n;
|
||||
return (int)(num - cp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (isalpha((unsigned char)*num)) {
|
||||
ap->v[ap->c++] = Dot;
|
||||
cp = strchr(alphas, tolower((unsigned char)*num));
|
||||
if (ap->c == ap->size) {
|
||||
ap->size *= 2;
|
||||
if ((ap->v = realloc(ap->v, ap->size * sizeof(int))) == NULL)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "mkver realloc failed");
|
||||
}
|
||||
ap->v[ap->c++] = (int)(cp - alphas) + 1;
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* make a version number string into an array of comparable ints */
|
||||
static int
|
||||
mkversion(arr_t *ap, const char *num)
|
||||
{
|
||||
ap->c = 0;
|
||||
ap->size = 0;
|
||||
ap->v = NULL;
|
||||
ap->netbsd = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
while (*num) {
|
||||
num += mkcomponent(ap, num);
|
||||
}
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
freeversion(arr_t *ap)
|
||||
{
|
||||
free(ap->v);
|
||||
ap->v = NULL;
|
||||
ap->c = 0;
|
||||
ap->size = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#define DIGIT(v, c, n) (((n) < (c)) ? v[n] : 0)
|
||||
|
||||
/* compare the result against the test we were expecting */
|
||||
static int
|
||||
result(int cmp, int tst)
|
||||
{
|
||||
switch(tst) {
|
||||
case DEWEY_LT:
|
||||
return cmp < 0;
|
||||
case DEWEY_LE:
|
||||
return cmp <= 0;
|
||||
case DEWEY_GT:
|
||||
return cmp > 0;
|
||||
case DEWEY_GE:
|
||||
return cmp >= 0;
|
||||
case DEWEY_EQ:
|
||||
return cmp == 0;
|
||||
case DEWEY_NE:
|
||||
return cmp != 0;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* do the test on the 2 vectors */
|
||||
static int
|
||||
vtest(arr_t *lhs, int tst, arr_t *rhs)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int cmp;
|
||||
unsigned int c, i;
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0, c = MAX(lhs->c, rhs->c) ; i < c ; i++) {
|
||||
if ((cmp = DIGIT(lhs->v, lhs->c, i) - DIGIT(rhs->v, rhs->c, i)) != 0) {
|
||||
return result(cmp, tst);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
return result(lhs->netbsd - rhs->netbsd, tst);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Compare two dewey decimal numbers
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
dewey_cmp(const char *lhs, int op, const char *rhs)
|
||||
{
|
||||
arr_t right;
|
||||
arr_t left;
|
||||
int retval;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!mkversion(&left, lhs))
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
if (!mkversion(&right, rhs)) {
|
||||
freeversion(&left);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
retval = vtest(&left, op, &right);
|
||||
freeversion(&left);
|
||||
freeversion(&right);
|
||||
return retval;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Perform dewey match on "pkg" against "pattern".
|
||||
* Return 1 on match, 0 on non-match, -1 on error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
dewey_match(const char *pattern, const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *version;
|
||||
const char *sep, *sep2;
|
||||
int op, op2;
|
||||
int n;
|
||||
|
||||
/* compare names */
|
||||
if ((version=strrchr(pkg, '-')) == NULL) {
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((sep = strpbrk(pattern, "<>")) == NULL)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
/* compare name lengths */
|
||||
if ((sep-pattern != version-pkg) ||
|
||||
strncmp(pkg, pattern, (size_t)(version-pkg)) != 0)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
version++;
|
||||
|
||||
/* extract comparison operator */
|
||||
if ((n = dewey_mktest(&op, sep)) < 0) {
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
/* skip operator */
|
||||
sep += n;
|
||||
|
||||
/* if greater than, look for less than */
|
||||
sep2 = NULL;
|
||||
if (op == DEWEY_GT || op == DEWEY_GE) {
|
||||
if ((sep2 = strchr(sep, '<')) != NULL) {
|
||||
if ((n = dewey_mktest(&op2, sep2)) < 0) {
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
/* compare upper limit */
|
||||
if (!dewey_cmp(version, op2, sep2+n))
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* compare only pattern / lower limit */
|
||||
if (sep2) {
|
||||
char ver[PKG_PATTERN_MAX];
|
||||
|
||||
strlcpy(ver, sep, MIN((ssize_t)sizeof(ver), sep2-sep+1));
|
||||
if (dewey_cmp(version, op, ver))
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else {
|
||||
if (dewey_cmp(version, op, sep))
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
19
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/dewey.h
vendored
Normal file
19
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/dewey.h
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,19 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: dewey.h,v 1.1.1.1 2008/09/30 19:00:27 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _INST_LIB_DEWEY_H_
|
||||
#define _INST_LIB_DEWEY_H_
|
||||
|
||||
int dewey_cmp(const char *, int, const char *);
|
||||
int dewey_match(const char *, const char *);
|
||||
int dewey_mktest(int *, const char *);
|
||||
|
||||
enum {
|
||||
DEWEY_LT,
|
||||
DEWEY_LE,
|
||||
DEWEY_EQ,
|
||||
DEWEY_GE,
|
||||
DEWEY_GT,
|
||||
DEWEY_NE
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _INST_LIB_DEWEY_H_ */
|
167
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/fexec.c
vendored
Normal file
167
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/fexec.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,167 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: fexec.c,v 1.1.1.3 2009/08/06 16:55:26 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2003 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
* by Matthias Scheler.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
* TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
* PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
* CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
* SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
* INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
* CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
* ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
* POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_WAIT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/wait.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERRNO_H
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDARG_H
|
||||
#include <stdarg.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_UNISTD_H
|
||||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: fexec.c,v 1.1.1.3 2009/08/06 16:55:26 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
static int vfcexec(const char *, int, const char *, va_list);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* fork, then change current working directory to path and
|
||||
* execute the command and arguments in the argv array.
|
||||
* wait for the command to finish, then return the exit status.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
pfcexec(const char *path, const char *file, const char **argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
pid_t child;
|
||||
int status;
|
||||
|
||||
child = vfork();
|
||||
switch (child) {
|
||||
case 0:
|
||||
if ((path != NULL) && (chdir(path) < 0))
|
||||
_exit(127);
|
||||
|
||||
(void)execvp(file, __UNCONST(argv));
|
||||
_exit(127);
|
||||
/* NOTREACHED */
|
||||
case -1:
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
while (waitpid(child, &status, 0) < 0) {
|
||||
if (errno != EINTR)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (!WIFEXITED(status))
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
|
||||
return WEXITSTATUS(status);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
vfcexec(const char *path, int skipempty, const char *arg, va_list ap)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char **argv;
|
||||
size_t argv_size, argc;
|
||||
int retval;
|
||||
|
||||
argv_size = 16;
|
||||
argv = xcalloc(argv_size, sizeof(*argv));
|
||||
|
||||
argv[0] = arg;
|
||||
argc = 1;
|
||||
|
||||
do {
|
||||
if (argc == argv_size) {
|
||||
argv_size *= 2;
|
||||
argv = xrealloc(argv, argv_size * sizeof(*argv));
|
||||
}
|
||||
arg = va_arg(ap, const char *);
|
||||
if (skipempty && arg && strlen(arg) == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
argv[argc++] = arg;
|
||||
} while (arg != NULL);
|
||||
|
||||
retval = pfcexec(path, argv[0], argv);
|
||||
free(argv);
|
||||
return retval;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
fexec(const char *arg, ...)
|
||||
{
|
||||
va_list ap;
|
||||
int result;
|
||||
|
||||
va_start(ap, arg);
|
||||
result = vfcexec(NULL, 0, arg, ap);
|
||||
va_end(ap);
|
||||
|
||||
return result;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
fexec_skipempty(const char *arg, ...)
|
||||
{
|
||||
va_list ap;
|
||||
int result;
|
||||
|
||||
va_start(ap, arg);
|
||||
result = vfcexec(NULL, 1, arg, ap);
|
||||
va_end(ap);
|
||||
|
||||
return result;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
fcexec(const char *path, const char *arg, ...)
|
||||
{
|
||||
va_list ap;
|
||||
int result;
|
||||
|
||||
va_start(ap, arg);
|
||||
result = vfcexec(path, 0, arg, ap);
|
||||
va_end(ap);
|
||||
|
||||
return result;
|
||||
}
|
374
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/file.c
vendored
Normal file
374
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/file.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,374 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: file.c,v 1.1.1.6 2011/02/18 22:32:30 aymeric Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H
|
||||
#include <sys/param.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_QUEUE_H
|
||||
#include <sys/queue.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: file.c,v 1.1.1.6 2011/02/18 22:32:30 aymeric Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Miscellaneous file access utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_WAIT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/wait.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ASSERT_H
|
||||
#include <assert.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_GLOB_H
|
||||
#include <glob.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_PWD_H
|
||||
#include <pwd.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_TIME_H
|
||||
#include <time.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_FCNTL_H
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Quick check to see if a file (or dir ...) exists
|
||||
*/
|
||||
Boolean
|
||||
fexists(const char *fname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct stat dummy;
|
||||
if (!lstat(fname, &dummy))
|
||||
return TRUE;
|
||||
return FALSE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Quick check to see if something is a directory
|
||||
*/
|
||||
Boolean
|
||||
isdir(const char *fname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct stat sb;
|
||||
|
||||
if (lstat(fname, &sb) != FAIL && S_ISDIR(sb.st_mode))
|
||||
return TRUE;
|
||||
else
|
||||
return FALSE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Check if something is a link to a directory
|
||||
*/
|
||||
Boolean
|
||||
islinktodir(const char *fname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct stat sb;
|
||||
|
||||
if (lstat(fname, &sb) != FAIL && S_ISLNK(sb.st_mode)) {
|
||||
if (stat(fname, &sb) != FAIL && S_ISDIR(sb.st_mode))
|
||||
return TRUE; /* link to dir! */
|
||||
else
|
||||
return FALSE; /* link to non-dir */
|
||||
} else
|
||||
return FALSE; /* non-link */
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Check if something is a link that points to nonexistant target.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
Boolean
|
||||
isbrokenlink(const char *fname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct stat sb;
|
||||
|
||||
if (lstat(fname, &sb) != FAIL && S_ISLNK(sb.st_mode)) {
|
||||
if (stat(fname, &sb) != FAIL)
|
||||
return FALSE; /* link target exists! */
|
||||
else
|
||||
return TRUE; /* link target missing*/
|
||||
} else
|
||||
return FALSE; /* non-link */
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Check to see if file is a dir, and is empty
|
||||
*/
|
||||
Boolean
|
||||
isemptydir(const char *fname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (isdir(fname) || islinktodir(fname)) {
|
||||
DIR *dirp;
|
||||
struct dirent *dp;
|
||||
|
||||
dirp = opendir(fname);
|
||||
if (!dirp)
|
||||
return FALSE; /* no perms, leave it alone */
|
||||
for (dp = readdir(dirp); dp != NULL; dp = readdir(dirp)) {
|
||||
if (strcmp(dp->d_name, ".") && strcmp(dp->d_name, "..")) {
|
||||
closedir(dirp);
|
||||
return FALSE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
(void) closedir(dirp);
|
||||
return TRUE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return FALSE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Check if something is a regular file
|
||||
*/
|
||||
Boolean
|
||||
isfile(const char *fname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct stat sb;
|
||||
if (stat(fname, &sb) != FAIL && S_ISREG(sb.st_mode))
|
||||
return TRUE;
|
||||
return FALSE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Check to see if file is a file and is empty. If nonexistent or not
|
||||
* a file, say "it's empty", otherwise return TRUE if zero sized.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
Boolean
|
||||
isemptyfile(const char *fname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct stat sb;
|
||||
if (stat(fname, &sb) != FAIL && S_ISREG(sb.st_mode)) {
|
||||
if (sb.st_size != 0)
|
||||
return FALSE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return TRUE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* This struct defines the leading part of a valid URL name */
|
||||
typedef struct url_t {
|
||||
const char *u_s; /* the leading part of the URL */
|
||||
int u_len; /* its length */
|
||||
} url_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/* A table of valid leading strings for URLs */
|
||||
static const url_t urls[] = {
|
||||
#define STR_AND_SIZE(str) { str, sizeof(str) - 1 }
|
||||
STR_AND_SIZE("file://"),
|
||||
STR_AND_SIZE("ftp://"),
|
||||
STR_AND_SIZE("http://"),
|
||||
STR_AND_SIZE("https://"),
|
||||
#undef STR_AND_SIZE
|
||||
{NULL, 0}
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Returns length of leading part of any URL from urls table, or -1
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
URLlength(const char *fname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const url_t *up;
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
|
||||
if (fname != (char *) NULL) {
|
||||
for (i = 0; isspace((unsigned char) *fname); i++) {
|
||||
fname++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
for (up = urls; up->u_s; up++) {
|
||||
if (strncmp(fname, up->u_s, up->u_len) == 0) {
|
||||
return i + up->u_len; /* ... + sizeof(up->u_s); - HF */
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Takes a filename and package name, returning (in "try") the canonical
|
||||
* "preserve" name for it.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
Boolean
|
||||
make_preserve_name(char *try, size_t max, const char *name, const char *file)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t len, i;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((len = strlen(file)) == 0)
|
||||
return FALSE;
|
||||
i = len - 1;
|
||||
strncpy(try, file, max);
|
||||
if (try[i] == '/') /* Catch trailing slash early and save checking in the loop */
|
||||
--i;
|
||||
for (; i; i--) {
|
||||
if (try[i] == '/') {
|
||||
try[i + 1] = '.';
|
||||
strncpy(&try[i + 2], &file[i + 1], max - i - 2);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (!i) {
|
||||
try[0] = '.';
|
||||
strncpy(try + 1, file, max - 1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
/* I should probably be called rude names for these inline assignments */
|
||||
strncat(try, ".", max -= strlen(try));
|
||||
strncat(try, name, max -= strlen(name));
|
||||
strncat(try, ".", max--);
|
||||
strncat(try, "backup", max -= 6);
|
||||
return TRUE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
remove_files(const char *path, const char *pattern)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char fpath[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
glob_t globbed;
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
size_t j;
|
||||
|
||||
(void) snprintf(fpath, sizeof(fpath), "%s/%s", path, pattern);
|
||||
if ((i=glob(fpath, GLOB_NOSORT, NULL, &globbed)) != 0) {
|
||||
switch(i) {
|
||||
case GLOB_NOMATCH:
|
||||
warn("no files matching ``%s'' found", fpath);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case GLOB_ABORTED:
|
||||
warn("globbing aborted");
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case GLOB_NOSPACE:
|
||||
warn("out-of-memory during globbing");
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
warn("unknown error during globbing");
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* deleting globbed files */
|
||||
for (j = 0; j < globbed.gl_pathc; j++)
|
||||
if (unlink(globbed.gl_pathv[j]) < 0)
|
||||
warn("can't delete ``%s''", globbed.gl_pathv[j]);
|
||||
|
||||
return;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Using fmt, replace all instances of:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* %F With the parameter "name"
|
||||
* %D With the parameter "dir"
|
||||
* %B Return the directory part ("base") of %D/%F
|
||||
* %f Return the filename part of %D/%F
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Check that no overflows can occur.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
format_cmd(char *buf, size_t size, const char *fmt, const char *dir, const char *name)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t remaining, quoted;
|
||||
char *bufp, *tmp;
|
||||
char *cp;
|
||||
|
||||
for (bufp = buf, remaining = size; remaining > 1 && *fmt;) {
|
||||
if (*fmt != '%') {
|
||||
*bufp++ = *fmt++;
|
||||
--remaining;
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (*++fmt != 'D' && name == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("no last file available for '%s' command", buf);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
switch (*fmt) {
|
||||
case 'F':
|
||||
quoted = shquote(name, bufp, remaining);
|
||||
if (quoted >= remaining) {
|
||||
warnx("overflow during quoting");
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
bufp += quoted;
|
||||
remaining -= quoted;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'D':
|
||||
quoted = shquote(dir, bufp, remaining);
|
||||
if (quoted >= remaining) {
|
||||
warnx("overflow during quoting");
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
bufp += quoted;
|
||||
remaining -= quoted;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'B':
|
||||
tmp = xasprintf("%s/%s", dir, name);
|
||||
cp = strrchr(tmp, '/');
|
||||
*cp = '\0';
|
||||
quoted = shquote(tmp, bufp, remaining);
|
||||
free(tmp);
|
||||
if (quoted >= remaining) {
|
||||
warnx("overflow during quoting");
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
bufp += quoted;
|
||||
remaining -= quoted;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'f':
|
||||
tmp = xasprintf("%s/%s", dir, name);
|
||||
cp = strrchr(tmp, '/') + 1;
|
||||
quoted = shquote(cp, bufp, remaining);
|
||||
free(tmp);
|
||||
if (quoted >= remaining) {
|
||||
warnx("overflow during quoting");
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
bufp += quoted;
|
||||
remaining -= quoted;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
default:
|
||||
if (remaining == 1) {
|
||||
warnx("overflow during quoting");
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
*bufp++ = '%';
|
||||
*bufp++ = *fmt;
|
||||
remaining -= 2;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
++fmt;
|
||||
}
|
||||
*bufp = '\0';
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
38
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/global.c
vendored
Normal file
38
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/global.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,38 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: global.c,v 1.1.1.2 2009/02/02 20:44:06 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: global.c,v 1.1.1.2 2009/02/02 20:44:06 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Semi-convenient place to stick some needed globals.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* These are global for all utils */
|
||||
Boolean Verbose = FALSE;
|
||||
Boolean Fake = FALSE;
|
||||
Boolean Force = FALSE;
|
248
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/gpgsig.c
vendored
Normal file
248
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/gpgsig.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,248 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: gpgsig.c,v 1.1.1.2 2009/08/06 16:55:27 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: gpgsig.c,v 1.1.1.2 2009/08/06 16:55:27 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <sys/wait.h>
|
||||
#ifndef NETBSD
|
||||
#include <nbcompat/err.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef NETBSD
|
||||
#include <nbcompat/stdlib.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
verify_signature(const char *input, size_t input_len, const char *keyring,
|
||||
const char *detached_signature)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *argv[8], **argvp;
|
||||
pid_t child;
|
||||
int fd[2], status;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pipe(fd) == -1)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "cannot create input pipes");
|
||||
|
||||
child = vfork();
|
||||
if (child == -1)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "cannot fork GPG process");
|
||||
if (child == 0) {
|
||||
close(fd[1]);
|
||||
close(STDIN_FILENO);
|
||||
if (dup2(fd[0], STDIN_FILENO) == -1) {
|
||||
static const char err_msg[] =
|
||||
"cannot redirect stdin of GPG process\n";
|
||||
write(STDERR_FILENO, err_msg, sizeof(err_msg) - 1);
|
||||
_exit(255);
|
||||
}
|
||||
close(fd[0]);
|
||||
argvp = argv;
|
||||
*argvp++ = gpg_cmd;
|
||||
*argvp++ = "--verify";
|
||||
if (keyring != NULL) {
|
||||
*argvp++ = "--no-default-keyring";
|
||||
*argvp++ = "--keyring";
|
||||
*argvp++ = keyring;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (detached_signature != NULL)
|
||||
*argvp++ = detached_signature;
|
||||
*argvp++ = "-";
|
||||
|
||||
*argvp = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
execvp(gpg_cmd, __UNCONST(argv));
|
||||
_exit(255);
|
||||
}
|
||||
close(fd[0]);
|
||||
if (write(fd[1], input, input_len) != (ssize_t)input_len)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Short read from GPG");
|
||||
close(fd[1]);
|
||||
waitpid(child, &status, 0);
|
||||
if (status)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "GPG could not verify the signature");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
inline_gpg_verify(const char *content, size_t len, const char *keyring)
|
||||
{
|
||||
verify_signature(content, len, keyring, NULL);
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
detached_gpg_verify(const char *content, size_t len,
|
||||
const char *signature, size_t signature_len, const char *keyring)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int fd;
|
||||
const char *tmpdir;
|
||||
char *tempsig;
|
||||
ssize_t ret;
|
||||
|
||||
if (gpg_cmd == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("GPG variable not set, failing signature check");
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if ((tmpdir = getenv("TMPDIR")) == NULL)
|
||||
tmpdir = "/tmp";
|
||||
tempsig = xasprintf("%s/pkg_install.XXXXXX", tmpdir);
|
||||
|
||||
fd = mkstemp(tempsig);
|
||||
if (fd == -1) {
|
||||
warnx("Creating temporary file for GPG signature failed");
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
while (signature_len) {
|
||||
ret = write(fd, signature, signature_len);
|
||||
if (ret == -1)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "Write to GPG failed");
|
||||
if (ret == 0)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Short write to GPG");
|
||||
signature_len -= ret;
|
||||
signature += ret;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
verify_signature(content, len, keyring, tempsig);
|
||||
|
||||
unlink(tempsig);
|
||||
close(fd);
|
||||
free(tempsig);
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
detached_gpg_sign(const char *content, size_t len, char **sig, size_t *sig_len,
|
||||
const char *keyring, const char *user)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *argv[12], **argvp;
|
||||
pid_t child;
|
||||
int fd_in[2], fd_out[2], status;
|
||||
size_t allocated;
|
||||
ssize_t ret;
|
||||
|
||||
if (gpg_cmd == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "GPG variable not set");
|
||||
|
||||
if (pipe(fd_in) == -1)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "cannot create input pipes");
|
||||
if (pipe(fd_out) == -1)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "cannot create output pipes");
|
||||
|
||||
child = fork();
|
||||
if (child == -1)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "cannot fork GPG process");
|
||||
if (child == 0) {
|
||||
close(fd_in[1]);
|
||||
close(STDIN_FILENO);
|
||||
if (dup2(fd_in[0], STDIN_FILENO) == -1) {
|
||||
static const char err_msg[] =
|
||||
"cannot redirect stdin of GPG process\n";
|
||||
write(STDERR_FILENO, err_msg, sizeof(err_msg) - 1);
|
||||
_exit(255);
|
||||
}
|
||||
close(fd_in[0]);
|
||||
|
||||
close(fd_out[0]);
|
||||
close(STDOUT_FILENO);
|
||||
if (dup2(fd_out[1], STDOUT_FILENO) == -1) {
|
||||
static const char err_msg[] =
|
||||
"cannot redirect stdout of GPG process\n";
|
||||
write(STDERR_FILENO, err_msg, sizeof(err_msg) - 1);
|
||||
_exit(255);
|
||||
}
|
||||
close(fd_out[1]);
|
||||
|
||||
argvp = argv;
|
||||
*argvp++ = gpg_cmd;
|
||||
*argvp++ = "--detach-sign";
|
||||
*argvp++ = "--armor";
|
||||
*argvp++ = "--output";
|
||||
*argvp++ = "-";
|
||||
if (user != NULL) {
|
||||
*argvp++ = "--local-user";
|
||||
*argvp++ = user;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (keyring != NULL) {
|
||||
*argvp++ = "--no-default-keyring";
|
||||
*argvp++ = "--secret-keyring";
|
||||
*argvp++ = keyring;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
*argvp++ = "-";
|
||||
*argvp = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
execvp(gpg_cmd, __UNCONST(argv));
|
||||
_exit(255);
|
||||
}
|
||||
close(fd_in[0]);
|
||||
if (write(fd_in[1], content, len) != (ssize_t)len)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Short read from GPG");
|
||||
close(fd_in[1]);
|
||||
|
||||
allocated = 1024;
|
||||
*sig = xmalloc(allocated);
|
||||
*sig_len = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
close(fd_out[1]);
|
||||
|
||||
while ((ret = read(fd_out[0], *sig + *sig_len,
|
||||
allocated - *sig_len)) > 0) {
|
||||
*sig_len += ret;
|
||||
if (*sig_len == allocated) {
|
||||
allocated *= 2;
|
||||
*sig = xrealloc(*sig, allocated);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
close(fd_out[0]);
|
||||
|
||||
waitpid(child, &status, 0);
|
||||
if (status)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "GPG could not create signature");
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
485
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/iterate.c
vendored
Normal file
485
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/iterate.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,485 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: iterate.c,v 1.1.1.4 2010/01/30 21:33:47 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2007 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERRNO_H
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Generic iteration function:
|
||||
* - get new entries from srciter, stop on NULL
|
||||
* - call matchiter for those entries, stop on non-null return value.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
iterate_pkg_generic_src(int (*matchiter)(const char *, void *),
|
||||
void *match_cookie, const char *(*srciter)(void *), void *src_cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int retval;
|
||||
const char *entry;
|
||||
|
||||
retval = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
while ((entry = (*srciter)(src_cookie)) != NULL) {
|
||||
if ((retval = (*matchiter)(entry, match_cookie)) != 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return retval;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct pkg_dir_iter_arg {
|
||||
DIR *dirp;
|
||||
int filter_suffix;
|
||||
int allow_nonfiles;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static const char *
|
||||
pkg_dir_iter(void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct pkg_dir_iter_arg *arg = cookie;
|
||||
struct dirent *dp;
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
|
||||
while ((dp = readdir(arg->dirp)) != NULL) {
|
||||
#if defined(DT_UNKNOWN) && defined(DT_DIR)
|
||||
if (arg->allow_nonfiles == 0 &&
|
||||
dp->d_type != DT_UNKNOWN && dp->d_type != DT_REG)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
len = strlen(dp->d_name);
|
||||
/* .tbz or .tgz suffix length + some prefix*/
|
||||
if (len < 5)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (arg->filter_suffix == 0 ||
|
||||
memcmp(dp->d_name + len - 4, ".tgz", 4) == 0 ||
|
||||
memcmp(dp->d_name + len - 4, ".tbz", 4) == 0)
|
||||
return dp->d_name;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Call matchiter for every package in the directory.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
iterate_local_pkg_dir(const char *dir, int filter_suffix, int allow_nonfiles,
|
||||
int (*matchiter)(const char *, void *), void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct pkg_dir_iter_arg arg;
|
||||
int retval;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((arg.dirp = opendir(dir)) == NULL)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
|
||||
arg.filter_suffix = filter_suffix;
|
||||
arg.allow_nonfiles = allow_nonfiles;
|
||||
retval = iterate_pkg_generic_src(matchiter, cookie, pkg_dir_iter, &arg);
|
||||
|
||||
if (closedir(arg.dirp) == -1)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
return retval;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static const char *
|
||||
pkg_db_iter(void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
DIR *dirp = cookie;
|
||||
struct dirent *dp;
|
||||
|
||||
while ((dp = readdir(dirp)) != NULL) {
|
||||
if (strcmp(dp->d_name, ".") == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (strcmp(dp->d_name, "..") == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (strcmp(dp->d_name, "pkgdb.byfile.db") == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (strcmp(dp->d_name, ".cookie") == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (strcmp(dp->d_name, "pkg-vulnerabilities") == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
#if defined(DT_UNKNOWN) && defined(DT_DIR)
|
||||
if (dp->d_type != DT_UNKNOWN && dp->d_type != DT_DIR)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
return dp->d_name;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Call matchiter for every installed package.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
iterate_pkg_db(int (*matchiter)(const char *, void *), void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
DIR *dirp;
|
||||
int retval;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((dirp = opendir(pkgdb_get_dir())) == NULL) {
|
||||
if (errno == ENOENT)
|
||||
return 0; /* No pkgdb directory == empty pkgdb */
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
retval = iterate_pkg_generic_src(matchiter, cookie, pkg_db_iter, dirp);
|
||||
|
||||
if (closedir(dirp) == -1)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
return retval;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
match_by_basename(const char *pkg, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *target = cookie;
|
||||
const char *pkg_version;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((pkg_version = strrchr(pkg, '-')) == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("Entry %s in pkgdb is not a valid package name", pkg);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (strncmp(pkg, target, pkg_version - pkg) == 0 &&
|
||||
pkg + strlen(target) == pkg_version)
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
else
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
match_by_pattern(const char *pkg, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *pattern = cookie;
|
||||
|
||||
return pkg_match(pattern, pkg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct add_matching_arg {
|
||||
lpkg_head_t *pkghead;
|
||||
int got_match;
|
||||
int (*match_fn)(const char *pkg, void *cookie);
|
||||
void *cookie;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
match_and_add(const char *pkg, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct add_matching_arg *arg = cookie;
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((*arg->match_fn)(pkg, arg->cookie) == 1) {
|
||||
arg->got_match = 1;
|
||||
|
||||
lpp = alloc_lpkg(pkg);
|
||||
TAILQ_INSERT_TAIL(arg->pkghead, lpp, lp_link);
|
||||
}
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Find all installed packages with the given basename and add them
|
||||
* to pkghead.
|
||||
* Returns -1 on error, 0 if no match was found and 1 otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
add_installed_pkgs_by_basename(const char *pkgbase, lpkg_head_t *pkghead)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct add_matching_arg arg;
|
||||
|
||||
arg.pkghead = pkghead;
|
||||
arg.got_match = 0;
|
||||
arg.match_fn = match_by_basename;
|
||||
arg.cookie = __UNCONST(pkgbase);
|
||||
|
||||
if (iterate_pkg_db(match_and_add, &arg) == -1) {
|
||||
warnx("could not process pkgdb");
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return arg.got_match;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Match all installed packages against pattern, add the matches to pkghead.
|
||||
* Returns -1 on error, 0 if no match was found and 1 otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
add_installed_pkgs_by_pattern(const char *pattern, lpkg_head_t *pkghead)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct add_matching_arg arg;
|
||||
|
||||
arg.pkghead = pkghead;
|
||||
arg.got_match = 0;
|
||||
arg.match_fn = match_by_pattern;
|
||||
arg.cookie = __UNCONST(pattern);
|
||||
|
||||
if (iterate_pkg_db(match_and_add, &arg) == -1) {
|
||||
warnx("could not process pkgdb");
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return arg.got_match;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct best_installed_match_arg {
|
||||
const char *pattern;
|
||||
char *best_current_match;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
match_best_installed(const char *pkg, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct best_installed_match_arg *arg = cookie;
|
||||
|
||||
switch (pkg_order(arg->pattern, pkg, arg->best_current_match)) {
|
||||
case 0:
|
||||
case 2:
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Either current package doesn't match or
|
||||
* the older match is better. Nothing to do.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 1:
|
||||
/* Current package is better, remember it. */
|
||||
free(arg->best_current_match);
|
||||
arg->best_current_match = xstrdup(pkg);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Returns a copy of the name of best matching package.
|
||||
* If no package matched the pattern or an error occured, return NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *
|
||||
find_best_matching_installed_pkg(const char *pattern)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct best_installed_match_arg arg;
|
||||
|
||||
arg.pattern = pattern;
|
||||
arg.best_current_match = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
if (iterate_pkg_db(match_best_installed, &arg) == -1) {
|
||||
warnx("could not process pkgdb");
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return arg.best_current_match;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct call_matching_arg {
|
||||
const char *pattern;
|
||||
int (*call_fn)(const char *pkg, void *cookie);
|
||||
void *cookie;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
match_and_call(const char *pkg, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct call_matching_arg *arg = cookie;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkg_match(arg->pattern, pkg) == 1) {
|
||||
return (*arg->call_fn)(pkg, arg->cookie);
|
||||
} else
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Find all packages that match the given pattern and call the function
|
||||
* for each of them. Iteration stops if the callback return non-0.
|
||||
* Returns -1 on error, 0 if the iteration finished or whatever the
|
||||
* callback returned otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
match_installed_pkgs(const char *pattern, int (*cb)(const char *, void *),
|
||||
void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct call_matching_arg arg;
|
||||
|
||||
arg.pattern = pattern;
|
||||
arg.call_fn = cb;
|
||||
arg.cookie = cookie;
|
||||
|
||||
return iterate_pkg_db(match_and_call, &arg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct best_file_match_arg {
|
||||
const char *pattern;
|
||||
char *best_current_match_filtered;
|
||||
char *best_current_match;
|
||||
int filter_suffix;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
match_best_file(const char *filename, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct best_file_match_arg *arg = cookie;
|
||||
const char *active_filename;
|
||||
char *filtered_filename;
|
||||
|
||||
if (arg->filter_suffix) {
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
|
||||
len = strlen(filename);
|
||||
if (len < 5 ||
|
||||
(memcmp(filename + len - 4, ".tgz", 4) != 0 &&
|
||||
memcmp(filename + len - 4, ".tbz", 4) != 0)) {
|
||||
warnx("filename %s does not contain a recognized suffix", filename);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
filtered_filename = xmalloc(len - 4 + 1);
|
||||
memcpy(filtered_filename, filename, len - 4);
|
||||
filtered_filename[len - 4] = '\0';
|
||||
active_filename = filtered_filename;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
filtered_filename = NULL;
|
||||
active_filename = filename;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
switch (pkg_order(arg->pattern, active_filename, arg->best_current_match_filtered)) {
|
||||
case 0:
|
||||
case 2:
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Either current package doesn't match or
|
||||
* the older match is better. Nothing to do.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
free(filtered_filename);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
case 1:
|
||||
/* Current package is better, remember it. */
|
||||
free(arg->best_current_match);
|
||||
free(arg->best_current_match_filtered);
|
||||
arg->best_current_match = xstrdup(filename);
|
||||
if (filtered_filename != NULL)
|
||||
arg->best_current_match_filtered = filtered_filename;
|
||||
else
|
||||
arg->best_current_match_filtered = xstrdup(active_filename);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Invalid error from pkg_order");
|
||||
/* NOTREACHED */
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Returns a copy of the name of best matching file.
|
||||
* If no package matched the pattern or an error occured, return NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *
|
||||
find_best_matching_file(const char *dir, const char *pattern, int filter_suffix, int allow_nonfiles)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct best_file_match_arg arg;
|
||||
|
||||
arg.filter_suffix = filter_suffix;
|
||||
arg.pattern = pattern;
|
||||
arg.best_current_match = NULL;
|
||||
arg.best_current_match_filtered = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
if (iterate_local_pkg_dir(dir, filter_suffix, allow_nonfiles, match_best_file, &arg) == -1) {
|
||||
warnx("could not process directory");
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(arg.best_current_match_filtered);
|
||||
|
||||
return arg.best_current_match;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct call_matching_file_arg {
|
||||
const char *pattern;
|
||||
int (*call_fn)(const char *pkg, void *cookie);
|
||||
void *cookie;
|
||||
int filter_suffix;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
match_file_and_call(const char *filename, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct call_matching_file_arg *arg = cookie;
|
||||
const char *active_filename;
|
||||
char *filtered_filename;
|
||||
int ret;
|
||||
|
||||
if (arg->filter_suffix) {
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
|
||||
len = strlen(filename);
|
||||
if (len < 5 ||
|
||||
(memcmp(filename + len - 4, ".tgz", 4) != 0 &&
|
||||
memcmp(filename + len - 4, ".tbz", 4) != 0)) {
|
||||
warnx("filename %s does not contain a recognized suffix", filename);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
filtered_filename = xmalloc(len - 4 + 1);
|
||||
memcpy(filtered_filename, filename, len - 4);
|
||||
filtered_filename[len - 4] = '\0';
|
||||
active_filename = filtered_filename;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
filtered_filename = NULL;
|
||||
active_filename = filename;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
ret = pkg_match(arg->pattern, active_filename);
|
||||
free(filtered_filename);
|
||||
|
||||
if (ret == 1)
|
||||
return (*arg->call_fn)(filename, arg->cookie);
|
||||
else
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Find all packages that match the given pattern and call the function
|
||||
* for each of them. Iteration stops if the callback return non-0.
|
||||
* Returns -1 on error, 0 if the iteration finished or whatever the
|
||||
* callback returned otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
match_local_files(const char *dir, int filter_suffix, int allow_nonfiles, const char *pattern,
|
||||
int (*cb)(const char *, void *), void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct call_matching_file_arg arg;
|
||||
|
||||
arg.pattern = pattern;
|
||||
arg.call_fn = cb;
|
||||
arg.cookie = cookie;
|
||||
arg.filter_suffix = filter_suffix;
|
||||
|
||||
return iterate_local_pkg_dir(dir, filter_suffix, allow_nonfiles, match_file_and_call, &arg);
|
||||
}
|
457
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/lib.h
vendored
Normal file
457
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/lib.h
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,457 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: lib.h,v 1.6 2010/06/26 00:17:13 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/* from FreeBSD Id: lib.h,v 1.25 1997/10/08 07:48:03 charnier Exp */
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Include and define various things wanted by the library routines.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _INST_LIB_LIB_H_
|
||||
#define _INST_LIB_LIB_H_
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H
|
||||
#include <sys/param.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_STAT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/stat.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_FILE_H
|
||||
#include <sys/file.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_QUEUE_H
|
||||
#include <sys/queue.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CTYPE_H
|
||||
#include <ctype.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_DIRENT_H
|
||||
#include <dirent.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDIO_H
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDARG_H
|
||||
#include <stdarg.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_UNISTD_H
|
||||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Macros */
|
||||
#ifndef __UNCONST
|
||||
#define __UNCONST(a) ((void *)(unsigned long)(const void *)(a))
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define SUCCESS (0)
|
||||
#define FAIL (-1)
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef TRUE
|
||||
#define TRUE (1)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FALSE
|
||||
#define FALSE (0)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef OPSYS_NAME
|
||||
#define OPSYS_NAME "NetBSD"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef DEF_UMASK
|
||||
#define DEF_UMASK 022
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef PATH_MAX
|
||||
# ifdef MAXPATHLEN
|
||||
# define PATH_MAX MAXPATHLEN
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PATH_MAX 1024
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
enum {
|
||||
MaxPathSize = PATH_MAX
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* The names of our "special" files */
|
||||
#define CONTENTS_FNAME "+CONTENTS"
|
||||
#define COMMENT_FNAME "+COMMENT"
|
||||
#define DESC_FNAME "+DESC"
|
||||
#define INSTALL_FNAME "+INSTALL"
|
||||
#define DEINSTALL_FNAME "+DEINSTALL"
|
||||
#define REQUIRED_BY_FNAME "+REQUIRED_BY"
|
||||
#define REQUIRED_BY_FNAME_TMP "+REQUIRED_BY.tmp"
|
||||
#define DISPLAY_FNAME "+DISPLAY"
|
||||
#define MTREE_FNAME "+MTREE_DIRS"
|
||||
#define BUILD_VERSION_FNAME "+BUILD_VERSION"
|
||||
#define BUILD_INFO_FNAME "+BUILD_INFO"
|
||||
#define INSTALLED_INFO_FNAME "+INSTALLED_INFO"
|
||||
#define SIZE_PKG_FNAME "+SIZE_PKG"
|
||||
#define SIZE_ALL_FNAME "+SIZE_ALL"
|
||||
#define PRESERVE_FNAME "+PRESERVE"
|
||||
#define VIEWS_FNAME "+VIEWS"
|
||||
#define VIEWS_FNAME_TMP "+VIEWS.tmp"
|
||||
#define DEPOT_FNAME "+DEPOT"
|
||||
|
||||
/* The names of special variables */
|
||||
#define AUTOMATIC_VARNAME "automatic"
|
||||
|
||||
/* Prefix for extended PLIST cmd */
|
||||
#define CMD_CHAR '@'
|
||||
|
||||
/* The name of the "prefix" environment variable given to scripts */
|
||||
#define PKG_PREFIX_VNAME "PKG_PREFIX"
|
||||
|
||||
/* The name of the "destdir" environment variable given to scripts */
|
||||
#define PKG_DESTDIR_VNAME "PKG_DESTDIR"
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* The name of the "metadatadir" environment variable given to scripts.
|
||||
* This variable holds the location of the +-files for this package.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define PKG_METADATA_DIR_VNAME "PKG_METADATA_DIR"
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* The name of the environment variable holding the location to the
|
||||
* reference-counts database directory.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define PKG_REFCOUNT_DBDIR_VNAME "PKG_REFCOUNT_DBDIR"
|
||||
|
||||
#define PKG_PATTERN_MAX MaxPathSize /* max length of pattern, including nul */
|
||||
#define PKG_SUFFIX_MAX 10 /* max length of suffix, including nul */
|
||||
|
||||
enum {
|
||||
ReadWrite,
|
||||
ReadOnly
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Enumerated constants for plist entry types */
|
||||
typedef enum pl_ent_t {
|
||||
PLIST_SHOW_ALL = -1,
|
||||
PLIST_FILE, /* 0 */
|
||||
PLIST_CWD, /* 1 */
|
||||
PLIST_CMD, /* 2 */
|
||||
PLIST_CHMOD, /* 3 */
|
||||
PLIST_CHOWN, /* 4 */
|
||||
PLIST_CHGRP, /* 5 */
|
||||
PLIST_COMMENT, /* 6 */
|
||||
PLIST_IGNORE, /* 7 */
|
||||
PLIST_NAME, /* 8 */
|
||||
PLIST_UNEXEC, /* 9 */
|
||||
PLIST_SRC, /* 10 */
|
||||
PLIST_DISPLAY, /* 11 */
|
||||
PLIST_PKGDEP, /* 12 */
|
||||
PLIST_DIR_RM, /* 13 */
|
||||
PLIST_OPTION, /* 14 */
|
||||
PLIST_PKGCFL, /* 15 */
|
||||
PLIST_BLDDEP, /* 16 */
|
||||
PLIST_PKGDIR /* 17 */
|
||||
} pl_ent_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Enumerated constants for build info */
|
||||
typedef enum bi_ent_t {
|
||||
BI_OPSYS, /* 0 */
|
||||
BI_OS_VERSION, /* 1 */
|
||||
BI_MACHINE_ARCH, /* 2 */
|
||||
BI_IGNORE_RECOMMENDED, /* 3 */
|
||||
BI_USE_ABI_DEPENDS, /* 4 */
|
||||
BI_LICENSE, /* 5 */
|
||||
BI_PKGTOOLS_VERSION, /* 6 */
|
||||
BI_ENUM_COUNT /* 7 */
|
||||
} bi_ent_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Types */
|
||||
typedef unsigned int Boolean;
|
||||
|
||||
/* This structure describes a packing list entry */
|
||||
typedef struct plist_t {
|
||||
struct plist_t *prev; /* previous entry */
|
||||
struct plist_t *next; /* next entry */
|
||||
char *name; /* name of entry */
|
||||
Boolean marked; /* whether entry has been marked */
|
||||
pl_ent_t type; /* type of entry */
|
||||
} plist_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/* This structure describes a package's complete packing list */
|
||||
typedef struct package_t {
|
||||
plist_t *head; /* head of list */
|
||||
plist_t *tail; /* tail of list */
|
||||
} package_t;
|
||||
|
||||
#define SYMLINK_HEADER "Symlink:"
|
||||
#define CHECKSUM_HEADER "MD5:"
|
||||
|
||||
enum {
|
||||
ChecksumHeaderLen = 4, /* strlen(CHECKSUM_HEADER) */
|
||||
SymlinkHeaderLen = 8, /* strlen(SYMLINK_HEADER) */
|
||||
ChecksumLen = 16,
|
||||
LegibleChecksumLen = 33
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* List of files */
|
||||
typedef struct _lfile_t {
|
||||
TAILQ_ENTRY(_lfile_t) lf_link;
|
||||
char *lf_name;
|
||||
} lfile_t;
|
||||
TAILQ_HEAD(_lfile_head_t, _lfile_t);
|
||||
typedef struct _lfile_head_t lfile_head_t;
|
||||
#define LFILE_ADD(lfhead,lfp,str) do { \
|
||||
lfp = xmalloc(sizeof(lfile_t)); \
|
||||
lfp->lf_name = str; \
|
||||
TAILQ_INSERT_TAIL(lfhead,lfp,lf_link); \
|
||||
} while(0)
|
||||
|
||||
/* List of packages */
|
||||
typedef struct _lpkg_t {
|
||||
TAILQ_ENTRY(_lpkg_t) lp_link;
|
||||
char *lp_name;
|
||||
} lpkg_t;
|
||||
TAILQ_HEAD(_lpkg_head_t, _lpkg_t);
|
||||
typedef struct _lpkg_head_t lpkg_head_t;
|
||||
|
||||
struct pkg_vulnerabilities {
|
||||
size_t entries;
|
||||
char **vulnerability;
|
||||
char **classification;
|
||||
char **advisory;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* If URLlength()>0, then there is a ftp:// or http:// in the string,
|
||||
* and this must be an URL. Hide this behind a more obvious name. */
|
||||
#define IS_URL(str) (URLlength(str) > 0)
|
||||
|
||||
#define IS_STDIN(str) ((str) != NULL && !strcmp((str), "-"))
|
||||
#define IS_FULLPATH(str) ((str) != NULL && (str)[0] == '/')
|
||||
|
||||
/* Conflict handling (conflicts.c) */
|
||||
int some_installed_package_conflicts_with(const char *, const char *, char **, char **);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Prototypes */
|
||||
/* Misc */
|
||||
void show_version(void);
|
||||
int fexec(const char *, ...);
|
||||
int fexec_skipempty(const char *, ...);
|
||||
int fcexec(const char *, const char *, ...);
|
||||
int pfcexec(const char *, const char *, const char **);
|
||||
|
||||
/* variables file handling */
|
||||
|
||||
char *var_get(const char *, const char *);
|
||||
char *var_get_memory(const char *, const char *);
|
||||
int var_set(const char *, const char *, const char *);
|
||||
int var_copy_list(const char *, const char **);
|
||||
|
||||
/* automatically installed as dependency */
|
||||
|
||||
Boolean is_automatic_installed(const char *);
|
||||
int mark_as_automatic_installed(const char *, int);
|
||||
|
||||
/* String */
|
||||
const char *basename_of(const char *);
|
||||
const char *dirname_of(const char *);
|
||||
const char *suffix_of(const char *);
|
||||
int pkg_match(const char *, const char *);
|
||||
int pkg_order(const char *, const char *, const char *);
|
||||
int ispkgpattern(const char *);
|
||||
int quick_pkg_match(const char *, const char *);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Iterator functions */
|
||||
int iterate_pkg_generic_src(int (*)(const char *, void *), void *,
|
||||
const char *(*)(void *),void *);
|
||||
int iterate_local_pkg_dir(const char *, int, int, int (*)(const char *, void *),
|
||||
void *);
|
||||
int iterate_pkg_db(int (*)(const char *, void *), void *);
|
||||
|
||||
int add_installed_pkgs_by_basename(const char *, lpkg_head_t *);
|
||||
int add_installed_pkgs_by_pattern(const char *, lpkg_head_t *);
|
||||
char *find_best_matching_installed_pkg(const char *);
|
||||
char *find_best_matching_file(const char *, const char *, int, int);
|
||||
int match_installed_pkgs(const char *, int (*)(const char *, void *), void *);
|
||||
int match_local_files(const char *, int, int, const char *, int (*cb)(const char *, void *), void *);
|
||||
|
||||
/* File */
|
||||
Boolean fexists(const char *);
|
||||
Boolean isdir(const char *);
|
||||
Boolean islinktodir(const char *);
|
||||
Boolean isemptydir(const char *);
|
||||
Boolean isemptyfile(const char *);
|
||||
Boolean isfile(const char *);
|
||||
Boolean isbrokenlink(const char *);
|
||||
Boolean isempty(const char *);
|
||||
int URLlength(const char *);
|
||||
Boolean make_preserve_name(char *, size_t, const char *, const char *);
|
||||
void remove_files(const char *, const char *);
|
||||
int format_cmd(char *, size_t, const char *, const char *, const char *);
|
||||
|
||||
int recursive_remove(const char *, int);
|
||||
|
||||
void add_pkgdir(const char *, const char *, const char *);
|
||||
void delete_pkgdir(const char *, const char *, const char *);
|
||||
int has_pkgdir(const char *);
|
||||
|
||||
/* pkg_io.c: Local and remote archive handling */
|
||||
struct archive;
|
||||
struct archive_entry;
|
||||
|
||||
struct archive *open_archive(const char *, char **);
|
||||
struct archive *find_archive(const char *, int, char **);
|
||||
void process_pkg_path(void);
|
||||
struct url *find_best_package(const char *, const char *, int);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Packing list */
|
||||
plist_t *new_plist_entry(void);
|
||||
plist_t *last_plist(package_t *);
|
||||
plist_t *find_plist(package_t *, pl_ent_t);
|
||||
char *find_plist_option(package_t *, const char *);
|
||||
void plist_delete(package_t *, Boolean, pl_ent_t, char *);
|
||||
void free_plist(package_t *);
|
||||
void mark_plist(package_t *);
|
||||
void csum_plist_entry(char *, plist_t *);
|
||||
void add_plist(package_t *, pl_ent_t, const char *);
|
||||
void add_plist_top(package_t *, pl_ent_t, const char *);
|
||||
void delete_plist(package_t *, Boolean, pl_ent_t, char *);
|
||||
void write_plist(package_t *, FILE *, char *);
|
||||
void stringify_plist(package_t *, char **, size_t *, const char *);
|
||||
void parse_plist(package_t *, const char *);
|
||||
void read_plist(package_t *, FILE *);
|
||||
void append_plist(package_t *, FILE *);
|
||||
int delete_package(Boolean, package_t *, Boolean, const char *);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Package Database */
|
||||
int pkgdb_open(int);
|
||||
void pkgdb_close(void);
|
||||
int pkgdb_store(const char *, const char *);
|
||||
char *pkgdb_retrieve(const char *);
|
||||
int pkgdb_dump(void);
|
||||
int pkgdb_remove(const char *);
|
||||
int pkgdb_remove_pkg(const char *);
|
||||
char *pkgdb_refcount_dir(void);
|
||||
char *pkgdb_get_database(void);
|
||||
const char *pkgdb_get_dir(void);
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Priorities:
|
||||
* 0 builtin default
|
||||
* 1 config file
|
||||
* 2 environment
|
||||
* 3 command line
|
||||
* 4 destdir/views reset
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void pkgdb_set_dir(const char *, int);
|
||||
char *pkgdb_pkg_dir(const char *);
|
||||
char *pkgdb_pkg_file(const char *, const char *);
|
||||
|
||||
/* List of packages functions */
|
||||
lpkg_t *alloc_lpkg(const char *);
|
||||
lpkg_t *find_on_queue(lpkg_head_t *, const char *);
|
||||
void free_lpkg(lpkg_t *);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Read pkg_vulnerabilities from file */
|
||||
struct pkg_vulnerabilities *read_pkg_vulnerabilities_file(const char *, int, int);
|
||||
/* Read pkg_vulnerabilities from memory */
|
||||
struct pkg_vulnerabilities *read_pkg_vulnerabilities_memory(void *, size_t, int);
|
||||
void free_pkg_vulnerabilities(struct pkg_vulnerabilities *);
|
||||
int audit_package(struct pkg_vulnerabilities *, const char *, const char *,
|
||||
int);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Parse configuration file */
|
||||
void pkg_install_config(void);
|
||||
/* Print configuration variable */
|
||||
void pkg_install_show_variable(const char *);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Package signature creation and validation */
|
||||
int pkg_verify_signature(const char *, struct archive **, struct archive_entry **, char **);
|
||||
int pkg_full_signature_check(const char *, struct archive **);
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_SSL
|
||||
void pkg_sign_x509(const char *, const char *, const char *, const char *);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
void pkg_sign_gpg(const char *, const char *);
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_SSL
|
||||
/* PKCS7 signing/verification */
|
||||
int easy_pkcs7_verify(const char *, size_t, const char *, size_t,
|
||||
const char *, int);
|
||||
int easy_pkcs7_sign(const char *, size_t, char **, size_t *, const char *,
|
||||
const char *);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
int inline_gpg_verify(const char *, size_t, const char *);
|
||||
int detached_gpg_verify(const char *, size_t, const char *, size_t,
|
||||
const char *);
|
||||
int detached_gpg_sign(const char *, size_t, char **, size_t *, const char *,
|
||||
const char *);
|
||||
|
||||
/* License handling */
|
||||
int add_licenses(const char *);
|
||||
int acceptable_license(const char *);
|
||||
int acceptable_pkg_license(const char *);
|
||||
void load_license_lists(void);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Helper functions for memory allocation */
|
||||
char *xstrdup(const char *);
|
||||
void *xrealloc(void *, size_t);
|
||||
void *xcalloc(size_t, size_t);
|
||||
void *xmalloc(size_t);
|
||||
char *xasprintf(const char *, ...);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Externs */
|
||||
extern Boolean Verbose;
|
||||
extern Boolean Fake;
|
||||
extern Boolean Force;
|
||||
extern const char *cert_chain_file;
|
||||
extern const char *certs_packages;
|
||||
extern const char *certs_pkg_vulnerabilities;
|
||||
extern const char *check_eol;
|
||||
extern const char *check_vulnerabilities;
|
||||
extern const char *config_file;
|
||||
extern const char *config_pkg_dbdir;
|
||||
extern const char *config_pkg_path;
|
||||
extern const char *config_pkg_refcount_dbdir;
|
||||
extern const char *do_license_check;
|
||||
extern const char *verified_installation;
|
||||
extern const char *gpg_cmd;
|
||||
extern const char *gpg_keyring_pkgvuln;
|
||||
extern const char *gpg_keyring_sign;
|
||||
extern const char *gpg_keyring_verify;
|
||||
extern const char *gpg_sign_as;
|
||||
extern char fetch_flags[];
|
||||
|
||||
extern const char *pkg_vulnerabilities_dir;
|
||||
extern const char *pkg_vulnerabilities_file;
|
||||
extern const char *pkg_vulnerabilities_url;
|
||||
extern const char *ignore_advisories;
|
||||
extern const char tnf_vulnerability_base[];
|
||||
|
||||
extern const char *acceptable_licenses;
|
||||
extern const char *default_acceptable_licenses;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _INST_LIB_LIB_H_ */
|
318
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/license.c
vendored
Normal file
318
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/license.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,318 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: license.c,v 1.4 2013/04/20 15:29:23 wiz Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2009 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#define HASH_SIZE 521
|
||||
|
||||
const char *default_acceptable_licenses =
|
||||
"apache-1.1 apache-2.0 "
|
||||
"arphic-public "
|
||||
"artistic artistic-2.0 "
|
||||
"boost-license "
|
||||
"cc-by-sa-v3.0 "
|
||||
"cddl-1.0 "
|
||||
"cpl-1.0 "
|
||||
"epl-v1.0 "
|
||||
"gnu-fdl-v1.1 gnu-fdl-v1.2 gnu-fdl-v1.3 "
|
||||
"gnu-gpl-v1 "
|
||||
"gnu-gpl-v2 gnu-lgpl-v2 gnu-lgpl-v2.1 "
|
||||
"gnu-gpl-v3 gnu-lgpl-v3 "
|
||||
"ibm-public-license-1.0 "
|
||||
"ipafont "
|
||||
"isc "
|
||||
"lppl-1.3c "
|
||||
"lucent "
|
||||
"miros "
|
||||
"mit "
|
||||
"mpl-1.0 mpl-1.1 mpl-2.0 "
|
||||
"mplusfont "
|
||||
"ofl-v1.0 ofl-v1.1 "
|
||||
"original-bsd modified-bsd 2-clause-bsd "
|
||||
"php "
|
||||
"png-license "
|
||||
"postgresql-license "
|
||||
"public-domain "
|
||||
"python-software-foundation "
|
||||
"qpl-v1.0 "
|
||||
"sleepycat-public "
|
||||
"unlicense "
|
||||
"x11 "
|
||||
"zlib "
|
||||
"zpl";
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef DEBUG
|
||||
static size_t hash_collisions;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
static char **license_hash[HASH_SIZE];
|
||||
static const char license_spaces[] = " \t\n";
|
||||
static const char license_chars[] =
|
||||
"ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZabcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz0123456789_-.";
|
||||
|
||||
static size_t
|
||||
hash_license(const char *license, size_t len)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t hash;
|
||||
|
||||
for (hash = 0; *license && len; ++license, --len)
|
||||
hash = *license + hash * 32;
|
||||
return hash % HASH_SIZE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
add_license_internal(const char *license, size_t len)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *new_license;
|
||||
size_t slot, i;
|
||||
|
||||
slot = hash_license(license, len);
|
||||
|
||||
new_license = malloc(len + 1);
|
||||
memcpy(new_license, license, len);
|
||||
new_license[len] = '\0';
|
||||
|
||||
if (license_hash[slot] == NULL) {
|
||||
license_hash[slot] = calloc(sizeof(char *), 2);
|
||||
license_hash[slot][0] = new_license;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
for (i = 0; license_hash[slot][i]; ++i) {
|
||||
if (!memcmp(license_hash[slot][i], license, len) &&
|
||||
license_hash[slot][i][len] == '\0') {
|
||||
free(new_license);
|
||||
return;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef DEBUG
|
||||
++hash_collisions;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
license_hash[slot] = realloc(license_hash[slot],
|
||||
sizeof(char *) * (i + 2));
|
||||
license_hash[slot][i] = new_license;
|
||||
license_hash[slot][i + 1] = NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
add_licenses(const char *line)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *next;
|
||||
|
||||
if (line == NULL)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
for (line += strspn(line, license_spaces); line; ) {
|
||||
next = line + strspn(line, license_chars);
|
||||
if (next == line)
|
||||
return *line ? -1 : 0;
|
||||
add_license_internal(line, next - line);
|
||||
line = next + strspn(next, license_spaces);
|
||||
if (next == line)
|
||||
return *line ? -1 : 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
acceptable_license_internal(const char *license, size_t len)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t slot, i;
|
||||
|
||||
slot = hash_license(license, len);
|
||||
|
||||
if (license_hash[slot] == NULL)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; license_hash[slot][i]; ++i) {
|
||||
if (strncmp(license_hash[slot][i], license, len) == 0 &&
|
||||
license_hash[slot][i][len] == '\0')
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
acceptable_license(const char *license)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
|
||||
len = strlen(license);
|
||||
if (strspn(license, license_chars) != len) {
|
||||
warnx("Invalid character in license name at position %" PRIzu, len);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return acceptable_license_internal(license, len);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
acceptable_pkg_license_internal(const char **licensep, int toplevel, const char *start)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *license = *licensep;
|
||||
int need_parenthesis, is_true = 0;
|
||||
int expr_type = 0; /* 0: unset, 1: or, 2: and */
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
|
||||
license += strspn(license, license_spaces);
|
||||
|
||||
if (*license == '(' && !toplevel) {
|
||||
need_parenthesis = 1;
|
||||
++license;
|
||||
license += strspn(license, license_spaces);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
need_parenthesis = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
for (;;) {
|
||||
if (*license == '(') {
|
||||
switch (acceptable_pkg_license_internal(&license, 0, start)) {
|
||||
case -1:
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
case 0:
|
||||
if (expr_type == 2)
|
||||
is_true = 0;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 1:
|
||||
is_true = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
license += strspn(license, license_spaces);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
len = strspn(license, license_chars);
|
||||
if (len == 0) {
|
||||
warnx("Invalid character in license name at position %" PRIzu, license - start + 1);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (acceptable_license_internal(license, len)) {
|
||||
if (expr_type != 2)
|
||||
is_true = 1;
|
||||
} else if (expr_type == 2) {
|
||||
is_true = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
license += len;
|
||||
|
||||
len = strspn(license, license_spaces);
|
||||
if (len == 0 && *license && *license != ')') {
|
||||
warnx("Missing space at position %" PRIzu, license - start + 1);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
license += len;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (*license == ')') {
|
||||
if (!need_parenthesis) {
|
||||
warnx("Missing open parenthesis at position %" PRIzu, license - start + 1);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
*licensep = license + 1;
|
||||
return is_true;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (*license == '\0') {
|
||||
if (need_parenthesis) {
|
||||
warnx("Unbalanced parenthesis at position %" PRIzu, license - start + 1);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
*licensep = license;
|
||||
return is_true;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (strncmp(license, "AND", 3) == 0) {
|
||||
if (expr_type == 1) {
|
||||
warnx("Invalid operator in OR expression at position %" PRIzu, license - start + 1);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
expr_type = 2;
|
||||
license += 3;
|
||||
} else if (strncmp(license, "OR", 2) == 0) {
|
||||
if (expr_type == 2) {
|
||||
warnx("Invalid operator in AND expression at position %" PRIzu, license - start + 1);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
expr_type = 1;
|
||||
license += 2;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
warnx("Invalid operator at position %" PRIzu, license - start + 1);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
len = strspn(license, license_spaces);
|
||||
if (len == 0 && *license != '(') {
|
||||
warnx("Missing space at position %" PRIzu, license - start + 1);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
license += len;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
acceptable_pkg_license(const char *license)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int ret;
|
||||
|
||||
ret = acceptable_pkg_license_internal(&license, 1, license);
|
||||
if (ret == -1)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
license += strspn(license, license_spaces);
|
||||
if (*license) {
|
||||
warnx("Trailing garbage in license specification");
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return ret;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
load_license_lists(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (add_licenses(getenv("PKGSRC_ACCEPTABLE_LICENSES")))
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "syntax error in PKGSRC_ACCEPTABLE_LICENSES");
|
||||
if (add_licenses(acceptable_licenses))
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "syntax error in ACCEPTABLE_LICENSES");
|
||||
if (add_licenses(getenv("PKGSRC_DEFAULT_ACCEPTABLE_LICENSES")))
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "syntax error in PKGSRC_DEFAULT_ACCEPTABLE_LICENSES");
|
||||
if (add_licenses(default_acceptable_licenses))
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "syntax error in DEFAULT_ACCEPTABLE_LICENSES");
|
||||
}
|
70
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/lpkg.c
vendored
Normal file
70
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/lpkg.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,70 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: lpkg.c,v 1.1.1.2 2009/02/02 20:44:06 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 1999 Christian E. Hopps
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
* 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote products
|
||||
* derived from this software without specific prior written permission
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR
|
||||
* IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
|
||||
* OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED.
|
||||
* IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
|
||||
* NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
|
||||
* DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
|
||||
* THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
|
||||
* (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Package-list auxiliary functions
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Add a package to the (add/recursive delete) list
|
||||
*/
|
||||
lpkg_t *
|
||||
alloc_lpkg(const char *pkgname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp;
|
||||
|
||||
lpp = xmalloc(sizeof(*lpp));
|
||||
lpp->lp_name = xstrdup(pkgname);
|
||||
return (lpp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
free_lpkg(lpkg_t *lpp)
|
||||
{
|
||||
free(lpp->lp_name);
|
||||
free(lpp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
lpkg_t *
|
||||
find_on_queue(lpkg_head_t *qp, const char *name)
|
||||
{
|
||||
lpkg_t *lpp;
|
||||
|
||||
for (lpp = TAILQ_FIRST(qp); lpp; lpp = TAILQ_NEXT(lpp, lp_link))
|
||||
if (!strcmp(name, lpp->lp_name))
|
||||
return (lpp);
|
||||
return (0);
|
||||
}
|
213
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/opattern.c
vendored
Normal file
213
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/opattern.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,213 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: opattern.c,v 1.1.1.3 2012/02/19 17:46:47 tron Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: opattern.c,v 1.1.1.3 2012/02/19 17:46:47 tron Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Miscellaneous string utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ASSERT_H
|
||||
#include <assert.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_FNMATCH_H
|
||||
#include <fnmatch.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
#include "dewey.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* pull in definitions and macros for resizing arrays as we go */
|
||||
#include "defs.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Perform alternate match on "pkg" against "pattern",
|
||||
* calling pkg_match (recursively) to resolve any other patterns.
|
||||
* Return 1 on match, 0 otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
alternate_match(const char *pattern, const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *sep;
|
||||
char buf[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
char *last;
|
||||
char *alt;
|
||||
char *cp;
|
||||
int cnt;
|
||||
int found;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((sep = strchr(pattern, '{')) == (char *) NULL) {
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "alternate_match(): '{' expected in `%s'", pattern);
|
||||
}
|
||||
(void) strncpy(buf, pattern, (size_t) (sep - pattern));
|
||||
alt = &buf[sep - pattern];
|
||||
last = (char *) NULL;
|
||||
for (cnt = 0, cp = sep; *cp && last == (char *) NULL; cp++) {
|
||||
if (*cp == '{') {
|
||||
cnt++;
|
||||
} else if (*cp == '}' && --cnt == 0 && last == (char *) NULL) {
|
||||
last = cp + 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (cnt != 0) {
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Malformed alternate `%s'", pattern);
|
||||
}
|
||||
for (found = 0, cp = sep + 1; *sep != '}'; cp = sep + 1) {
|
||||
for (cnt = 0, sep = cp; cnt > 0 || (cnt == 0 && *sep != '}' && *sep != ','); sep++) {
|
||||
if (*sep == '{') {
|
||||
cnt++;
|
||||
} else if (*sep == '}') {
|
||||
cnt--;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
(void) snprintf(alt, sizeof(buf) - (alt - buf), "%.*s%s", (int) (sep - cp), cp, last);
|
||||
if (pkg_match(buf, pkg) == 1) {
|
||||
found = 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
return found;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Perform glob match on "pkg" against "pattern".
|
||||
* Return 1 on match, 0 otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
glob_match(const char *pattern, const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return fnmatch(pattern, pkg, FNM_PERIOD) == 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Perform simple match on "pkg" against "pattern".
|
||||
* Return 1 on match, 0 otherwise
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
simple_match(const char *pattern, const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return strcmp(pattern, pkg) == 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Performs a fast check if pattern can ever match pkg.
|
||||
* Returns 1 if a match is possible and 0 otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
quick_pkg_match(const char *pattern, const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
#define simple(x) (isalnum((unsigned char)(x)) || (x) == '-')
|
||||
if (!simple(pattern[0]))
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
if (pattern[0] != pkg[0])
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!simple(pattern[1]))
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
if (pattern[1] != pkg[1])
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
#undef simple
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Match pkg against pattern, return 1 if matching, 0 else
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
pkg_match(const char *pattern, const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (!quick_pkg_match(pattern, pkg))
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (strchr(pattern, '{') != (char *) NULL) {
|
||||
/* emulate csh-type alternates */
|
||||
return alternate_match(pattern, pkg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (strpbrk(pattern, "<>") != (char *) NULL) {
|
||||
int ret;
|
||||
|
||||
/* perform relational dewey match on version number */
|
||||
ret = dewey_match(pattern, pkg);
|
||||
if (ret < 0)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "dewey_match returned error");
|
||||
return ret;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (strpbrk(pattern, "*?[]") != (char *) NULL) {
|
||||
/* glob match */
|
||||
if (glob_match(pattern, pkg))
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* no alternate, dewey or glob match -> simple compare */
|
||||
if (simple_match(pattern, pkg))
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
|
||||
/* globbing patterns and simple matches may be specified with or
|
||||
* without the version number, so check for both cases. */
|
||||
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *pattern_ver;
|
||||
int retval;
|
||||
|
||||
pattern_ver = xasprintf("%s-[0-9]*", pattern);
|
||||
retval = glob_match(pattern_ver, pkg);
|
||||
free(pattern_ver);
|
||||
return retval;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
pkg_order(const char *pattern, const char *first_pkg, const char *second_pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *first_version;
|
||||
const char *second_version;
|
||||
|
||||
if (first_pkg == NULL && second_pkg == NULL)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (first_pkg == NULL)
|
||||
return pkg_match(pattern, second_pkg) ? 2 : 0;
|
||||
if (second_pkg == NULL)
|
||||
return pkg_match(pattern, first_pkg) ? 1 : 0;
|
||||
|
||||
first_version = strrchr(first_pkg, '-');
|
||||
second_version = strrchr(second_pkg, '-');
|
||||
|
||||
if (first_version == NULL || !pkg_match(pattern, first_pkg))
|
||||
return pkg_match(pattern, second_pkg) ? 2 : 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (second_version == NULL || !pkg_match(pattern, second_pkg))
|
||||
return pkg_match(pattern, first_pkg) ? 1 : 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (dewey_cmp(first_version + 1, DEWEY_GT, second_version + 1))
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
else if (dewey_cmp(first_version + 1, DEWEY_LT, second_version + 1))
|
||||
return 2;
|
||||
else if (strcmp(first_pkg, second_pkg) < 0)
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
else
|
||||
return 2;
|
||||
}
|
271
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/parse-config.c
vendored
Normal file
271
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/parse-config.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,271 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: parse-config.c,v 1.1.1.11 2010/06/26 00:14:31 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: parse-config.c,v 1.1.1.11 2010/06/26 00:14:31 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008, 2009 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef BOOTSTRAP
|
||||
#include <fetch.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static int cache_connections = 16;
|
||||
static int cache_connections_host = 4;
|
||||
|
||||
const char *config_file = SYSCONFDIR"/pkg_install.conf";
|
||||
|
||||
char fetch_flags[10] = ""; /* Workaround Mac OS X linker issues with BSS */
|
||||
static const char *active_ftp;
|
||||
static const char *verbose_netio;
|
||||
static const char *ignore_proxy;
|
||||
const char *cache_index = "yes";
|
||||
const char *cert_chain_file;
|
||||
const char *certs_packages;
|
||||
const char *certs_pkg_vulnerabilities;
|
||||
const char *check_eol = "yes";
|
||||
const char *check_vulnerabilities;
|
||||
static const char *config_cache_connections;
|
||||
static const char *config_cache_connections_host;
|
||||
const char *config_pkg_dbdir;
|
||||
const char *config_pkg_path;
|
||||
const char *config_pkg_refcount_dbdir;
|
||||
const char *do_license_check;
|
||||
const char *verified_installation;
|
||||
const char *gpg_cmd;
|
||||
const char *gpg_keyring_pkgvuln;
|
||||
const char *gpg_keyring_sign;
|
||||
const char *gpg_keyring_verify;
|
||||
const char *gpg_sign_as;
|
||||
const char *pkg_vulnerabilities_dir;
|
||||
const char *pkg_vulnerabilities_file;
|
||||
const char *pkg_vulnerabilities_url;
|
||||
const char *ignore_advisories = NULL;
|
||||
const char tnf_vulnerability_base[] = "http://ftp.NetBSD.org/pub/NetBSD/packages/vulns";
|
||||
const char *acceptable_licenses = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
static struct config_variable {
|
||||
const char *name;
|
||||
const char **var;
|
||||
} config_variables[] = {
|
||||
{ "ACCEPTABLE_LICENSES", &acceptable_licenses },
|
||||
{ "ACTIVE_FTP", &active_ftp },
|
||||
{ "CACHE_INDEX", &cache_index },
|
||||
{ "CACHE_CONNECTIONS", &config_cache_connections },
|
||||
{ "CACHE_CONNECTIONS_HOST", &config_cache_connections_host },
|
||||
{ "CERTIFICATE_ANCHOR_PKGS", &certs_packages },
|
||||
{ "CERTIFICATE_ANCHOR_PKGVULN", &certs_pkg_vulnerabilities },
|
||||
{ "CERTIFICATE_CHAIN", &cert_chain_file },
|
||||
{ "CHECK_LICENSE", &do_license_check },
|
||||
{ "CHECK_END_OF_LIFE", &check_eol },
|
||||
{ "CHECK_VULNERABILITIES", &check_vulnerabilities },
|
||||
{ "DEFAULT_ACCEPTABLE_LICENSES", &default_acceptable_licenses },
|
||||
{ "GPG", &gpg_cmd },
|
||||
{ "GPG_KEYRING_PKGVULN", &gpg_keyring_pkgvuln },
|
||||
{ "GPG_KEYRING_SIGN", &gpg_keyring_sign },
|
||||
{ "GPG_KEYRING_VERIFY", &gpg_keyring_verify },
|
||||
{ "GPG_SIGN_AS", &gpg_sign_as },
|
||||
{ "IGNORE_PROXY", &ignore_proxy },
|
||||
{ "IGNORE_URL", &ignore_advisories },
|
||||
{ "PKG_DBDIR", &config_pkg_dbdir },
|
||||
{ "PKG_PATH", &config_pkg_path },
|
||||
{ "PKG_REFCOUNT_DBDIR", &config_pkg_refcount_dbdir },
|
||||
{ "PKGVULNDIR", &pkg_vulnerabilities_dir },
|
||||
{ "PKGVULNURL", &pkg_vulnerabilities_url },
|
||||
{ "VERBOSE_NETIO", &verbose_netio },
|
||||
{ "VERIFIED_INSTALLATION", &verified_installation },
|
||||
{ NULL, NULL }, /* For use by pkg_install_show_variable */
|
||||
{ NULL, NULL }
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
char *config_tmp_variables[sizeof config_variables/sizeof config_variables[0]];
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
parse_pkg_install_conf(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct config_variable *var;
|
||||
FILE *fp;
|
||||
char *line, *value;
|
||||
size_t len, var_len, i;
|
||||
|
||||
fp = fopen(config_file, "r");
|
||||
if (!fp) {
|
||||
if (errno != ENOENT)
|
||||
warn("Can't open '%s' for reading", config_file);
|
||||
return;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
while ((line = fgetln(fp, &len)) != (char *) NULL) {
|
||||
if (line[len - 1] == '\n')
|
||||
--len;
|
||||
for (i = 0; (var = &config_variables[i])->name != NULL; ++i) {
|
||||
var_len = strlen(var->name);
|
||||
if (strncmp(var->name, line, var_len) != 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (line[var_len] != '=')
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
line += var_len + 1;
|
||||
len -= var_len + 1;
|
||||
if (config_tmp_variables[i])
|
||||
value = xasprintf("%s\n%.*s",
|
||||
config_tmp_variables[i], (int)len, line);
|
||||
else
|
||||
value = xasprintf("%.*s", (int)len, line);
|
||||
free(config_tmp_variables[i]);
|
||||
config_tmp_variables[i] = value;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; (var = &config_variables[i])->name != NULL; ++i) {
|
||||
if (config_tmp_variables[i] == NULL)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
*var->var = config_tmp_variables[i];
|
||||
config_tmp_variables[i] = NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
pkg_install_config(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int do_cache_index;
|
||||
char *value;
|
||||
|
||||
parse_pkg_install_conf();
|
||||
|
||||
if ((value = getenv("PKG_DBDIR")) != NULL)
|
||||
pkgdb_set_dir(value, 2);
|
||||
else if (config_pkg_dbdir != NULL)
|
||||
pkgdb_set_dir(config_pkg_dbdir, 1);
|
||||
config_pkg_dbdir = xstrdup(pkgdb_get_dir());
|
||||
|
||||
if ((value = getenv("PKG_REFCOUNT_DBDIR")) != NULL)
|
||||
config_pkg_refcount_dbdir = value;
|
||||
else if (config_pkg_refcount_dbdir == NULL)
|
||||
config_pkg_refcount_dbdir = xasprintf("%s.refcount",
|
||||
pkgdb_get_dir());
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkg_vulnerabilities_dir == NULL)
|
||||
pkg_vulnerabilities_dir = pkgdb_get_dir();
|
||||
pkg_vulnerabilities_file = xasprintf("%s/pkg-vulnerabilities",
|
||||
pkg_vulnerabilities_dir);
|
||||
if (pkg_vulnerabilities_url == NULL) {
|
||||
pkg_vulnerabilities_url = xasprintf("%s/pkg-vulnerabilities.gz",
|
||||
tnf_vulnerability_base);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (verified_installation == NULL)
|
||||
verified_installation = "never";
|
||||
|
||||
if (check_vulnerabilities == NULL)
|
||||
check_vulnerabilities = "never";
|
||||
|
||||
if (do_license_check == NULL)
|
||||
do_license_check = "no";
|
||||
|
||||
if ((value = getenv("PKG_PATH")) != NULL)
|
||||
config_pkg_path = value;
|
||||
|
||||
if (strcasecmp(cache_index, "yes") == 0)
|
||||
do_cache_index = 1;
|
||||
else {
|
||||
if (strcasecmp(cache_index, "no"))
|
||||
warnx("Invalid value for configuration option "
|
||||
"CACHE_INDEX");
|
||||
do_cache_index = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (config_cache_connections && *config_cache_connections) {
|
||||
long v = strtol(config_cache_connections, &value, 10);
|
||||
if (*value == '\0') {
|
||||
if (v >= INT_MAX || v < 0)
|
||||
v = -1;
|
||||
cache_connections = v;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
config_cache_connections = xasprintf("%d", cache_connections);
|
||||
|
||||
if (config_cache_connections_host) {
|
||||
long v = strtol(config_cache_connections_host, &value, 10);
|
||||
if (*value == '\0') {
|
||||
if (v >= INT_MAX || v < 0)
|
||||
v = -1;
|
||||
cache_connections_host = v;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
config_cache_connections_host = xasprintf("%d", cache_connections_host);
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef BOOTSTRAP
|
||||
fetchConnectionCacheInit(cache_connections, cache_connections_host);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
snprintf(fetch_flags, sizeof(fetch_flags), "%s%s%s%s",
|
||||
(do_cache_index) ? "c" : "",
|
||||
(verbose_netio && *verbose_netio) ? "v" : "",
|
||||
(active_ftp && *active_ftp) ? "a" : "",
|
||||
(ignore_proxy && *ignore_proxy) ? "d" : "");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
pkg_install_show_variable(const char *var_name)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct config_variable *var;
|
||||
const char *tmp_value = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
for (var = config_variables; var->name != NULL; ++var) {
|
||||
if (strcmp(var->name, var_name) == 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (var->name == NULL) {
|
||||
var->name = var_name;
|
||||
var->var = &tmp_value;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
pkg_install_config();
|
||||
|
||||
if (*var->var != NULL)
|
||||
puts(*var->var);
|
||||
}
|
332
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkcs7.c
vendored
Normal file
332
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkcs7.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,332 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: pkcs7.c,v 1.1.1.4 2009/08/06 16:55:27 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: pkcs7.c,v 1.1.1.4 2009/08/06 16:55:27 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2004, 2008 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
* by Love Hörnquist Åstrand <lha@it.su.se>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
* TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
* PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
* CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
* SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
* INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
* CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
* ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
* POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <openssl/pkcs7.h>
|
||||
#include <openssl/evp.h>
|
||||
#include <openssl/x509.h>
|
||||
#include <openssl/x509v3.h>
|
||||
#include <openssl/pem.h>
|
||||
#include <openssl/err.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef NS_ANY_CA
|
||||
#define NS_ANY_CA (NS_SSL_CA|NS_SMIME_CA|NS_OBJSIGN_CA)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
static const unsigned int pkg_key_usage = XKU_CODE_SIGN | XKU_SMIME;
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
check_ca(X509 *cert)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if ((cert->ex_flags & EXFLAG_KUSAGE) != 0 &&
|
||||
(cert->ex_kusage & KU_KEY_CERT_SIGN) != KU_KEY_CERT_SIGN)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
if ((cert->ex_flags & EXFLAG_BCONS) != 0)
|
||||
return (cert->ex_flags & EXFLAG_CA) == EXFLAG_CA;
|
||||
if ((cert->ex_flags & (EXFLAG_V1|EXFLAG_SS)) == (EXFLAG_V1|EXFLAG_SS))
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
if ((cert->ex_flags & EXFLAG_KUSAGE) != 0)
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
if ((cert->ex_flags & EXFLAG_NSCERT) != 0 &&
|
||||
(cert->ex_nscert & NS_ANY_CA) != 0)
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static STACK_OF(X509) *
|
||||
file_to_certs(const char *file)
|
||||
{
|
||||
unsigned long ret;
|
||||
STACK_OF(X509) *certs;
|
||||
FILE *f;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((f = fopen(file, "r")) == NULL) {
|
||||
warn("open failed %s", file);
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
certs = sk_X509_new_null();
|
||||
for (;;) {
|
||||
X509 *cert;
|
||||
|
||||
cert = PEM_read_X509(f, NULL, NULL, NULL);
|
||||
if (cert == NULL) {
|
||||
ret = ERR_GET_REASON(ERR_peek_error());
|
||||
if (ret == PEM_R_NO_START_LINE) {
|
||||
/* End of file reached. no error */
|
||||
ERR_clear_error();
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
sk_X509_free(certs);
|
||||
warnx("Can't read certificate in file: %s", file);
|
||||
fclose(f);
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
sk_X509_insert(certs, cert, sk_X509_num(certs));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
fclose(f);
|
||||
|
||||
if (sk_X509_num(certs) == 0) {
|
||||
sk_X509_free(certs);
|
||||
certs = NULL;
|
||||
warnx("No certificate found in file %s", file);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return certs;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
easy_pkcs7_verify(const char *content, size_t len,
|
||||
const char *signature, size_t signature_len,
|
||||
const char *anchor, int is_pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
STACK_OF(X509) *cert_chain, *signers;
|
||||
X509_STORE *store;
|
||||
BIO *sig, *in;
|
||||
PKCS7 *p7;
|
||||
int i, status;
|
||||
X509_NAME *name;
|
||||
char *subject;
|
||||
|
||||
OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms();
|
||||
ERR_load_crypto_strings();
|
||||
|
||||
status = -1;
|
||||
|
||||
if (cert_chain_file)
|
||||
cert_chain = file_to_certs(cert_chain_file);
|
||||
else
|
||||
cert_chain = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
store = X509_STORE_new();
|
||||
if (store == NULL) {
|
||||
sk_X509_free(cert_chain);
|
||||
warnx("Failed to create certificate store");
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
X509_STORE_load_locations(store, anchor, NULL);
|
||||
|
||||
in = BIO_new_mem_buf(__UNCONST(content), len);
|
||||
sig = BIO_new_mem_buf(__UNCONST(signature), signature_len);
|
||||
signers = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
p7 = PEM_read_bio_PKCS7(sig, NULL, NULL, NULL);
|
||||
if (p7 == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("Failed to parse the signature");
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (PKCS7_verify(p7, cert_chain, store, in, NULL, 0) != 1) {
|
||||
warnx("Failed to verify signature");
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
signers = PKCS7_get0_signers(p7, NULL, 0);
|
||||
if (signers == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("Failed to get signers");
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (sk_X509_num(signers) == 0) {
|
||||
warnx("No signers found");
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < sk_X509_num(signers); i++) {
|
||||
/* Compute ex_xkusage */
|
||||
X509_check_purpose(sk_X509_value(signers, i), -1, -1);
|
||||
|
||||
if (check_ca(sk_X509_value(signers, i))) {
|
||||
warnx("CA keys are not valid for signatures");
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (is_pkg) {
|
||||
if (sk_X509_value(signers, i)->ex_xkusage != pkg_key_usage) {
|
||||
warnx("Certificate must have CODE SIGNING "
|
||||
"and EMAIL PROTECTION property");
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
if (sk_X509_value(signers, i)->ex_xkusage != 0) {
|
||||
warnx("Certificate must not have any property");
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
printf("Sigature ok, signed by:\n");
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < sk_X509_num(signers); i++) {
|
||||
name = X509_get_subject_name(sk_X509_value(signers, i));
|
||||
subject = X509_NAME_oneline(name, NULL, 0);
|
||||
|
||||
printf("\t%s\n", subject);
|
||||
|
||||
OPENSSL_free(subject);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
status = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
cleanup:
|
||||
sk_X509_free(cert_chain);
|
||||
sk_X509_free(signers);
|
||||
X509_STORE_free(store);
|
||||
|
||||
PKCS7_free(p7);
|
||||
BIO_free(in);
|
||||
BIO_free(sig);
|
||||
|
||||
return status;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
ssl_pass_cb(char *buf, int size, int rwflag, void *u)
|
||||
{
|
||||
|
||||
if (EVP_read_pw_string(buf, size, "Passphrase :", 0)) {
|
||||
#if OPENSSL_VERSION >= 0x0090608fL
|
||||
OPENSSL_cleanse(buf, size);
|
||||
#else
|
||||
memset(buf, 0, size);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return strlen(buf);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
easy_pkcs7_sign(const char *content, size_t len,
|
||||
char **signature, size_t *signature_len,
|
||||
const char *key_file, const char *cert_file)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *f;
|
||||
X509 *certificate;
|
||||
STACK_OF(X509) *c, *cert_chain;
|
||||
EVP_PKEY *private_key;
|
||||
char *tmp_sig;
|
||||
BIO *out, *in;
|
||||
PKCS7 *p7;
|
||||
int status;
|
||||
|
||||
OpenSSL_add_all_algorithms();
|
||||
ERR_load_crypto_strings();
|
||||
|
||||
status = -1;
|
||||
private_key = NULL;
|
||||
cert_chain = NULL;
|
||||
in = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
c = file_to_certs(cert_file);
|
||||
|
||||
if (sk_X509_num(c) != 1) {
|
||||
warnx("More then one certificate in the certificate file");
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
certificate = sk_X509_value(c, 0);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Compute ex_kusage */
|
||||
X509_check_purpose(certificate, -1, 0);
|
||||
|
||||
if (check_ca(certificate)) {
|
||||
warnx("CA keys are not valid for signatures");
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (certificate->ex_xkusage != pkg_key_usage) {
|
||||
warnx("Certificate must have CODE SIGNING "
|
||||
"and EMAIL PROTECTION property");
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (cert_chain_file)
|
||||
cert_chain = file_to_certs(cert_chain_file);
|
||||
|
||||
if ((f = fopen(key_file, "r")) == NULL) {
|
||||
warn("Failed to open private key file %s", key_file);
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
private_key = PEM_read_PrivateKey(f, NULL, ssl_pass_cb, NULL);
|
||||
fclose(f);
|
||||
if (private_key == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("Can't read private key: %s", key_file);
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (X509_check_private_key(certificate, private_key) != 1) {
|
||||
warnx("The private key %s doesn't match the certificate %s",
|
||||
key_file, cert_file);
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
in = BIO_new_mem_buf(__UNCONST(content), len);
|
||||
|
||||
p7 = PKCS7_sign(certificate, private_key, cert_chain, in,
|
||||
PKCS7_DETACHED|PKCS7_NOATTR|PKCS7_BINARY);
|
||||
if (p7 == NULL) {
|
||||
warnx("Failed to create signature structure");
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
out = BIO_new(BIO_s_mem());
|
||||
PEM_write_bio_PKCS7(out, p7);
|
||||
*signature_len = BIO_get_mem_data(out, &tmp_sig);
|
||||
*signature = xmalloc(*signature_len);
|
||||
memcpy(*signature, tmp_sig, *signature_len);
|
||||
BIO_free_all(out);
|
||||
|
||||
PKCS7_free(p7);
|
||||
|
||||
status = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
cleanup:
|
||||
sk_X509_free(c);
|
||||
sk_X509_free(cert_chain);
|
||||
EVP_PKEY_free(private_key);
|
||||
BIO_free(in);
|
||||
|
||||
return status;
|
||||
}
|
216
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkg_install.conf.5.in
vendored
Normal file
216
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkg_install.conf.5.in
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,216 @@
|
|||
.\" $NetBSD: pkg_install.conf.5.in,v 1.1.1.13 2013/04/20 15:26:53 wiz Exp $
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Copyright (c) 2008, 2009, 2012 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
.\" All rights reserved.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
.\" by Thomas Klausner.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
.\" are met:
|
||||
.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
.\" ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
.\" TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
.\" PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
.\" POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.Dd February 22, 2012
|
||||
.Dt PKG_INSTALL.CONF 5
|
||||
.Os
|
||||
.Sh NAME
|
||||
.Nm pkg_install.conf
|
||||
.Nd configuration file for package installation tools
|
||||
.Sh DESCRIPTION
|
||||
The file
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
contains system defaults for the package installation tools
|
||||
as a list of variable-value pairs.
|
||||
Each line has the format
|
||||
.Ev VARIABLE=VALUE .
|
||||
If the value consists of more than one line, each line is prefixed with
|
||||
.Ev VARIABLE= .
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
The current value of a variable can be checked by running
|
||||
.Dl Ic pkg_admin config-var VARIABLE
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
Some variables are overriden by environmental variables of the same name.
|
||||
Those are marked by (*).
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
The following variables are supported:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent
|
||||
.It Dv ACCEPTABLE_LICENSES
|
||||
Space-separated list of licenses packages are allowed to carry.
|
||||
License names are case-sensitive.
|
||||
.It Dv ACTIVE_FTP
|
||||
Force the use of active FTP.
|
||||
.It Dv CACHE_INDEX
|
||||
Cache directory listenings in memory.
|
||||
This avoids retransfers of the large directory index for HTTP and is
|
||||
enabled by default.
|
||||
.It Dv CERTIFICATE_ANCHOR_PKGS
|
||||
Path to the file containing the certificates used for validating
|
||||
binary packages.
|
||||
A package is trusted when a certificate chain ends in one of the
|
||||
certificates contained in this file.
|
||||
The certificates must be PEM-encoded.
|
||||
.It Dv CERTIFICATE_ANCHOR_PKGVULN
|
||||
Analogous to
|
||||
.Dv CERTIFICATE_ANCHOR_PKGS .
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Pa pkg-vulnerabilities
|
||||
is trusted when a certificate chain ends in one of the certificates
|
||||
contained in this file.
|
||||
.It Dv CERTIFICATE_CHAIN
|
||||
Path to a file containing additional certificates that can be used
|
||||
for completing certificate chains when validating binary packages or
|
||||
pkg-vulnerabilities files.
|
||||
.It Dv CHECK_LICENSE
|
||||
Check the license conditions of packages before installing them.
|
||||
Supported values are:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width interactiveXX
|
||||
.It Dv no
|
||||
The check is not performed.
|
||||
.It Dv yes
|
||||
The check is performed if the package has license conditions set.
|
||||
.It Dv always
|
||||
Passing the license check is required.
|
||||
Missing license conditions are considered an error.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.It Dv CHECK_END_OF_LIFE
|
||||
During vulnerability checks, consider packages that have reached end-of-life
|
||||
as vulnerable.
|
||||
This option is enabled by default.
|
||||
.It Dv CHECK_VULNERABILITIES
|
||||
Check for vulnerabilities when installing packages.
|
||||
Supported values are:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width interactiveXX
|
||||
.It Dv never
|
||||
No check is performed.
|
||||
.It Dv always
|
||||
Passing the vulnerability check is required.
|
||||
A missing pkg-vulnerabilities file is considered an error.
|
||||
.It Dv interactive
|
||||
The user is always asked to confirm installation of vulnerable packages.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.It Dv CONFIG_CACHE_CONNECTIONS
|
||||
Limit the global connection cache to this value.
|
||||
For FTP, this is the number of sessions without active command.
|
||||
For HTTP, this is the number of connections open with keep-alive.
|
||||
.It Dv CONFIG_CACHE_CONNECTIONS_HOST
|
||||
Like
|
||||
.Dv CONFIG_CACHE_CONNECTIONS ,
|
||||
but limit the number of connections to the host as well.
|
||||
See
|
||||
.Xr fetch 3
|
||||
for further details
|
||||
.It Dv DEFAULT_ACCEPTABLE_LICENSES
|
||||
Space-separated list of common Free and Open Source licenses packages are
|
||||
allowed to carry.
|
||||
The default value contains all OSI approved licenses in pkgsrc on the date
|
||||
pkg_install was released.
|
||||
License names are case-sensitive.
|
||||
.It Dv GPG
|
||||
Path to
|
||||
.Xr gpg 1 ,
|
||||
which can be used to verify the signature in the
|
||||
.Pa pkg-vulnerabilities
|
||||
file when running
|
||||
.Dl Ic pkg_admin check-pkg-vulnerabilities -s
|
||||
or
|
||||
.Dl Ic pkg_admin fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities -s
|
||||
It can also be used to verify and sign binary packages.
|
||||
.It Dv GPG_KEYRING_PKGVULN
|
||||
Non-default keyring to use for verifying GPG signatures of
|
||||
.Pa pkg-vulnerabilities .
|
||||
.It Dv GPG_KEYRING_SIGN
|
||||
Non-default keyring to use for signing packages with GPG.
|
||||
.It Dv GPG_KEYRING_VERIFY
|
||||
Non-default keyring to use for verifying GPG signature of packages.
|
||||
.It Dv GPG_SIGN_AS
|
||||
User-id to use for signing packages.
|
||||
.It Dv IGNORE_PROXY
|
||||
Use direct connections and ignore
|
||||
.Ev FTP_PROXY
|
||||
and
|
||||
.Ev HTTP_PROXY .
|
||||
.It Dv IGNORE_URL
|
||||
One line per advisory which should be ignored when running
|
||||
.Dl Ic pkg_admin audit
|
||||
The URL from the
|
||||
.Pa pkg-vulnerabilities
|
||||
file should be used as value.
|
||||
.It Dv PKG_DBDIR (*)
|
||||
Location of the packages database.
|
||||
This option is always overriden by the argument of the
|
||||
.Fl K
|
||||
option.
|
||||
.It Dv PKG_PATH (*)
|
||||
Search path for packages.
|
||||
The entries are separated by semicolon.
|
||||
Each entry specifies a directory or URL to search for packages.
|
||||
.It Dv PKG_REFCOUNT_DBDIR (*)
|
||||
Location of the package reference counts database directory.
|
||||
The default value is
|
||||
.Pa ${PKG_DBDIR}.refcount .
|
||||
.It Dv PKGVULNDIR
|
||||
Directory name in which the
|
||||
.Pa pkg-vulnerabilities
|
||||
file resides.
|
||||
Default is
|
||||
.Pa ${PKG_DBDIR} .
|
||||
.It Dv PKGVULNURL
|
||||
URL which is used for updating the local
|
||||
.Pa pkg-vulnerabilities
|
||||
file when running
|
||||
.Dl Ic pkg_admin fetch-pkg-vulnerabilities
|
||||
The default location is ftp.NetBSD.org using HTTP.
|
||||
.Em Note :
|
||||
Usually, only the compression type should be changed.
|
||||
Currently supported are uncompressed files and files compressed by
|
||||
.Xr bzip2 1
|
||||
.Pq Pa .bz2
|
||||
or
|
||||
.Xr gzip 1
|
||||
.Pq Pa .gz .
|
||||
.It Dv VERBOSE_NETIO
|
||||
Log details of network IO to stderr.
|
||||
.It Dv VERIFIED_INSTALLATION
|
||||
Set trust level used when installation.
|
||||
Supported values are:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width interactiveXX
|
||||
.It Dv never
|
||||
No signature checks are performed.
|
||||
.It Dv always
|
||||
A valid signature is required.
|
||||
If the binary package can not be verified, the installation is terminated
|
||||
.It Dv trusted
|
||||
A valid signature is required.
|
||||
If the binary package can not be verified, the user is asked interactively.
|
||||
.It Dv interactive
|
||||
The user is always asked interactively when installing a package.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Sh FILES
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width ".Pa @SYSCONFDIR@/pkg_install.conf"
|
||||
.It Pa @SYSCONFDIR@/pkg_install.conf
|
||||
Default location for the file described in this manual page.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Sh SEE ALSO
|
||||
.Xr pkg_add 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_admin 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_create 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_delete 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1
|
383
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkg_io.c
vendored
Normal file
383
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkg_io.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,383 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: pkg_io.c,v 1.1.1.9 2010/04/23 20:54:11 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008, 2009 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: pkg_io.c,v 1.1.1.9 2010/04/23 20:54:11 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
#include <archive.h>
|
||||
#include <archive_entry.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERRNO_H
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <fetch.h>
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
struct pkg_path {
|
||||
TAILQ_ENTRY(pkg_path) pl_link;
|
||||
char *pl_path;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static char *orig_cwd, *last_toplevel;
|
||||
static TAILQ_HEAD(, pkg_path) pkg_path = TAILQ_HEAD_INITIALIZER(pkg_path);
|
||||
|
||||
struct fetch_archive {
|
||||
struct url *url;
|
||||
fetchIO *fetch;
|
||||
char buffer[32768];
|
||||
off_t size;
|
||||
int restart;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
fetch_archive_open(struct archive *a, void *client_data)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct fetch_archive *f = client_data;
|
||||
struct url_stat us;
|
||||
|
||||
f->fetch = fetchXGet(f->url, &us, fetch_flags);
|
||||
if (f->fetch == NULL)
|
||||
return ENOENT;
|
||||
f->size = us.size;
|
||||
f->restart = 1;
|
||||
f->url->offset = 0;
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static ssize_t
|
||||
fetch_archive_read(struct archive *a, void *client_data,
|
||||
const void **buffer)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct fetch_archive *f = client_data;
|
||||
struct url_stat us;
|
||||
ssize_t rv;
|
||||
|
||||
*buffer = f->buffer;
|
||||
rv = fetchIO_read(f->fetch, f->buffer, sizeof(f->buffer));
|
||||
if (rv > 0) {
|
||||
f->url->offset += rv;
|
||||
return rv;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (f->restart == 0)
|
||||
return rv;
|
||||
if (rv == 0) {
|
||||
if (f->size == -1)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
if (f->url->offset == f->size)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
f->restart = 0;
|
||||
if (1) {
|
||||
char *url = fetchStringifyURL(f->url);
|
||||
fprintf(stderr, "Trying to reconnect %s\n", url);
|
||||
free(url);
|
||||
}
|
||||
fetchIO_close(f->fetch);
|
||||
f->fetch = fetchXGet(f->url, &us, fetch_flags);
|
||||
if (f->fetch == NULL)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
if (us.size != f->size)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
rv = fetchIO_read(f->fetch, f->buffer, sizeof(f->buffer));
|
||||
if (rv > 0)
|
||||
f->url->offset += rv;
|
||||
return rv;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
fetch_archive_close(struct archive *a, void *client_data)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct fetch_archive *f = client_data;
|
||||
|
||||
if (f->fetch != NULL)
|
||||
fetchIO_close(f->fetch);
|
||||
fetchFreeURL(f->url);
|
||||
free(f);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static struct archive *
|
||||
open_archive_by_url(struct url *url, char **archive_name)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct fetch_archive *f;
|
||||
struct archive *a;
|
||||
|
||||
f = xmalloc(sizeof(*f));
|
||||
f->url = fetchCopyURL(url);
|
||||
|
||||
*archive_name = fetchStringifyURL(url);
|
||||
|
||||
a = archive_read_new();
|
||||
archive_read_support_compression_all(a);
|
||||
archive_read_support_format_all(a);
|
||||
if (archive_read_open(a, f, fetch_archive_open, fetch_archive_read,
|
||||
fetch_archive_close)) {
|
||||
free(*archive_name);
|
||||
*archive_name = NULL;
|
||||
archive_read_finish(a);
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct archive *
|
||||
open_archive(const char *url, char **archive_name)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct url *u;
|
||||
struct archive *a;
|
||||
|
||||
*archive_name = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!IS_URL(url)) {
|
||||
a = archive_read_new();
|
||||
archive_read_support_compression_all(a);
|
||||
archive_read_support_format_all(a);
|
||||
if (archive_read_open_filename(a, url, 1024)) {
|
||||
archive_read_close(a);
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
*archive_name = xstrdup(url);
|
||||
return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if ((u = fetchParseURL(url)) == NULL)
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
a = open_archive_by_url(u, archive_name);
|
||||
|
||||
fetchFreeURL(u);
|
||||
return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
strip_suffix(char *filename)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
|
||||
len = strlen(filename);
|
||||
if (len <= 4)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
if (strcmp(filename + len - 4, ".tgz") == 0 ||
|
||||
strcmp(filename + len - 4, ".tbz") == 0) {
|
||||
filename[len - 4] = '\0';
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
} else
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
find_best_package_int(struct url *url, const char *pattern,
|
||||
struct url **best_url)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *cur_match, *url_pattern, *best_match = NULL;
|
||||
struct url_list ue;
|
||||
size_t i;
|
||||
|
||||
if (*best_url) {
|
||||
if ((best_match = fetchUnquoteFilename(*best_url)) == NULL)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
} else
|
||||
best_match = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
if (best_match && strip_suffix(best_match) == 0) {
|
||||
free(best_match);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; pattern[i] != '\0'; ++i) {
|
||||
if (!isalnum((unsigned char)(pattern[i])) &&
|
||||
(pattern[i]) != '-')
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
url_pattern = xasprintf("%*.*s*", (int)i, (int)i, pattern);
|
||||
|
||||
fetchInitURLList(&ue);
|
||||
if (fetchList(&ue, url, url_pattern, fetch_flags)) {
|
||||
char *base_url;
|
||||
base_url = fetchStringifyURL(url);
|
||||
warnx("Can't process %s/%s: %s", base_url, url_pattern,
|
||||
fetchLastErrString);
|
||||
free(base_url);
|
||||
free(url_pattern);
|
||||
fetchFreeURLList(&ue);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(url_pattern);
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < ue.length; ++i) {
|
||||
cur_match = fetchUnquoteFilename(ue.urls + i);
|
||||
|
||||
if (cur_match == NULL) {
|
||||
free(best_match);
|
||||
fetchFreeURLList(&ue);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (strip_suffix(cur_match) == 0) {
|
||||
free(cur_match);
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (pkg_order(pattern, cur_match, best_match) == 1) {
|
||||
if (*best_url)
|
||||
fetchFreeURL(*best_url);
|
||||
*best_url = fetchCopyURL(ue.urls + i);
|
||||
free(best_match);
|
||||
best_match = cur_match;
|
||||
cur_match = NULL;
|
||||
if (*best_url == NULL) {
|
||||
free(best_match);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(cur_match);
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(best_match);
|
||||
fetchFreeURLList(&ue);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
process_pkg_path(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char cwd[PATH_MAX];
|
||||
int relative_path;
|
||||
struct pkg_path *pl;
|
||||
const char *start, *next;
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
|
||||
if (getcwd(cwd, sizeof(cwd)) == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "getcwd failed");
|
||||
|
||||
orig_cwd = xstrdup(cwd);
|
||||
|
||||
if (config_pkg_path == NULL)
|
||||
return;
|
||||
|
||||
for (start = config_pkg_path; *start; start = next) {
|
||||
len = strcspn(start, ";");
|
||||
if (*(next = start + len) != '\0')
|
||||
++next;
|
||||
|
||||
relative_path = !IS_FULLPATH(start) && !IS_URL(start);
|
||||
pl = xmalloc(sizeof(*pl));
|
||||
pl->pl_path = xasprintf("%s%s%*.*s",
|
||||
relative_path ? cwd : "", len && relative_path ? "/" : "",
|
||||
(int)len, (int)len, start);
|
||||
TAILQ_INSERT_TAIL(&pkg_path, pl, pl_link);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct url *
|
||||
find_best_package(const char *toplevel, const char *pattern, int do_path)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct url *url, *best_match = NULL;
|
||||
struct pkg_path *pl;
|
||||
|
||||
if (toplevel) {
|
||||
url = fetchParseURL(last_toplevel);
|
||||
if (url != NULL) {
|
||||
find_best_package_int(url, pattern, &best_match);
|
||||
/* XXX Check return value and complain */
|
||||
fetchFreeURL(url);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (!do_path)
|
||||
return best_match;
|
||||
|
||||
TAILQ_FOREACH(pl, &pkg_path, pl_link) {
|
||||
url = fetchParseURL(pl->pl_path);
|
||||
if (url != NULL) {
|
||||
find_best_package_int(url, pattern, &best_match);
|
||||
/* XXX Check return value and complain */
|
||||
fetchFreeURL(url);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return best_match;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct archive *
|
||||
find_archive(const char *fname, int top_level, char **archive_name)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct archive *a;
|
||||
struct url *best_match;
|
||||
char *full_fname, *last_slash;
|
||||
int search_path;
|
||||
|
||||
search_path = 0;
|
||||
if (IS_FULLPATH(fname) || IS_URL(fname)) {
|
||||
full_fname = xstrdup(fname);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
if (strchr(fname, '/') == NULL)
|
||||
search_path = 1;
|
||||
full_fname = xasprintf("%s/%s", orig_cwd, fname);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
last_slash = strrchr(full_fname, '/');
|
||||
if (top_level) {
|
||||
free(last_toplevel);
|
||||
*last_slash = '\0';
|
||||
last_toplevel = xstrdup(full_fname);
|
||||
*last_slash = '/';
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
a = open_archive(full_fname, archive_name);
|
||||
if (a != NULL) {
|
||||
free(full_fname);
|
||||
return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
fname = last_slash + 1;
|
||||
*last_slash = '\0';
|
||||
|
||||
best_match = find_best_package(full_fname, fname, 0);
|
||||
|
||||
if (search_path && best_match == NULL)
|
||||
best_match = find_best_package(last_toplevel, fname, 1);
|
||||
|
||||
free(full_fname);
|
||||
|
||||
if (best_match == NULL)
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
a = open_archive_by_url(best_match, archive_name);
|
||||
fetchFreeURL(best_match);
|
||||
return a;
|
||||
}
|
710
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkg_signature.c
vendored
Normal file
710
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkg_signature.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,710 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: pkg_signature.c,v 1.2 2013/09/11 12:59:19 khorben Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: pkg_signature.c,v 1.2 2013/09/11 12:59:19 khorben Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_WAIT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/wait.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <ctype.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#ifndef NETBSD
|
||||
#include <nbcompat/sha2.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#include <sha2.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <signal.h>
|
||||
#ifdef NETBSD
|
||||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#include <nbcompat/unistd.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <archive.h>
|
||||
#include <archive_entry.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#define HASH_FNAME "+PKG_HASH"
|
||||
#define SIGNATURE_FNAME "+PKG_SIGNATURE"
|
||||
#define GPG_SIGNATURE_FNAME "+PKG_GPG_SIGNATURE"
|
||||
|
||||
struct signature_archive {
|
||||
struct archive *archive;
|
||||
off_t pkg_size;
|
||||
size_t sign_block_len, sign_block_number, sign_cur_block;
|
||||
char **sign_blocks;
|
||||
unsigned char *sign_buf;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
hash_block(unsigned char *buf, size_t buf_len,
|
||||
char hash[SHA512_DIGEST_STRING_LENGTH])
|
||||
{
|
||||
unsigned char digest[SHA512_DIGEST_LENGTH];
|
||||
SHA512_CTX hash_ctx;
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
|
||||
SHA512_Init(&hash_ctx);
|
||||
SHA512_Update(&hash_ctx, buf, buf_len);
|
||||
SHA512_Final(digest, &hash_ctx);
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < SHA512_DIGEST_LENGTH; ++i) {
|
||||
unsigned char c;
|
||||
|
||||
c = digest[i] / 16;
|
||||
if (c < 10)
|
||||
hash[2 * i] = '0' + c;
|
||||
else
|
||||
hash[2 * i] = 'a' - 10 + c;
|
||||
|
||||
c = digest[i] % 16;
|
||||
if (c < 10)
|
||||
hash[2 * i + 1] = '0' + c;
|
||||
else
|
||||
hash[2 * i + 1] = 'a' - 10 + c;
|
||||
}
|
||||
hash[2 * i] = '\0';
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static ssize_t
|
||||
verify_signature_read_cb(struct archive *archive, void *cookie, const void **buf)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct signature_archive *state = cookie;
|
||||
char hash[SHA512_DIGEST_STRING_LENGTH];
|
||||
ssize_t len, expected;
|
||||
|
||||
if (state->sign_cur_block >= state->sign_block_number)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/* The following works for sign_block_len > 1 */
|
||||
if (state->sign_cur_block + 1 == state->sign_block_number)
|
||||
expected = state->pkg_size % state->sign_block_len;
|
||||
else
|
||||
expected = state->sign_block_len;
|
||||
|
||||
len = archive_read_data(state->archive, state->sign_buf, expected);
|
||||
if (len != expected) {
|
||||
warnx("Short read from package");
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
hash_block(state->sign_buf, len, hash);
|
||||
|
||||
if (strcmp(hash, state->sign_blocks[state->sign_cur_block]) != 0) {
|
||||
warnx("Invalid signature of block %llu",
|
||||
(unsigned long long)state->sign_cur_block);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
++state->sign_cur_block;
|
||||
*buf = state->sign_buf;
|
||||
return len;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
free_signature_int(struct signature_archive *state)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t i;
|
||||
|
||||
if (state->sign_blocks != NULL) {
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < state->sign_block_number; ++i)
|
||||
free(state->sign_blocks[i]);
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(state->sign_blocks);
|
||||
free(state->sign_buf);
|
||||
free(state);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
verify_signature_close_cb(struct archive *archive, void *cookie)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct signature_archive *state = cookie;
|
||||
|
||||
archive_read_finish(state->archive);
|
||||
free_signature_int(state);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
read_file_from_archive(const char *archive_name, struct archive *archive,
|
||||
struct archive_entry **entry,
|
||||
const char *fname, char **content, size_t *len)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int r;
|
||||
|
||||
*content = NULL;
|
||||
*len = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
retry:
|
||||
if (*entry == NULL &&
|
||||
(r = archive_read_next_header(archive, entry)) != ARCHIVE_OK) {
|
||||
if (r == ARCHIVE_FATAL) {
|
||||
warnx("Cannot read from archive `%s': %s",
|
||||
archive_name, archive_error_string(archive));
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
warnx("Premature end of archive `%s'", archive_name);
|
||||
}
|
||||
*entry = NULL;
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (strcmp(archive_entry_pathname(*entry), "//") == 0) {
|
||||
archive_read_data_skip(archive);
|
||||
*entry = NULL;
|
||||
goto retry;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (strcmp(fname, archive_entry_pathname(*entry)) != 0)
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
|
||||
if (archive_entry_size(*entry) > SSIZE_MAX - 1) {
|
||||
warnx("Signature of archive `%s' too large to process",
|
||||
archive_name);
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
*len = archive_entry_size(*entry);
|
||||
*content = xmalloc(*len + 1);
|
||||
|
||||
if (archive_read_data(archive, *content, *len) != (ssize_t)*len) {
|
||||
warnx("Cannot read complete %s from archive `%s'", fname,
|
||||
archive_name);
|
||||
free(*content);
|
||||
*len = 0;
|
||||
*content = NULL;
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
(*content)[*len] = '\0';
|
||||
*entry = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
parse_hash_file(const char *hash_file, char **pkgname,
|
||||
struct signature_archive *state)
|
||||
{
|
||||
static const char block1[] = "pkgsrc signature\n\nversion: 1\npkgname: ";
|
||||
static const char block2[] = "algorithm: SHA512\nblock size: ";
|
||||
static const char block3[] = "file size: ";
|
||||
static const char block4[] = "end pkgsrc signature\n";
|
||||
char *next;
|
||||
size_t i, len;
|
||||
|
||||
*pkgname = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
if (strncmp(hash_file, block1, strlen(block1)) != 0)
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
hash_file += strlen(block1);
|
||||
|
||||
len = strcspn(hash_file, "\n");
|
||||
*pkgname = xmalloc(len + 1);
|
||||
memcpy(*pkgname, hash_file, len);
|
||||
(*pkgname)[len] = '\0';
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < len; ++i) {
|
||||
if (!isgraph((unsigned char)(*pkgname)[i]))
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
hash_file += len + 1;
|
||||
|
||||
if (strncmp(hash_file, block2, strlen(block2)) != 0)
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
hash_file += strlen(block2);
|
||||
|
||||
errno = 0;
|
||||
if (!isdigit((unsigned char)*hash_file))
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
state->sign_block_len = strtoul(hash_file, &next, 10);
|
||||
hash_file = next;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Assert sane minimum block size of 1KB */
|
||||
if (*hash_file++ != '\n' || errno == ERANGE || state->sign_block_len < 1024)
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
|
||||
if (strncmp(hash_file, block3, strlen(block3)) != 0)
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
hash_file += strlen(block3);
|
||||
|
||||
errno = 0;
|
||||
if (!isdigit((unsigned char)*hash_file))
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
if (/* CONSTCOND */sizeof(off_t) >= sizeof(long long))
|
||||
state->pkg_size = strtoll(hash_file, &next, 10);
|
||||
else
|
||||
state->pkg_size = strtol(hash_file, &next, 10);
|
||||
hash_file = next;
|
||||
if (*hash_file++ != '\n' || errno == ERANGE || state->pkg_size < 1)
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
|
||||
if (*hash_file++ != '\n')
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
|
||||
if (state->pkg_size / state->sign_block_len > SSIZE_MAX)
|
||||
goto cleanup;
|
||||
state->sign_block_number = (state->pkg_size +
|
||||
state->sign_block_len - 1) / state->sign_block_len;
|
||||
|
||||
state->sign_buf = xmalloc(state->sign_block_len);
|
||||
state->sign_blocks = xcalloc(state->sign_block_number, sizeof(char *));
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < state->sign_block_number; ++i) {
|
||||
len = strspn(hash_file, "01234567889abcdef");
|
||||
if (len != SHA512_DIGEST_LENGTH * 2 || hash_file[len] != '\n')
|
||||
goto cleanup_hashes;
|
||||
state->sign_blocks[i] = xmalloc(len + 1);
|
||||
memcpy(state->sign_blocks[i], hash_file, len);
|
||||
state->sign_blocks[i][len] = '\0';
|
||||
hash_file += len + 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (strcmp(hash_file, block4) != 0)
|
||||
goto cleanup_hashes;
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
cleanup_hashes:
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < state->sign_block_number; ++i)
|
||||
free(state->sign_blocks[i]);
|
||||
free(state->sign_blocks);
|
||||
state->sign_blocks = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
cleanup:
|
||||
warnx("Unknown format of hash file");
|
||||
free(*pkgname);
|
||||
*pkgname = NULL;
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
pkg_verify_signature(const char *archive_name, struct archive **archive,
|
||||
struct archive_entry **entry, char **pkgname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct signature_archive *state;
|
||||
struct archive_entry *my_entry;
|
||||
struct archive *a;
|
||||
char *hash_file, *signature_file;
|
||||
size_t hash_len, signature_len;
|
||||
int r, has_sig;
|
||||
|
||||
*pkgname = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
state = xcalloc(sizeof(*state), 1);
|
||||
|
||||
r = read_file_from_archive(archive_name, *archive, entry, HASH_FNAME,
|
||||
&hash_file, &hash_len);
|
||||
if (r == -1) {
|
||||
archive_read_finish(*archive);
|
||||
*archive = NULL;
|
||||
free(state);
|
||||
goto no_valid_signature;
|
||||
} else if (r == 1) {
|
||||
free(state);
|
||||
goto no_valid_signature;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (parse_hash_file(hash_file, pkgname, state))
|
||||
goto no_valid_signature;
|
||||
|
||||
r = read_file_from_archive(archive_name, *archive, entry, SIGNATURE_FNAME,
|
||||
&signature_file, &signature_len);
|
||||
if (r == -1) {
|
||||
archive_read_finish(*archive);
|
||||
*archive = NULL;
|
||||
free(state);
|
||||
free(hash_file);
|
||||
goto no_valid_signature;
|
||||
} else if (r != 0) {
|
||||
if (*entry != NULL)
|
||||
r = read_file_from_archive(archive_name, *archive,
|
||||
entry, GPG_SIGNATURE_FNAME,
|
||||
&signature_file, &signature_len);
|
||||
if (r == -1) {
|
||||
archive_read_finish(*archive);
|
||||
*archive = NULL;
|
||||
free(state);
|
||||
free(hash_file);
|
||||
goto no_valid_signature;
|
||||
} else if (r != 0) {
|
||||
free(hash_file);
|
||||
free(state);
|
||||
goto no_valid_signature;
|
||||
}
|
||||
has_sig = !detached_gpg_verify(hash_file, hash_len,
|
||||
signature_file, signature_len, gpg_keyring_verify);
|
||||
|
||||
free(signature_file);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_SSL
|
||||
has_sig = !easy_pkcs7_verify(hash_file, hash_len, signature_file,
|
||||
signature_len, certs_packages, 1);
|
||||
|
||||
free(signature_file);
|
||||
#else
|
||||
warnx("No OpenSSL support compiled in, skipping signature");
|
||||
has_sig = 0;
|
||||
free(signature_file);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
r = archive_read_next_header(*archive, &my_entry);
|
||||
if (r != ARCHIVE_OK) {
|
||||
warnx("Cannot read inner package: %s",
|
||||
archive_error_string(*archive));
|
||||
free_signature_int(state);
|
||||
goto no_valid_signature;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (archive_entry_size(my_entry) != state->pkg_size) {
|
||||
warnx("Package size doesn't match signature");
|
||||
free_signature_int(state);
|
||||
goto no_valid_signature;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
state->archive = *archive;
|
||||
|
||||
a = archive_read_new();
|
||||
archive_read_support_compression_all(a);
|
||||
archive_read_support_format_all(a);
|
||||
if (archive_read_open(a, state, NULL, verify_signature_read_cb,
|
||||
verify_signature_close_cb)) {
|
||||
warnx("Can't open signed package file");
|
||||
archive_read_finish(a);
|
||||
goto no_valid_signature;
|
||||
}
|
||||
*archive = a;
|
||||
*entry = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
return has_sig ? 0 : -1;
|
||||
|
||||
no_valid_signature:
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
pkg_full_signature_check(const char *archive_name, struct archive **archive)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct archive_entry *entry = NULL;
|
||||
char *pkgname;
|
||||
int r;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkg_verify_signature(archive_name, archive, &entry, &pkgname))
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
if (pkgname == NULL)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/* XXX read PLIST and compare pkgname */
|
||||
while ((r = archive_read_next_header(*archive, &entry)) == ARCHIVE_OK)
|
||||
archive_read_data_skip(*archive);
|
||||
|
||||
free(pkgname);
|
||||
return r == ARCHIVE_EOF ? 0 : -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static char *
|
||||
extract_pkgname(int fd)
|
||||
{
|
||||
package_t plist;
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
struct archive *a;
|
||||
struct archive_entry *entry;
|
||||
char *buf;
|
||||
ssize_t len;
|
||||
int r;
|
||||
|
||||
a = archive_read_new();
|
||||
archive_read_support_compression_all(a);
|
||||
archive_read_support_format_all(a);
|
||||
if (archive_read_open_fd(a, fd, 1024)) {
|
||||
warnx("Cannot open binary package: %s",
|
||||
archive_error_string(a));
|
||||
archive_read_finish(a);
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
r = archive_read_next_header(a, &entry);
|
||||
if (r != ARCHIVE_OK) {
|
||||
warnx("Cannot extract package name: %s",
|
||||
r == ARCHIVE_EOF ? "EOF" : archive_error_string(a));
|
||||
archive_read_finish(a);
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (strcmp(archive_entry_pathname(entry), "+CONTENTS") != 0) {
|
||||
warnx("Invalid binary package, doesn't start with +CONTENTS");
|
||||
archive_read_finish(a);
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (archive_entry_size(entry) > SSIZE_MAX - 1) {
|
||||
warnx("+CONTENTS too large to process");
|
||||
archive_read_finish(a);
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
len = archive_entry_size(entry);
|
||||
buf = xmalloc(len + 1);
|
||||
|
||||
if (archive_read_data(a, buf, len) != len) {
|
||||
warnx("Short read when extracing +CONTENTS");
|
||||
free(buf);
|
||||
archive_read_finish(a);
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
buf[len] = '\0';
|
||||
|
||||
archive_read_finish(a);
|
||||
|
||||
parse_plist(&plist, buf);
|
||||
free(buf);
|
||||
p = find_plist(&plist, PLIST_NAME);
|
||||
if (p != NULL) {
|
||||
buf = xstrdup(p->name);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
warnx("Invalid PLIST: missing @name");
|
||||
buf = NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free_plist(&plist);
|
||||
|
||||
if (lseek(fd, 0, SEEK_SET) != 0) {
|
||||
warn("Cannot seek in archive");
|
||||
free(buf);
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return buf;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static const char hash_template[] =
|
||||
"pkgsrc signature\n"
|
||||
"\n"
|
||||
"version: 1\n"
|
||||
"pkgname: %s\n"
|
||||
"algorithm: SHA512\n"
|
||||
"block size: 65536\n"
|
||||
"file size: %lld\n"
|
||||
"\n";
|
||||
|
||||
static const char hash_trailer[] = "end pkgsrc signature\n";
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_SSL
|
||||
void
|
||||
pkg_sign_x509(const char *name, const char *output, const char *key_file, const char *cert_file)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct archive *pkg;
|
||||
struct archive_entry *entry, *hash_entry, *sign_entry;
|
||||
int fd;
|
||||
struct stat sb;
|
||||
char *hash_file, *signature_file, *tmp, *pkgname, hash[SHA512_DIGEST_STRING_LENGTH];
|
||||
unsigned char block[65536];
|
||||
off_t i, size;
|
||||
size_t block_len, signature_len;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((fd = open(name, O_RDONLY)) == -1)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot open binary package %s", name);
|
||||
if (fstat(fd, &sb) == -1)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot stat %s", name);
|
||||
|
||||
entry = archive_entry_new();
|
||||
archive_entry_copy_stat(entry, &sb);
|
||||
|
||||
pkgname = extract_pkgname(fd);
|
||||
hash_file = xasprintf(hash_template, pkgname,
|
||||
(long long)archive_entry_size(entry));
|
||||
free(pkgname);
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < archive_entry_size(entry); i += block_len) {
|
||||
if (i + (off_t)sizeof(block) < archive_entry_size(entry))
|
||||
block_len = sizeof(block);
|
||||
else
|
||||
block_len = archive_entry_size(entry) % sizeof(block);
|
||||
if (read(fd, block, block_len) != (ssize_t)block_len)
|
||||
err(2, "short read");
|
||||
hash_block(block, block_len, hash);
|
||||
tmp = xasprintf("%s%s\n", hash_file, hash);
|
||||
free(hash_file);
|
||||
hash_file = tmp;
|
||||
}
|
||||
tmp = xasprintf("%s%s", hash_file, hash_trailer);
|
||||
free(hash_file);
|
||||
hash_file = tmp;
|
||||
|
||||
if (easy_pkcs7_sign(hash_file, strlen(hash_file), &signature_file,
|
||||
&signature_len, key_file, cert_file))
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot sign hash file");
|
||||
|
||||
lseek(fd, 0, SEEK_SET);
|
||||
|
||||
sign_entry = archive_entry_clone(entry);
|
||||
hash_entry = archive_entry_clone(entry);
|
||||
pkgname = strrchr(name, '/');
|
||||
archive_entry_set_pathname(entry, pkgname != NULL ? pkgname + 1 : name);
|
||||
archive_entry_set_pathname(hash_entry, HASH_FNAME);
|
||||
archive_entry_set_pathname(sign_entry, SIGNATURE_FNAME);
|
||||
archive_entry_set_size(hash_entry, strlen(hash_file));
|
||||
archive_entry_set_size(sign_entry, signature_len);
|
||||
|
||||
pkg = archive_write_new();
|
||||
archive_write_set_compression_none(pkg);
|
||||
archive_write_set_format_ar_bsd(pkg);
|
||||
archive_write_open_filename(pkg, output);
|
||||
|
||||
archive_write_header(pkg, hash_entry);
|
||||
archive_write_data(pkg, hash_file, strlen(hash_file));
|
||||
archive_write_finish_entry(pkg);
|
||||
archive_entry_free(hash_entry);
|
||||
|
||||
archive_write_header(pkg, sign_entry);
|
||||
archive_write_data(pkg, signature_file, signature_len);
|
||||
archive_write_finish_entry(pkg);
|
||||
archive_entry_free(sign_entry);
|
||||
|
||||
size = archive_entry_size(entry);
|
||||
archive_write_header(pkg, entry);
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < size; i += block_len) {
|
||||
if (i + (off_t)sizeof(block) < size)
|
||||
block_len = sizeof(block);
|
||||
else
|
||||
block_len = size % sizeof(block);
|
||||
if (read(fd, block, block_len) != (ssize_t)block_len)
|
||||
err(2, "short read");
|
||||
archive_write_data(pkg, block, block_len);
|
||||
}
|
||||
archive_write_finish_entry(pkg);
|
||||
archive_entry_free(entry);
|
||||
|
||||
archive_write_finish(pkg);
|
||||
|
||||
close(fd);
|
||||
|
||||
exit(0);
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
pkg_sign_gpg(const char *name, const char *output)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct archive *pkg;
|
||||
struct archive_entry *entry, *hash_entry, *sign_entry;
|
||||
int fd;
|
||||
struct stat sb;
|
||||
char *hash_file, *signature_file, *tmp, *pkgname, hash[SHA512_DIGEST_STRING_LENGTH];
|
||||
unsigned char block[65536];
|
||||
off_t i, size;
|
||||
size_t block_len, signature_len;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((fd = open(name, O_RDONLY)) == -1)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot open binary package %s", name);
|
||||
if (fstat(fd, &sb) == -1)
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot stat %s", name);
|
||||
|
||||
entry = archive_entry_new();
|
||||
archive_entry_copy_stat(entry, &sb);
|
||||
|
||||
pkgname = extract_pkgname(fd);
|
||||
hash_file = xasprintf(hash_template, pkgname,
|
||||
(long long)archive_entry_size(entry));
|
||||
free(pkgname);
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < archive_entry_size(entry); i += block_len) {
|
||||
if (i + (off_t)sizeof(block) < archive_entry_size(entry))
|
||||
block_len = sizeof(block);
|
||||
else
|
||||
block_len = archive_entry_size(entry) % sizeof(block);
|
||||
if (read(fd, block, block_len) != (ssize_t)block_len)
|
||||
err(2, "short read");
|
||||
hash_block(block, block_len, hash);
|
||||
tmp = xasprintf("%s%s\n", hash_file, hash);
|
||||
free(hash_file);
|
||||
hash_file = tmp;
|
||||
}
|
||||
tmp = xasprintf("%s%s", hash_file, hash_trailer);
|
||||
free(hash_file);
|
||||
hash_file = tmp;
|
||||
|
||||
if (detached_gpg_sign(hash_file, strlen(hash_file), &signature_file,
|
||||
&signature_len, gpg_keyring_sign, gpg_sign_as))
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot sign hash file");
|
||||
|
||||
lseek(fd, 0, SEEK_SET);
|
||||
|
||||
sign_entry = archive_entry_clone(entry);
|
||||
hash_entry = archive_entry_clone(entry);
|
||||
pkgname = strrchr(name, '/');
|
||||
archive_entry_set_pathname(entry, pkgname != NULL ? pkgname + 1 : name);
|
||||
archive_entry_set_pathname(hash_entry, HASH_FNAME);
|
||||
archive_entry_set_pathname(sign_entry, GPG_SIGNATURE_FNAME);
|
||||
archive_entry_set_size(hash_entry, strlen(hash_file));
|
||||
archive_entry_set_size(sign_entry, signature_len);
|
||||
|
||||
pkg = archive_write_new();
|
||||
archive_write_set_compression_none(pkg);
|
||||
archive_write_set_format_ar_bsd(pkg);
|
||||
archive_write_open_filename(pkg, output);
|
||||
|
||||
archive_write_header(pkg, hash_entry);
|
||||
archive_write_data(pkg, hash_file, strlen(hash_file));
|
||||
archive_write_finish_entry(pkg);
|
||||
archive_entry_free(hash_entry);
|
||||
|
||||
archive_write_header(pkg, sign_entry);
|
||||
archive_write_data(pkg, signature_file, signature_len);
|
||||
archive_write_finish_entry(pkg);
|
||||
archive_entry_free(sign_entry);
|
||||
|
||||
size = archive_entry_size(entry);
|
||||
archive_write_header(pkg, entry);
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < size; i += block_len) {
|
||||
if (i + (off_t)sizeof(block) < size)
|
||||
block_len = sizeof(block);
|
||||
else
|
||||
block_len = size % sizeof(block);
|
||||
if (read(fd, block, block_len) != (ssize_t)block_len)
|
||||
err(2, "short read");
|
||||
archive_write_data(pkg, block, block_len);
|
||||
}
|
||||
archive_write_finish_entry(pkg);
|
||||
archive_entry_free(entry);
|
||||
|
||||
archive_write_finish(pkg);
|
||||
|
||||
close(fd);
|
||||
|
||||
exit(0);
|
||||
}
|
138
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkg_summary.5
vendored
Normal file
138
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkg_summary.5
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,138 @@
|
|||
.\" $NetBSD: pkg_summary.5,v 1.4 2012/02/19 17:49:09 tron Exp $
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Copyright (c) 2006 The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
.\" are met:
|
||||
.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
.\" 3. Neither the name of the NetBSD Foundation nor the names of its
|
||||
.\" contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from
|
||||
.\" this software without specific prior written permission.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION AND ITS CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
.\" ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT
|
||||
.\" NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
|
||||
.\" FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT
|
||||
.\" SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
|
||||
.\" INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
|
||||
.\" (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
|
||||
.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
|
||||
.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
|
||||
.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
|
||||
.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.Dd April 11, 2009
|
||||
.Dt PKG_SUMMARY 5
|
||||
.Os
|
||||
.Sh NAME
|
||||
.Nm pkg_summary
|
||||
.Nd summary of binary package repository
|
||||
.Sh DESCRIPTION
|
||||
The file
|
||||
.Nm
|
||||
contains information about each package in a binary package
|
||||
repository as a list of variable-value pairs.
|
||||
The variables describing different packages are separated by one empty
|
||||
line.
|
||||
Each line has the format
|
||||
.Ev VARIABLE=VALUE .
|
||||
If the value consists of more than one line, each line is prefixed with
|
||||
.Ev VARIABLE= .
|
||||
Multi-line variables are guaranteed to be in consecutive lines.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
The following variables are used:
|
||||
.Bl -tag -width indent
|
||||
.It Ev BUILD_DATE
|
||||
(required) The date and time when the package was built.
|
||||
.It Ev CATEGORIES
|
||||
(required) A list of categories which this package fits in, separated by
|
||||
space.
|
||||
.It Ev COMMENT
|
||||
(required) A one-line description of the package.
|
||||
.It Ev CONFLICTS
|
||||
(optional) A list of dewey patterns of packages the package conflicts
|
||||
with, one per line.
|
||||
If missing, this package has no conflicts.
|
||||
.It Ev DEPENDS
|
||||
(optional) A list of dewey patterns of packages the package depends
|
||||
on, one per line.
|
||||
If missing, this package has no dependencies.
|
||||
.It Ev DESCRIPTION
|
||||
(required) A more detailed description of the package.
|
||||
.\" DIGEST
|
||||
.It Ev FILE_CKSUM
|
||||
(optional) A checksum type supported by
|
||||
.Xr digest 1
|
||||
and checksum separated by space character.
|
||||
.It Ev FILE_NAME
|
||||
(optional) The name of the binary package file.
|
||||
If not given,
|
||||
.Pa PKGNAME.tgz
|
||||
can be assumed.
|
||||
.It Ev FILE_SIZE
|
||||
(optional) The size of the binary package file, in bytes.
|
||||
.It Ev HOMEPAGE
|
||||
(optional) A URL where more information about the package can be found.
|
||||
.It Ev LICENSE
|
||||
(optional) The type of license this package is distributed under.
|
||||
If empty or missing, it is OSI-approved.
|
||||
.It Ev MACHINE_ARCH
|
||||
(required) The architecture on which the package was compiled.
|
||||
.It Ev OPSYS
|
||||
(required) The operating system on which the package was compiled.
|
||||
.It Ev OS_VERSION
|
||||
(required) The version of the operating system on which the package
|
||||
was compiled.
|
||||
.It Ev PKG_OPTIONS
|
||||
(optional) Any options selected to compile this package.
|
||||
If missing, the package does not support options.
|
||||
.It Ev PKGNAME
|
||||
(required) The name of the package.
|
||||
.It Ev PKGPATH
|
||||
(required) The path of the package directory within pkgsrc.
|
||||
.It Ev PKGTOOLS_VERSION
|
||||
(required) The version of the package tools used to create the package.
|
||||
.It Ev PREV_PKGPATH
|
||||
(optional) The previous path of the package directory within pkgsrc when
|
||||
a package was moved.
|
||||
(See
|
||||
.Ev SUPERSEDES
|
||||
below for a renamed package.)
|
||||
.It Ev PROVIDES
|
||||
(optional) A list of shared libraries provided by the package,
|
||||
including major version number, one per line.
|
||||
If missing, this package does not provide shared libraries.
|
||||
.It Ev REQUIRES
|
||||
(optional) A list of shared libraries needed by the package, including
|
||||
major version number, one per line.
|
||||
If missing, this package does not require shared libraries.
|
||||
.It Ev SIZE_PKG
|
||||
(required) The size of the package when installed, in bytes.
|
||||
.It Ev SUPERSEDES
|
||||
(optional) A list of dewey patterns of previous packages this
|
||||
package replaces, one per line.
|
||||
This is used for package renaming.
|
||||
.El
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nm pkg_summary
|
||||
file can be generated using the
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1
|
||||
.Fl X
|
||||
option.
|
||||
For example, the following will list this data for all installed packages:
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
.Dl "pkg_info -X -a"
|
||||
.Sh SEE ALSO
|
||||
.Xr digest 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1
|
||||
.Sh HISTORY
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nm pkg_summary
|
||||
format was first officially documented in April 2006.
|
339
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkgdb.c
vendored
Normal file
339
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkgdb.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,339 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: pkgdb.c,v 1.1.1.8 2010/04/23 20:54:11 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: pkgdb.c,v 1.1.1.8 2010/04/23 20:54:11 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 1999-2010 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
* by Hubert Feyrer <hubert@feyrer.de>.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
* TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
* PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
* CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
* SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
* INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
* CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
* ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
* POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef NETBSD
|
||||
#include <db.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#include <nbcompat/db.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERRNO_H
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_FCNTL_H
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDARG_H
|
||||
#include <stdarg.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDIO_H
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#define PKGDB_FILE "pkgdb.byfile.db" /* indexed by filename */
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Where we put logging information by default if PKG_DBDIR is unset.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef DEF_LOG_DIR
|
||||
#define DEF_LOG_DIR "/var/db/pkg"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* just in case we change the environment variable name */
|
||||
#define PKG_DBDIR "PKG_DBDIR"
|
||||
|
||||
static DB *pkgdbp;
|
||||
static char pkgdb_dir_default[] = DEF_LOG_DIR;
|
||||
static char *pkgdb_dir = pkgdb_dir_default;
|
||||
static int pkgdb_dir_prio = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Return name of cache file in the buffer that was passed.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *
|
||||
pkgdb_get_database(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return xasprintf("%s/%s", pkgdb_get_dir(), PKGDB_FILE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Open the pkg-database
|
||||
* Return value:
|
||||
* 1: everything ok
|
||||
* 0: error
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
pkgdb_open(int mode)
|
||||
{
|
||||
BTREEINFO info;
|
||||
char *cachename;
|
||||
|
||||
/* try our btree format first */
|
||||
info.flags = 0;
|
||||
info.cachesize = 2*1024*1024;
|
||||
info.maxkeypage = 0;
|
||||
info.minkeypage = 0;
|
||||
info.psize = 4096;
|
||||
info.compare = NULL;
|
||||
info.prefix = NULL;
|
||||
info.lorder = 0;
|
||||
cachename = pkgdb_get_database();
|
||||
pkgdbp = (DB *) dbopen(cachename,
|
||||
(mode == ReadOnly) ? O_RDONLY : O_RDWR | O_CREAT,
|
||||
0644, DB_BTREE, (void *) &info);
|
||||
free(cachename);
|
||||
return (pkgdbp != NULL);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Close the pkg database
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
pkgdb_close(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (pkgdbp != NULL) {
|
||||
(void) (*pkgdbp->close) (pkgdbp);
|
||||
pkgdbp = NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Store value "val" with key "key" in database
|
||||
* Return value is as from ypdb_store:
|
||||
* 0: ok
|
||||
* 1: key already present
|
||||
* -1: some other error, see errno
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
pkgdb_store(const char *key, const char *val)
|
||||
{
|
||||
DBT keyd, vald;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkgdbp == NULL)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
|
||||
keyd.data = __UNCONST(key);
|
||||
keyd.size = strlen(key) + 1;
|
||||
vald.data = __UNCONST(val);
|
||||
vald.size = strlen(val) + 1;
|
||||
|
||||
if (keyd.size > MaxPathSize || vald.size > MaxPathSize)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
|
||||
return (*pkgdbp->put) (pkgdbp, &keyd, &vald, R_NOOVERWRITE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Recall value for given key
|
||||
* Return value:
|
||||
* NULL if some error occurred or value for key not found (check errno!)
|
||||
* String for "value" else
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *
|
||||
pkgdb_retrieve(const char *key)
|
||||
{
|
||||
DBT keyd, vald;
|
||||
int status;
|
||||
char *eos;
|
||||
static int corruption_warning;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkgdbp == NULL)
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
keyd.data = __UNCONST(key);
|
||||
keyd.size = strlen(key) + 1;
|
||||
errno = 0; /* to be sure it's 0 if the key doesn't match anything */
|
||||
|
||||
vald.data = (void *)NULL;
|
||||
vald.size = 0;
|
||||
status = (*pkgdbp->get) (pkgdbp, &keyd, &vald, 0);
|
||||
if (status)
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
eos = memchr(vald.data, 0, vald.size);
|
||||
if (eos == NULL || eos + 1 != (char *)vald.data + vald.size) {
|
||||
if (!corruption_warning) {
|
||||
warnx("pkgdb corrupted, please run ``pkg_admin rebuild''");
|
||||
corruption_warning = 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return vald.data;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* dump contents of the database to stdout */
|
||||
int
|
||||
pkgdb_dump(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
DBT key;
|
||||
DBT val;
|
||||
int type;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkgdb_open(ReadOnly)) {
|
||||
for (type = R_FIRST ; (*pkgdbp->seq)(pkgdbp, &key, &val, type) == 0 ; type = R_NEXT) {
|
||||
printf("file: %.*s pkg: %.*s\n",
|
||||
(int) key.size, (char *) key.data,
|
||||
(int) val.size, (char *) val.data);
|
||||
}
|
||||
pkgdb_close();
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
} else
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Remove data set from pkgdb
|
||||
* Return value as ypdb_delete:
|
||||
* 0: everything ok
|
||||
* 1: key not present
|
||||
* -1: some error occurred (see errno)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
pkgdb_remove(const char *key)
|
||||
{
|
||||
DBT keyd;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkgdbp == NULL)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
|
||||
keyd.data = __UNCONST(key);
|
||||
keyd.size = strlen(key) + 1;
|
||||
if (keyd.size > MaxPathSize)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
|
||||
return (*pkgdbp->del) (pkgdbp, &keyd, 0);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Remove any entry from the cache which has a data field of `pkg'.
|
||||
* Return value:
|
||||
* 1: everything ok
|
||||
* 0: error
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
pkgdb_remove_pkg(const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
DBT data;
|
||||
DBT key;
|
||||
int type;
|
||||
int ret;
|
||||
size_t cc;
|
||||
char *cachename;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pkgdbp == NULL) {
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
cachename = pkgdb_get_database();
|
||||
cc = strlen(pkg);
|
||||
for (ret = 1, type = R_FIRST; (*pkgdbp->seq)(pkgdbp, &key, &data, type) == 0 ; type = R_NEXT) {
|
||||
if ((cc + 1) == data.size && strncmp(data.data, pkg, cc) == 0) {
|
||||
if (Verbose) {
|
||||
printf("Removing file `%s' from %s\n", (char *)key.data, cachename);
|
||||
}
|
||||
switch ((*pkgdbp->del)(pkgdbp, &key, 0)) {
|
||||
case -1:
|
||||
warn("Error removing `%s' from %s", (char *)key.data, cachename);
|
||||
ret = 0;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case 1:
|
||||
warn("Key `%s' not present in %s", (char *)key.data, cachename);
|
||||
ret = 0;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(cachename);
|
||||
return ret;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Return the location of the package reference counts database directory.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *
|
||||
pkgdb_refcount_dir(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
static char buf[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
char *tmp;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((tmp = getenv(PKG_REFCOUNT_DBDIR_VNAME)) != NULL)
|
||||
strlcpy(buf, tmp, sizeof(buf));
|
||||
else
|
||||
snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%s.refcount", pkgdb_get_dir());
|
||||
return buf;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Return directory where pkgdb is stored
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *
|
||||
pkgdb_get_dir(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
|
||||
return pkgdb_dir;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Set the first place we look for where pkgdb is stored.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
pkgdb_set_dir(const char *dir, int prio)
|
||||
{
|
||||
|
||||
if (prio < pkgdb_dir_prio)
|
||||
return;
|
||||
|
||||
pkgdb_dir_prio = prio;
|
||||
|
||||
if (dir == pkgdb_dir)
|
||||
return;
|
||||
if (pkgdb_dir != pkgdb_dir_default)
|
||||
free(pkgdb_dir);
|
||||
pkgdb_dir = xstrdup(dir);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
pkgdb_pkg_dir(const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return xasprintf("%s/%s", pkgdb_get_dir(), pkg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
pkgdb_pkg_file(const char *pkg, const char *file)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return xasprintf("%s/%s/%s", pkgdb_get_dir(), pkg, file);
|
||||
}
|
54
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkgsrc.7
vendored
Normal file
54
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/pkgsrc.7
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,54 @@
|
|||
.\" $NetBSD: pkgsrc.7,v 1.1.1.1 2008/09/30 19:00:27 joerg Exp $
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Copyright (c) 2007 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
.\" All rights reserved.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
.\" by Thomas Klausner.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
.\" are met:
|
||||
.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
.\" ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
.\" TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
.\" PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
.\" BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
.\" CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
.\" SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
.\" INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
.\" CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
.\" ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
.\" POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.Dd March 2, 2007
|
||||
.Dt PKGSRC 7
|
||||
.Os
|
||||
.Sh NAME
|
||||
.Nm pkgsrc
|
||||
.Nd NetBSD packages collection (framework for third-party software)
|
||||
.Sh DESCRIPTION
|
||||
The
|
||||
.Nx
|
||||
Packages Collection (pkgsrc) is a framework for building and
|
||||
maintaining third-party software on
|
||||
.Nx
|
||||
and other
|
||||
.Ux Ns -like
|
||||
systems.
|
||||
It is used to enable freely available software to be configured
|
||||
and built easily on supported platforms.
|
||||
.Pp
|
||||
Tools are available to install ready-to-use packages and to perform
|
||||
various administrative tasks for the package system.
|
||||
.Sh SEE ALSO
|
||||
.Xr pkg_add 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_delete 1 ,
|
||||
.Xr pkg_info 1 ,
|
||||
.Pa http://www.netbsd.org/docs/pkgsrc/
|
783
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/plist.c
vendored
Normal file
783
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/plist.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,783 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: plist.c,v 1.1.1.5 2009/08/06 16:55:28 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: plist.c,v 1.1.1.5 2009/08/06 16:55:28 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* General packing list routines.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008, 2009 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERRNO_H
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef NETBSD
|
||||
#include <nbcompat/md5.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#include <md5.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
static int delete_with_parents(const char *, Boolean, Boolean);
|
||||
|
||||
/* This struct defines a plist command type */
|
||||
typedef struct cmd_t {
|
||||
const char *c_s; /* string to recognise */
|
||||
pl_ent_t c_type; /* type of command */
|
||||
int c_argc; /* # of arguments */
|
||||
int c_subst; /* can substitute real prefix */
|
||||
} cmd_t;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Commands to recognise */
|
||||
static const cmd_t cmdv[] = {
|
||||
{"cwd", PLIST_CWD, 1, 1},
|
||||
{"src", PLIST_SRC, 1, 1},
|
||||
{"exec", PLIST_CMD, 1, 0},
|
||||
{"unexec", PLIST_UNEXEC, 1, 0},
|
||||
{"mode", PLIST_CHMOD, 1, 0},
|
||||
{"owner", PLIST_CHOWN, 1, 0},
|
||||
{"group", PLIST_CHGRP, 1, 0},
|
||||
{"comment", PLIST_COMMENT, 1, 0},
|
||||
{"ignore", PLIST_IGNORE, 0, 0},
|
||||
{"name", PLIST_NAME, 1, 0},
|
||||
{"display", PLIST_DISPLAY, 1, 0},
|
||||
{"pkgdep", PLIST_PKGDEP, 1, 0},
|
||||
{"pkgcfl", PLIST_PKGCFL, 1, 0},
|
||||
{"pkgdir", PLIST_PKGDIR, 1, 0},
|
||||
{"dirrm", PLIST_DIR_RM, 1, 0},
|
||||
{"option", PLIST_OPTION, 1, 0},
|
||||
{"blddep", PLIST_BLDDEP, 1, 0},
|
||||
{NULL, FAIL, 0, 0}
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Add an item to the end of a packing list
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
add_plist(package_t *p, pl_ent_t type, const char *arg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *tmp;
|
||||
|
||||
tmp = new_plist_entry();
|
||||
tmp->name = (arg == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup(arg);
|
||||
tmp->type = type;
|
||||
if (!p->head) {
|
||||
p->head = p->tail = tmp;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
tmp->prev = p->tail;
|
||||
p->tail->next = tmp;
|
||||
p->tail = tmp;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Add an item to the start of a packing list
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
add_plist_top(package_t *p, pl_ent_t type, const char *arg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *tmp;
|
||||
|
||||
tmp = new_plist_entry();
|
||||
tmp->name = (arg == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup(arg);
|
||||
tmp->type = type;
|
||||
if (!p->head) {
|
||||
p->head = p->tail = tmp;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
tmp->next = p->head;
|
||||
p->head->prev = tmp;
|
||||
p->head = tmp;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Return the last (most recent) entry in a packing list
|
||||
*/
|
||||
plist_t *
|
||||
last_plist(package_t *p)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return p->tail;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Mark all items in a packing list to prevent iteration over them
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
mark_plist(package_t *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *pp;
|
||||
|
||||
for (pp = pkg->head; pp; pp = pp->next) {
|
||||
pp->marked = TRUE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Find a given item in a packing list and, if so, return it (else NULL)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
plist_t *
|
||||
find_plist(package_t *pkg, pl_ent_t type)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *pp;
|
||||
|
||||
for (pp = pkg->head; pp && pp->type != type; pp = pp->next) {
|
||||
}
|
||||
return pp;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Look for a specific boolean option argument in the list
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *
|
||||
find_plist_option(package_t *pkg, const char *name)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
|
||||
for (p = pkg->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
if (p->type == PLIST_OPTION
|
||||
&& strcmp(p->name, name) == 0) {
|
||||
return p->name;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return (char *) NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Delete plist item 'type' in the list (if 'name' is non-null, match it
|
||||
* too.) If 'all' is set, delete all items, not just the first occurance.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
delete_plist(package_t *pkg, Boolean all, pl_ent_t type, char *name)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *p = pkg->head;
|
||||
|
||||
while (p) {
|
||||
plist_t *pnext = p->next;
|
||||
|
||||
if (p->type == type && (!name || !strcmp(name, p->name))) {
|
||||
free(p->name);
|
||||
if (p->prev)
|
||||
p->prev->next = pnext;
|
||||
else
|
||||
pkg->head = pnext;
|
||||
if (pnext)
|
||||
pnext->prev = p->prev;
|
||||
else
|
||||
pkg->tail = p->prev;
|
||||
free(p);
|
||||
if (!all)
|
||||
return;
|
||||
p = pnext;
|
||||
} else
|
||||
p = p->next;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Allocate a new packing list entry, and return a pointer to it.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
plist_t *
|
||||
new_plist_entry(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return xcalloc(1, sizeof(plist_t));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Free an entire packing list
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
free_plist(package_t *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *p = pkg->head;
|
||||
|
||||
while (p) {
|
||||
plist_t *p1 = p->next;
|
||||
|
||||
free(p->name);
|
||||
free(p);
|
||||
p = p1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
pkg->head = pkg->tail = NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* For an ASCII string denoting a plist command, return its code and
|
||||
* optionally its argument(s)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
plist_cmd(const char *s, char **arg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const cmd_t *cmdp;
|
||||
const char *cp, *sp;
|
||||
char *sp2;
|
||||
|
||||
sp = NULL; /* Older GCC can't detect that the loop is executed */
|
||||
|
||||
for (cmdp = cmdv; cmdp->c_s; ++cmdp) {
|
||||
for (sp = s, cp = cmdp->c_s; *sp && *cp; ++cp, ++sp)
|
||||
if (*sp != *cp)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
if (*cp == '\0')
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (cmdp->c_s == NULL || arg == NULL)
|
||||
return cmdp->c_type;
|
||||
|
||||
while (isspace((unsigned char)*sp))
|
||||
++sp;
|
||||
*arg = xstrdup(sp);
|
||||
if (*sp) {
|
||||
sp2 = *arg + strlen(*arg) - 1;
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* The earlier loop ensured that at least one non-whitespace
|
||||
* is in the string.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
while (isspace((unsigned char)*sp2))
|
||||
--sp2;
|
||||
sp2[1] = '\0';
|
||||
}
|
||||
return cmdp->c_type;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Parse a packaging list from a memory buffer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
parse_plist(package_t *pkg, const char *buf)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int cmd;
|
||||
char *line, *cp;
|
||||
const char *eol, *next;
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
|
||||
pkg->head = NULL;
|
||||
pkg->tail = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
for (; *buf; buf = next) {
|
||||
/* Until add_plist can deal with trailing whitespace. */
|
||||
if ((eol = strchr(buf, '\n')) != NULL) {
|
||||
next = eol + 1;
|
||||
len = eol - buf;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
len = strlen(buf);
|
||||
next = buf + len;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
while (len && isspace((unsigned char)buf[len - 1]))
|
||||
--len;
|
||||
|
||||
if (len == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
|
||||
line = xmalloc(len + 1);
|
||||
memcpy(line, buf, len);
|
||||
line[len] = '\0';
|
||||
|
||||
if (*(cp = line) == CMD_CHAR) {
|
||||
if ((cmd = plist_cmd(line + 1, &cp)) == FAIL) {
|
||||
warnx("Unrecognised PLIST command `%s'", line);
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (*cp == '\0') {
|
||||
free(cp);
|
||||
cp = NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
cmd = PLIST_FILE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
add_plist(pkg, cmd, cp);
|
||||
free(cp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Read a packing list from a file
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
append_plist(package_t *pkg, FILE * fp)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char pline[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
char *cp;
|
||||
int cmd;
|
||||
int len;
|
||||
int free_cp;
|
||||
|
||||
while (fgets(pline, MaxPathSize, fp) != (char *) NULL) {
|
||||
for (len = strlen(pline); len &&
|
||||
isspace((unsigned char) pline[len - 1]);) {
|
||||
pline[--len] = '\0';
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (len == 0) {
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free_cp = 0;
|
||||
if (*(cp = pline) == CMD_CHAR) {
|
||||
if ((cmd = plist_cmd(pline + 1, &cp)) == FAIL) {
|
||||
warnx("Unrecognised PLIST command `%s'", pline);
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (*cp == '\0') {
|
||||
free(cp);
|
||||
cp = NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free_cp = 1;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
cmd = PLIST_FILE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
add_plist(pkg, cmd, cp);
|
||||
if (free_cp)
|
||||
free(cp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
read_plist(package_t *pkg, FILE * fp)
|
||||
{
|
||||
pkg->head = NULL;
|
||||
pkg->tail = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
append_plist(pkg, fp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Write a packing list to a file, converting commands to ASCII equivs
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
write_plist(package_t *pkg, FILE * fp, char *realprefix)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
const cmd_t *cmdp;
|
||||
|
||||
for (p = pkg->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
if (p->type == PLIST_FILE) {
|
||||
/* Fast-track files - these are the most common */
|
||||
(void) fprintf(fp, "%s\n", p->name);
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
for (cmdp = cmdv; cmdp->c_type != FAIL && cmdp->c_type != p->type; cmdp++) {
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (cmdp->c_type == FAIL) {
|
||||
warnx("Unknown PLIST command type %d (%s)", p->type, p->name);
|
||||
} else if (cmdp->c_argc == 0) {
|
||||
(void) fprintf(fp, "%c%s\n", CMD_CHAR, cmdp->c_s);
|
||||
} else if (cmdp->c_subst && realprefix) {
|
||||
(void) fprintf(fp, "%c%s %s\n", CMD_CHAR, cmdp->c_s, realprefix);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
(void) fprintf(fp, "%c%s %s\n", CMD_CHAR, cmdp->c_s,
|
||||
(p->name) ? p->name : "");
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Like write_plist, but compute memory string.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void
|
||||
stringify_plist(package_t *pkg, char **real_buf, size_t *real_len,
|
||||
const char *realprefix)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
const cmd_t *cmdp;
|
||||
char *buf;
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
int item_len;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Pass One: compute output size only. */
|
||||
len = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
for (p = pkg->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
if (p->type == PLIST_FILE) {
|
||||
len += strlen(p->name) + 1;
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
for (cmdp = cmdv; cmdp->c_type != FAIL && cmdp->c_type != p->type; cmdp++) {
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (cmdp->c_type == FAIL)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (cmdp->c_argc == 0)
|
||||
len += 1 + strlen(cmdp->c_s) + 1;
|
||||
else if (cmdp->c_subst && realprefix)
|
||||
len += 1 + strlen(cmdp->c_s) + 1 + strlen(realprefix) + 1;
|
||||
else
|
||||
len += 1 + strlen(cmdp->c_s) + 1 + strlen(p->name ? p->name : "") + 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Pass Two: build actual string. */
|
||||
buf = xmalloc(len + 1);
|
||||
*real_buf = buf;
|
||||
*real_len = len;
|
||||
++len;
|
||||
|
||||
#define UPDATE_LEN \
|
||||
do { \
|
||||
if (item_len < 0 || (size_t)item_len > len) \
|
||||
errx(2, "Size computation failed, aborted."); \
|
||||
buf += item_len; \
|
||||
len -= item_len; \
|
||||
} while (/* CONSTCOND */0)
|
||||
|
||||
for (p = pkg->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
if (p->type == PLIST_FILE) {
|
||||
/* Fast-track files - these are the most common */
|
||||
item_len = snprintf(buf, len, "%s\n", p->name);
|
||||
UPDATE_LEN;
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
for (cmdp = cmdv; cmdp->c_type != FAIL && cmdp->c_type != p->type; cmdp++) {
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (cmdp->c_type == FAIL) {
|
||||
warnx("Unknown PLIST command type %d (%s)", p->type, p->name);
|
||||
} else if (cmdp->c_argc == 0) {
|
||||
item_len = snprintf(buf, len, "%c%s\n", CMD_CHAR, cmdp->c_s);
|
||||
UPDATE_LEN;
|
||||
} else if (cmdp->c_subst && realprefix) {
|
||||
item_len = snprintf(buf, len, "%c%s %s\n", CMD_CHAR, cmdp->c_s, realprefix);
|
||||
UPDATE_LEN;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
item_len = snprintf(buf, len, "%c%s %s\n", CMD_CHAR, cmdp->c_s,
|
||||
(p->name) ? p->name : "");
|
||||
UPDATE_LEN;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (len != 1)
|
||||
errx(2, "Size computation failed, aborted.");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Delete the results of a package installation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This is here rather than in the pkg_delete code because pkg_add needs to
|
||||
* run it too in cases of failure.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
delete_package(Boolean ign_err, package_t *pkg, Boolean NoDeleteFiles,
|
||||
const char *destdir)
|
||||
{
|
||||
plist_t *p;
|
||||
const char *last_file = "";
|
||||
int fail = SUCCESS;
|
||||
Boolean preserve;
|
||||
char tmp[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
const char *prefix = NULL, *name = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!pkgdb_open(ReadWrite)) {
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "cannot open pkgdb");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
preserve = find_plist_option(pkg, "preserve") ? TRUE : FALSE;
|
||||
|
||||
for (p = pkg->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
switch (p->type) {
|
||||
case PLIST_NAME:
|
||||
name = p->name;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
case PLIST_CWD:
|
||||
if (prefix == NULL)
|
||||
prefix = p->name;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (name == NULL || prefix == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "broken PLIST");
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Remove database entries first, directory removal is done
|
||||
* in the main loop below.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
for (p = pkg->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
if (p->type == PLIST_PKGDIR)
|
||||
delete_pkgdir(name, prefix, p->name);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
for (p = pkg->head; p; p = p->next) {
|
||||
switch (p->type) {
|
||||
case PLIST_NAME:
|
||||
/* Handled already */
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case PLIST_PKGDIR:
|
||||
case PLIST_DIR_RM:
|
||||
(void) snprintf(tmp, sizeof(tmp), "%s/%s",
|
||||
prefix, p->name);
|
||||
if (has_pkgdir(tmp))
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
(void) snprintf(tmp, sizeof(tmp), "%s%s%s/%s",
|
||||
destdir ? destdir : "", destdir ? "/" : "",
|
||||
prefix, p->name);
|
||||
if (!fexists(tmp)) {
|
||||
if (p->type == PLIST_PKGDIR)
|
||||
warnx("Directory `%s' disappeared, skipping", tmp);
|
||||
} else if (!isdir(tmp)) {
|
||||
warnx("attempting to delete a file `%s' as a directory\n"
|
||||
"this packing list is incorrect - ignoring delete request", tmp);
|
||||
} else if (delete_with_parents(tmp, ign_err, TRUE))
|
||||
fail = FAIL;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case PLIST_IGNORE:
|
||||
p = p->next;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case PLIST_UNEXEC:
|
||||
if (NoDeleteFiles)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
format_cmd(tmp, sizeof(tmp), p->name, prefix, last_file);
|
||||
printf("Executing `%s'\n", tmp);
|
||||
if (!Fake && system(tmp)) {
|
||||
warnx("unexec command for `%s' failed", tmp);
|
||||
fail = FAIL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case PLIST_FILE:
|
||||
last_file = p->name;
|
||||
(void) snprintf(tmp, sizeof(tmp), "%s%s%s/%s",
|
||||
destdir ? destdir : "", destdir ? "/" : "",
|
||||
prefix, p->name);
|
||||
if (isdir(tmp)) {
|
||||
warnx("attempting to delete directory `%s' as a file\n"
|
||||
"this packing list is incorrect - ignoring delete request", tmp);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
int restored = 0; /* restored from preserve? */
|
||||
|
||||
if (p->next && p->next->type == PLIST_COMMENT) {
|
||||
if (strncmp(p->next->name, CHECKSUM_HEADER, ChecksumHeaderLen) == 0) {
|
||||
char *cp, buf[LegibleChecksumLen];
|
||||
|
||||
if ((cp = MD5File(tmp, buf)) != NULL) {
|
||||
/* Mismatch? */
|
||||
if (strcmp(cp, p->next->name + ChecksumHeaderLen) != 0) {
|
||||
printf("original MD5 checksum failed, %s: %s\n",
|
||||
Force ? "deleting anyway" : "not deleting", tmp);
|
||||
if (!Force) {
|
||||
fail = FAIL;
|
||||
goto pkgdb_cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
} else if (strncmp(p->next->name, SYMLINK_HEADER, SymlinkHeaderLen) == 0) {
|
||||
char buf[MaxPathSize + SymlinkHeaderLen];
|
||||
int cc;
|
||||
|
||||
(void) strlcpy(buf, SYMLINK_HEADER,
|
||||
sizeof(buf));
|
||||
if ((cc = readlink(tmp, &buf[SymlinkHeaderLen],
|
||||
sizeof(buf) - SymlinkHeaderLen - 1)) < 0) {
|
||||
warn("can't readlink `%s'", tmp);
|
||||
goto pkgdb_cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
buf[SymlinkHeaderLen + cc] = 0x0;
|
||||
if (strcmp(buf, p->next->name) != 0) {
|
||||
if ((cc = readlink(&buf[SymlinkHeaderLen], &buf[SymlinkHeaderLen],
|
||||
sizeof(buf) - SymlinkHeaderLen)) < 0) {
|
||||
printf("symlink %s is not same as recorded value, %s: %s\n",
|
||||
buf, Force ? "deleting anyway" : "not deleting", tmp);
|
||||
if (!Force) {
|
||||
fail = FAIL;
|
||||
goto pkgdb_cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
buf[SymlinkHeaderLen + cc] = 0x0;
|
||||
if (strcmp(buf, p->next->name) != 0) {
|
||||
printf("symlink %s is not same as recorded value, %s: %s\n",
|
||||
buf, Force ? "deleting anyway" : "not deleting", tmp);
|
||||
if (!Force) {
|
||||
fail = FAIL;
|
||||
goto pkgdb_cleanup;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Verbose && !NoDeleteFiles)
|
||||
printf("Delete file %s\n", tmp);
|
||||
if (!Fake && !NoDeleteFiles) {
|
||||
if (delete_with_parents(tmp, ign_err, FALSE))
|
||||
fail = FAIL;
|
||||
if (preserve && name) {
|
||||
char tmp2[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
|
||||
if (make_preserve_name(tmp2, MaxPathSize, name, tmp)) {
|
||||
if (fexists(tmp2)) {
|
||||
if (rename(tmp2, tmp))
|
||||
warn("preserve: unable to restore %s as %s",
|
||||
tmp2, tmp);
|
||||
else
|
||||
restored = 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
pkgdb_cleanup:
|
||||
if (!Fake) {
|
||||
if (!restored) {
|
||||
errno = 0;
|
||||
if (pkgdb_remove(tmp) && errno)
|
||||
perror("pkgdb_remove");
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
pkgdb_close();
|
||||
return fail;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Selectively delete a hierarchy
|
||||
* Returns 1 on error, 0 else.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int
|
||||
delete_with_parents(const char *fname, Boolean ign_err, Boolean ign_nonempty)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *cp, *cp2;
|
||||
|
||||
if (remove(fname)) {
|
||||
if (!ign_err && (!ign_nonempty || errno != ENOTEMPTY))
|
||||
warnx("Couldn't remove %s", fname);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
cp = xstrdup(fname);
|
||||
while (*cp) {
|
||||
if ((cp2 = strrchr(cp, '/')) != NULL)
|
||||
*cp2 = '\0';
|
||||
if (!isemptydir(cp))
|
||||
break;
|
||||
if (has_pkgdir(cp))
|
||||
break;
|
||||
if (rmdir(cp))
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(cp);
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
add_pkgdir(const char *pkg, const char *prefix, const char *path)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *fullpath, *oldvalue, *newvalue;
|
||||
|
||||
fullpath = xasprintf("%s/%s", prefix, path);
|
||||
oldvalue = pkgdb_retrieve(fullpath);
|
||||
if (oldvalue) {
|
||||
if (strncmp(oldvalue, "@pkgdir ", 8) != 0)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Internal error while processing pkgdb, run pkg_admin rebuild");
|
||||
newvalue = xasprintf("%s %s", oldvalue, pkg);
|
||||
pkgdb_remove(fullpath);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
newvalue = xasprintf("@pkgdir %s", pkg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
pkgdb_store(fullpath, newvalue);
|
||||
|
||||
free(fullpath);
|
||||
free(newvalue);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
delete_pkgdir(const char *pkg, const char *prefix, const char *path)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t pkg_len, len;
|
||||
char *fullpath, *oldvalue, *newvalue, *iter;
|
||||
|
||||
fullpath = xasprintf("%s/%s", prefix, path);
|
||||
oldvalue = pkgdb_retrieve(fullpath);
|
||||
if (oldvalue && strncmp(oldvalue, "@pkgdir ", 8) == 0) {
|
||||
newvalue = xstrdup(oldvalue);
|
||||
iter = newvalue + 8;
|
||||
pkg_len = strlen(pkg);
|
||||
while (*iter) {
|
||||
if (strncmp(iter, pkg, pkg_len) == 0 &&
|
||||
(iter[pkg_len] == ' ' || iter[pkg_len] == '\0')) {
|
||||
len = strlen(iter + pkg_len);
|
||||
memmove(iter, iter + pkg_len + 1, len);
|
||||
if (len == 0)
|
||||
*iter = '\0';
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
iter += strcspn(iter, " ");
|
||||
iter += strspn(iter, " ");
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
pkgdb_remove(fullpath);
|
||||
if (iter != newvalue + 8)
|
||||
pkgdb_store(fullpath, newvalue);
|
||||
free(newvalue);
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(fullpath);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
has_pkgdir(const char *path)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *value;
|
||||
|
||||
value = pkgdb_retrieve(path);
|
||||
|
||||
if (value && strncmp(value, "@pkgdir ", 8) == 0)
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
else
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
195
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/remove.c
vendored
Normal file
195
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/remove.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,195 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: remove.c,v 1.1.1.2 2009/08/06 16:55:29 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: remove.c,v 1.1.1.2 2009/08/06 16:55:29 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_DIRENT_H
|
||||
#include <dirent.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_FCNTL_H
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <limits.h>
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
safe_fchdir(int cwd)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int tmp_errno, rv;
|
||||
|
||||
tmp_errno = errno;
|
||||
rv = fchdir(cwd);
|
||||
errno = tmp_errno;
|
||||
|
||||
return rv;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
long_remove(const char **path_ptr, int missing_ok, int *did_chdir)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char tmp_path[PATH_MAX + 1];
|
||||
const char *path;
|
||||
size_t i, len;
|
||||
int rv;
|
||||
|
||||
path = *path_ptr;
|
||||
len = strlen(path);
|
||||
*did_chdir = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
while (len >= PATH_MAX) {
|
||||
for (i = PATH_MAX - 1; i > 0; --i) {
|
||||
if (path[i] == '/')
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (i == 0) {
|
||||
errno = ENAMETOOLONG;
|
||||
return -1; /* Assumes PATH_MAX > NAME_MAX */
|
||||
}
|
||||
memcpy(tmp_path, path, i);
|
||||
tmp_path[i] = '\0';
|
||||
if (chdir(tmp_path))
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
*did_chdir = 1;
|
||||
path += i + 1;
|
||||
len -= i + 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (remove(path) == 0 || (errno == ENOENT && missing_ok))
|
||||
rv = 0;
|
||||
else
|
||||
rv = -1;
|
||||
|
||||
*path_ptr = path;
|
||||
|
||||
return rv;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
recursive_remove_internal(const char *path, int missing_ok, int cwd)
|
||||
{
|
||||
DIR *dir;
|
||||
struct dirent *de;
|
||||
const char *sub_path;
|
||||
char *subdir;
|
||||
int did_chdir, rv;
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* If the argument is longer than PATH_MAX, long_remove
|
||||
* will try to shorten it using chdir. So before returning,
|
||||
* make sure to fchdir back to the original cwd.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
sub_path = path;
|
||||
if (long_remove(&sub_path, missing_ok, &did_chdir) == 0)
|
||||
rv = 0;
|
||||
else if (errno != ENOTEMPTY) /* Other errors are terminal. */
|
||||
rv = -1;
|
||||
else
|
||||
rv = 1;
|
||||
|
||||
if (rv != 1) {
|
||||
if (did_chdir && safe_fchdir(cwd) == -1 && rv == 0)
|
||||
rv = -1;
|
||||
return rv;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if ((dir = opendir(sub_path)) == NULL) {
|
||||
if (errno == EMFILE)
|
||||
warn("opendir failed");
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (did_chdir && fchdir(cwd) == -1)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
|
||||
rv = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
while ((de = readdir(dir)) != NULL) {
|
||||
if (strcmp(de->d_name, ".") == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (strcmp(de->d_name, "..") == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
subdir = xasprintf("%s/%s", path, de->d_name);
|
||||
rv = recursive_remove_internal(subdir, 1, cwd);
|
||||
free(subdir);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
closedir(dir);
|
||||
|
||||
safe_fchdir(cwd);
|
||||
|
||||
rv |= long_remove(&path, missing_ok, &did_chdir);
|
||||
|
||||
if (did_chdir && safe_fchdir(cwd) == -1 && rv == 0)
|
||||
rv = -1;
|
||||
|
||||
return rv;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
recursive_remove(const char *path, int missing_ok)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int orig_cwd, rv;
|
||||
|
||||
/* First try the easy case of regular file or empty directory. */
|
||||
if (remove(path) == 0 || (errno == ENOENT && missing_ok))
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* If the path is too long, long_remove will use chdir to shorten it,
|
||||
* so remember the current directory first.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
if ((orig_cwd = open(".", O_RDONLY)) == -1)
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
|
||||
rv = recursive_remove_internal(path, missing_ok, orig_cwd);
|
||||
|
||||
close(orig_cwd);
|
||||
return rv;
|
||||
}
|
102
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/str.c
vendored
Normal file
102
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/str.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,102 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: str.c,v 1.1.1.2 2009/02/02 20:44:08 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: str.c,v 1.1.1.2 2009/02/02 20:44:08 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* FreeBSD install - a package for the installation and maintainance
|
||||
* of non-core utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Jordan K. Hubbard
|
||||
* 18 July 1993
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Miscellaneous string utilities.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ASSERT_H
|
||||
#include <assert.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_FNMATCH_H
|
||||
#include <fnmatch.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
#include "dewey.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* pull in definitions and macros for resizing arrays as we go */
|
||||
#include "defs.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Return the suffix portion of a path
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *
|
||||
suffix_of(const char *str)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *dot;
|
||||
|
||||
return ((dot = strrchr(basename_of(str), '.')) == NULL) ? "" : dot + 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Return the filename portion of a path
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *
|
||||
basename_of(const char *str)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *slash;
|
||||
|
||||
return ((slash = strrchr(str, '/')) == NULL) ? str : slash + 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Return the dirname portion of a path
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *
|
||||
dirname_of(const char *path)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t cc;
|
||||
char *s;
|
||||
static char buf[MaxPathSize];
|
||||
|
||||
if ((s = strrchr(path, '/')) == NULL) {
|
||||
return ".";
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (s == path) {
|
||||
/* "/foo" -> return "/" */
|
||||
return "/";
|
||||
}
|
||||
cc = (size_t) (s - path);
|
||||
if (cc >= sizeof(buf))
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "dirname_of: too long dirname: '%s'", path);
|
||||
(void) memcpy(buf, path, cc);
|
||||
buf[cc] = 0;
|
||||
return buf;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Does the pkgname contain any of the special chars ("{[]?*<>")?
|
||||
* If so, return 1, else 0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
ispkgpattern(const char *pkg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return strpbrk(pkg, "<>[]?*{") != NULL;
|
||||
}
|
345
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/var.c
vendored
Normal file
345
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/var.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,345 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: var.c,v 1.2 2013/05/16 19:19:44 martin Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2005, 2008 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This code is derived from software contributed to The NetBSD Foundation
|
||||
* by Dieter Baron, Thomas Klausner, Johnny Lam, and Joerg Sonnenberger.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
* 3. Neither the name of The NetBSD Foundation nor the names of its
|
||||
* contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived
|
||||
* from this software without specific prior written permission.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
|
||||
* TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
* PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
|
||||
* CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
|
||||
* SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
|
||||
* INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
|
||||
* CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
|
||||
* ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
|
||||
* POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: var.c,v 1.2 2013/05/16 19:19:44 martin Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_STAT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/stat.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERRNO_H
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDIO_H
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static const char *var_cmp(const char *, size_t, const char *, size_t);
|
||||
static void var_print(FILE *, const char *, const char *);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Copy the specified varibales from the file fname to stdout.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
var_copy_list(const char *buf, const char **variables)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *eol, *next;
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
|
||||
for (; *buf; buf = next) {
|
||||
if ((eol = strchr(buf, '\n')) != NULL) {
|
||||
next = eol + 1;
|
||||
len = eol - buf;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
next = eol;
|
||||
len = strlen(buf);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
for (i=0; variables[i]; i++) {
|
||||
if (var_cmp(buf, len, variables[i],
|
||||
strlen(variables[i])) != NULL) {
|
||||
printf("%.*s\n", (int)len, buf);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Print the value of variable from the file fname to stdout.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *
|
||||
var_get(const char *fname, const char *variable)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *fp;
|
||||
char *line;
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
size_t varlen;
|
||||
char *value;
|
||||
size_t valuelen;
|
||||
size_t thislen;
|
||||
const char *p;
|
||||
|
||||
varlen = strlen(variable);
|
||||
if (varlen == 0)
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
fp = fopen(fname, "r");
|
||||
if (!fp) {
|
||||
if (errno != ENOENT)
|
||||
warn("var_get: can't open '%s' for reading", fname);
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
value = NULL;
|
||||
valuelen = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
while ((line = fgetln(fp, &len)) != (char *) NULL) {
|
||||
if (line[len - 1] == '\n')
|
||||
--len;
|
||||
if ((p=var_cmp(line, len, variable, varlen)) == NULL)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
|
||||
thislen = line+len - p;
|
||||
if (value) {
|
||||
value = xrealloc(value, valuelen+thislen+2);
|
||||
value[valuelen++] = '\n';
|
||||
}
|
||||
else {
|
||||
value = xmalloc(thislen+1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
sprintf(value+valuelen, "%.*s", (int)thislen, p);
|
||||
valuelen += thislen;
|
||||
}
|
||||
(void) fclose(fp);
|
||||
return value;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Print the value of variable from the memory buffer to stdout.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *
|
||||
var_get_memory(const char *buf, const char *variable)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *eol, *next, *data;
|
||||
size_t len, varlen, thislen, valuelen;
|
||||
char *value;
|
||||
|
||||
varlen = strlen(variable);
|
||||
if (varlen == 0)
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
value = NULL;
|
||||
valuelen = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
for (; buf && *buf; buf = next) {
|
||||
if ((eol = strchr(buf, '\n')) != NULL) {
|
||||
next = eol + 1;
|
||||
len = eol - buf;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
next = eol;
|
||||
len = strlen(buf);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((data = var_cmp(buf, len, variable, varlen)) == NULL)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
|
||||
thislen = buf + len - data;
|
||||
if (value) {
|
||||
value = xrealloc(value, valuelen+thislen+2);
|
||||
value[valuelen++] = '\n';
|
||||
}
|
||||
else {
|
||||
value = xmalloc(thislen+1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
sprintf(value + valuelen, "%.*s", (int)thislen, data);
|
||||
valuelen += thislen;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return value;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Add given variable with given value to file, overwriting any
|
||||
* previous occurrence.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int
|
||||
var_set(const char *fname, const char *variable, const char *value)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *fp;
|
||||
FILE *fout;
|
||||
char *tmpname;
|
||||
int fd;
|
||||
char *line;
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
size_t varlen;
|
||||
Boolean done;
|
||||
struct stat st;
|
||||
|
||||
varlen = strlen(variable);
|
||||
if (varlen == 0)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
fp = fopen(fname, "r");
|
||||
if (fp == NULL) {
|
||||
if (errno != ENOENT) {
|
||||
warn("var_set: can't open '%s' for reading", fname);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (value == NULL)
|
||||
return 0; /* Nothing to do */
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
tmpname = xasprintf("%s.XXXXXX", fname);
|
||||
if ((fd = mkstemp(tmpname)) < 0) {
|
||||
free(tmpname);
|
||||
if (fp != NULL)
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
warn("var_set: can't open temp file for '%s' for writing",
|
||||
fname);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (chmod(tmpname, 0644) < 0) {
|
||||
close(fd);
|
||||
if (fp != NULL)
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
free(tmpname);
|
||||
warn("var_set: can't set permissions for temp file for '%s'",
|
||||
fname);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((fout=fdopen(fd, "w")) == NULL) {
|
||||
close(fd);
|
||||
remove(tmpname);
|
||||
free(tmpname);
|
||||
if (fp != NULL)
|
||||
fclose(fp);
|
||||
warn("var_set: can't open temp file for '%s' for writing",
|
||||
fname);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
done = FALSE;
|
||||
|
||||
if (fp) {
|
||||
while ((line = fgetln(fp, &len)) != (char *) NULL) {
|
||||
if (var_cmp(line, len, variable, varlen) == NULL)
|
||||
fprintf(fout, "%.*s", (int)len, line);
|
||||
else {
|
||||
if (!done && value) {
|
||||
var_print(fout, variable, value);
|
||||
done = TRUE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
(void) fclose(fp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (!done && value)
|
||||
var_print(fout, variable, value);
|
||||
|
||||
if (fclose(fout) < 0) {
|
||||
free(tmpname);
|
||||
warn("var_set: write error for '%s'", fname);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (stat(tmpname, &st) < 0) {
|
||||
free(tmpname);
|
||||
warn("var_set: cannot stat tempfile for '%s'", fname);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (st.st_size == 0) {
|
||||
if (remove(tmpname) < 0) {
|
||||
free(tmpname);
|
||||
warn("var_set: cannot remove tempfile for '%s'",
|
||||
fname);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(tmpname);
|
||||
if (remove(fname) < 0) {
|
||||
warn("var_set: cannot remove '%s'", fname);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (rename(tmpname, fname) < 0) {
|
||||
free(tmpname);
|
||||
warn("var_set: cannot move tempfile to '%s'", fname);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(tmpname);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Check if line contains variable var, return pointer to its value or NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static const char *
|
||||
var_cmp(const char *line, size_t linelen, const char *var, size_t varlen)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* We expect lines to look like one of the following
|
||||
* forms:
|
||||
* VAR=value
|
||||
* VAR= value
|
||||
* We print out the value of VAR, or nothing if it
|
||||
* doesn't exist.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
if (linelen < varlen+1)
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
if (strncmp(var, line, varlen) != 0)
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
line += varlen;
|
||||
if (*line != '=')
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
++line;
|
||||
linelen -= varlen+1;
|
||||
if (linelen > 0 && *line == ' ')
|
||||
++line;
|
||||
return line;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Print given variable with value to file f.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static void
|
||||
var_print(FILE *f, const char *variable, const char *value)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *p;
|
||||
|
||||
while ((p=strchr(value, '\n')) != NULL) {
|
||||
if (p != value)
|
||||
fprintf(f, "%s=%.*s\n", variable, (int)(p-value), value);
|
||||
value = p+1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (*value)
|
||||
fprintf(f, "%s=%s\n", variable, value);
|
||||
}
|
49
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/version.c
vendored
Normal file
49
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/version.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,49 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: version.c,v 1.1.1.3 2010/02/03 14:24:00 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: version.c,v 1.1.1.3 2010/02/03 14:24:00 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2001 Thomas Klausner. All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR
|
||||
* IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
|
||||
* OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED.
|
||||
* IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
|
||||
* NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
|
||||
* DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
|
||||
* THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
|
||||
* (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDIO_H
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
#include "version.h"
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
show_version(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
printf("%d\n", PKGTOOLS_VERSION);
|
||||
exit (0);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
32
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/version.h
vendored
Normal file
32
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/version.h
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,32 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: version.h,v 1.10 2013/04/20 15:29:23 wiz Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2001 Thomas Klausner. All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
|
||||
* documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR
|
||||
* IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
|
||||
* OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED.
|
||||
* IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
|
||||
* NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
|
||||
* DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
|
||||
* THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
|
||||
* (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _INST_LIB_VERSION_H_
|
||||
#define _INST_LIB_VERSION_H_
|
||||
|
||||
#define PKGTOOLS_VERSION 20130131
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _INST_LIB_VERSION_H_ */
|
652
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/vulnerabilities-file.c
vendored
Normal file
652
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/vulnerabilities-file.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,652 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: vulnerabilities-file.c,v 1.1.1.5 2010/06/26 00:14:33 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008, 2010 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: vulnerabilities-file.c,v 1.1.1.5 2010/06/26 00:14:33 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_STAT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/stat.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_WAIT_H
|
||||
#include <sys/wait.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef BOOTSTRAP
|
||||
#include <archive.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <ctype.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#include <limits.h>
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
#ifndef NETBSD
|
||||
#include <nbcompat/sha1.h>
|
||||
#include <nbcompat/sha2.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#include <sha1.h>
|
||||
#include <sha2.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static struct pkg_vulnerabilities *read_pkg_vulnerabilities_archive(struct archive *, int);
|
||||
static struct pkg_vulnerabilities *parse_pkg_vuln(const char *, size_t, int);
|
||||
|
||||
static const char pgp_msg_start[] = "-----BEGIN PGP SIGNED MESSAGE-----\n";
|
||||
static const char pgp_msg_end[] = "-----BEGIN PGP SIGNATURE-----\n";
|
||||
static const char pkcs7_begin[] = "-----BEGIN PKCS7-----\n";
|
||||
static const char pkcs7_end[] = "-----END PKCS7-----\n";
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
verify_signature_pkcs7(const char *input)
|
||||
{
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_SSL
|
||||
const char *begin_pkgvul, *end_pkgvul, *begin_sig, *end_sig;
|
||||
|
||||
if (strncmp(input, pgp_msg_start, strlen(pgp_msg_start)) == 0) {
|
||||
begin_pkgvul = input + strlen(pgp_msg_start);
|
||||
if ((end_pkgvul = strstr(begin_pkgvul, pgp_msg_end)) == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Invalid PGP signature");
|
||||
if ((begin_sig = strstr(end_pkgvul, pkcs7_begin)) == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "No PKCS7 signature");
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
begin_pkgvul = input;
|
||||
if ((begin_sig = strstr(begin_pkgvul, pkcs7_begin)) == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "No PKCS7 signature");
|
||||
end_pkgvul = begin_sig;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if ((end_sig = strstr(begin_sig, pkcs7_end)) == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Invalid PKCS7 signature");
|
||||
end_sig += strlen(pkcs7_end);
|
||||
|
||||
if (easy_pkcs7_verify(begin_pkgvul, end_pkgvul - begin_pkgvul,
|
||||
begin_sig, end_sig - begin_sig, certs_pkg_vulnerabilities, 0))
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Unable to verify PKCS7 signature");
|
||||
#else
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "OpenSSL support is not compiled in");
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
verify_signature(const char *input, size_t input_len)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (gpg_cmd == NULL && certs_pkg_vulnerabilities == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE,
|
||||
"At least GPG or CERTIFICATE_ANCHOR_PKGVULN "
|
||||
"must be configured");
|
||||
if (gpg_cmd != NULL)
|
||||
inline_gpg_verify(input, input_len, gpg_keyring_pkgvuln);
|
||||
if (certs_pkg_vulnerabilities != NULL)
|
||||
verify_signature_pkcs7(input);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void *
|
||||
sha512_hash_init(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
static SHA512_CTX hash_ctx;
|
||||
|
||||
SHA512_Init(&hash_ctx);
|
||||
return &hash_ctx;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
sha512_hash_update(void *ctx, const void *data, size_t len)
|
||||
{
|
||||
SHA512_CTX *hash_ctx = ctx;
|
||||
|
||||
SHA512_Update(hash_ctx, data, len);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static const char *
|
||||
sha512_hash_finish(void *ctx)
|
||||
{
|
||||
static char hash[SHA512_DIGEST_STRING_LENGTH];
|
||||
unsigned char digest[SHA512_DIGEST_LENGTH];
|
||||
SHA512_CTX *hash_ctx = ctx;
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
|
||||
SHA512_Final(digest, hash_ctx);
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < SHA512_DIGEST_LENGTH; ++i) {
|
||||
unsigned char c;
|
||||
|
||||
c = digest[i] / 16;
|
||||
if (c < 10)
|
||||
hash[2 * i] = '0' + c;
|
||||
else
|
||||
hash[2 * i] = 'a' - 10 + c;
|
||||
|
||||
c = digest[i] % 16;
|
||||
if (c < 10)
|
||||
hash[2 * i + 1] = '0' + c;
|
||||
else
|
||||
hash[2 * i + 1] = 'a' - 10 + c;
|
||||
}
|
||||
hash[2 * i] = '\0';
|
||||
|
||||
return hash;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void *
|
||||
sha1_hash_init(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
static SHA1_CTX hash_ctx;
|
||||
|
||||
SHA1Init(&hash_ctx);
|
||||
return &hash_ctx;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
sha1_hash_update(void *ctx, const void *data, size_t len)
|
||||
{
|
||||
SHA1_CTX *hash_ctx = ctx;
|
||||
|
||||
SHA1Update(hash_ctx, data, len);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static const char *
|
||||
sha1_hash_finish(void *ctx)
|
||||
{
|
||||
static char hash[SHA1_DIGEST_STRING_LENGTH];
|
||||
SHA1_CTX *hash_ctx = ctx;
|
||||
|
||||
SHA1End(hash_ctx, hash);
|
||||
|
||||
return hash;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static const struct hash_algorithm {
|
||||
const char *name;
|
||||
size_t name_len;
|
||||
void * (*init)(void);
|
||||
void (*update)(void *, const void *, size_t);
|
||||
const char * (* finish)(void *);
|
||||
} hash_algorithms[] = {
|
||||
{ "SHA512", 6, sha512_hash_init, sha512_hash_update,
|
||||
sha512_hash_finish },
|
||||
{ "SHA1", 4, sha1_hash_init, sha1_hash_update,
|
||||
sha1_hash_finish },
|
||||
{ NULL, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL }
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
verify_hash(const char *input, const char *hash_line)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const struct hash_algorithm *hash;
|
||||
void *ctx;
|
||||
const char *last_start, *next, *hash_value;
|
||||
int in_pgp_msg;
|
||||
|
||||
for (hash = hash_algorithms; hash->name != NULL; ++hash) {
|
||||
if (strncmp(hash_line, hash->name, hash->name_len))
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (isspace((unsigned char)hash_line[hash->name_len]))
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (hash->name == NULL) {
|
||||
const char *end_name;
|
||||
for (end_name = hash_line; *end_name != '\0'; ++end_name) {
|
||||
if (!isalnum((unsigned char)*end_name))
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
warnx("Unsupported hash algorithm: %.*s",
|
||||
(int)(end_name - hash_line), hash_line);
|
||||
return;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
hash_line += hash->name_len;
|
||||
if (!isspace((unsigned char)*hash_line))
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Invalid #CHECKSUM");
|
||||
while (isspace((unsigned char)*hash_line) && *hash_line != '\n')
|
||||
++hash_line;
|
||||
|
||||
if (*hash_line == '\n')
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Invalid #CHECKSUM");
|
||||
|
||||
ctx = (*hash->init)();
|
||||
if (strncmp(input, pgp_msg_start, strlen(pgp_msg_start)) == 0) {
|
||||
input += strlen(pgp_msg_start);
|
||||
in_pgp_msg = 1;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
in_pgp_msg = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
for (last_start = input; *input != '\0'; input = next) {
|
||||
if ((next = strchr(input, '\n')) == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Missing newline in pkg-vulnerabilities");
|
||||
++next;
|
||||
if (in_pgp_msg && strncmp(input, pgp_msg_end, strlen(pgp_msg_end)) == 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
if (!in_pgp_msg && strncmp(input, pkcs7_begin, strlen(pkcs7_begin)) == 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
if (*input == '\n' ||
|
||||
strncmp(input, "Hash:", 5) == 0 ||
|
||||
strncmp(input, "# $NetBSD", 9) == 0 ||
|
||||
strncmp(input, "#CHECKSUM", 9) == 0) {
|
||||
(*hash->update)(ctx, last_start, input - last_start);
|
||||
last_start = next;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
(*hash->update)(ctx, last_start, input - last_start);
|
||||
hash_value = (*hash->finish)(ctx);
|
||||
if (strncmp(hash_line, hash_value, strlen(hash_value)))
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "%s hash doesn't match", hash->name);
|
||||
hash_line += strlen(hash_value);
|
||||
|
||||
while (isspace((unsigned char)*hash_line) && *hash_line != '\n')
|
||||
++hash_line;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!isspace((unsigned char)*hash_line))
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Invalid #CHECKSUM");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
add_vulnerability(struct pkg_vulnerabilities *pv, size_t *allocated, const char *line)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t len_pattern, len_class, len_url;
|
||||
const char *start_pattern, *start_class, *start_url;
|
||||
|
||||
start_pattern = line;
|
||||
|
||||
start_class = line;
|
||||
while (*start_class != '\0' && !isspace((unsigned char)*start_class))
|
||||
++start_class;
|
||||
len_pattern = start_class - line;
|
||||
|
||||
while (*start_class != '\n' && isspace((unsigned char)*start_class))
|
||||
++start_class;
|
||||
|
||||
if (*start_class == '0' || *start_class == '\n')
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Input error: missing classification");
|
||||
|
||||
start_url = start_class;
|
||||
while (*start_url != '\0' && !isspace((unsigned char)*start_url))
|
||||
++start_url;
|
||||
len_class = start_url - start_class;
|
||||
|
||||
while (*start_url != '\n' && isspace((unsigned char)*start_url))
|
||||
++start_url;
|
||||
|
||||
if (*start_url == '0' || *start_url == '\n')
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Input error: missing URL");
|
||||
|
||||
line = start_url;
|
||||
while (*line != '\0' && !isspace((unsigned char)*line))
|
||||
++line;
|
||||
len_url = line - start_url;
|
||||
|
||||
if (pv->entries == *allocated) {
|
||||
if (*allocated == 0)
|
||||
*allocated = 16;
|
||||
else if (*allocated <= SSIZE_MAX / 2)
|
||||
*allocated *= 2;
|
||||
else
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Too many vulnerabilities");
|
||||
pv->vulnerability = xrealloc(pv->vulnerability,
|
||||
sizeof(char *) * *allocated);
|
||||
pv->classification = xrealloc(pv->classification,
|
||||
sizeof(char *) * *allocated);
|
||||
pv->advisory = xrealloc(pv->advisory,
|
||||
sizeof(char *) * *allocated);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
pv->vulnerability[pv->entries] = xmalloc(len_pattern + 1);
|
||||
memcpy(pv->vulnerability[pv->entries], start_pattern, len_pattern);
|
||||
pv->vulnerability[pv->entries][len_pattern] = '\0';
|
||||
pv->classification[pv->entries] = xmalloc(len_class + 1);
|
||||
memcpy(pv->classification[pv->entries], start_class, len_class);
|
||||
pv->classification[pv->entries][len_class] = '\0';
|
||||
pv->advisory[pv->entries] = xmalloc(len_url + 1);
|
||||
memcpy(pv->advisory[pv->entries], start_url, len_url);
|
||||
pv->advisory[pv->entries][len_url] = '\0';
|
||||
|
||||
++pv->entries;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct pkg_vulnerabilities *
|
||||
read_pkg_vulnerabilities_memory(void *buf, size_t len, int check_sum)
|
||||
{
|
||||
#ifdef BOOTSTRAP
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Audit functions are unsupported during bootstrap");
|
||||
#else
|
||||
struct archive *a;
|
||||
struct pkg_vulnerabilities *pv;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((a = archive_read_new()) == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "memory allocation failed");
|
||||
|
||||
if (archive_read_support_compression_all(a) != ARCHIVE_OK ||
|
||||
archive_read_support_format_raw(a) != ARCHIVE_OK ||
|
||||
archive_read_open_memory(a, buf, len) != ARCHIVE_OK)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot open pkg_vulnerabilies buffer: %s",
|
||||
archive_error_string(a));
|
||||
|
||||
pv = read_pkg_vulnerabilities_archive(a, check_sum);
|
||||
|
||||
return pv;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct pkg_vulnerabilities *
|
||||
read_pkg_vulnerabilities_file(const char *path, int ignore_missing, int check_sum)
|
||||
{
|
||||
#ifdef BOOTSTRAP
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Audit functions are unsupported during bootstrap");
|
||||
#else
|
||||
struct archive *a;
|
||||
struct pkg_vulnerabilities *pv;
|
||||
int fd;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((fd = open(path, O_RDONLY)) == -1) {
|
||||
if (errno == ENOENT && ignore_missing)
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
err(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot open %s", path);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if ((a = archive_read_new()) == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "memory allocation failed");
|
||||
|
||||
if (archive_read_support_compression_all(a) != ARCHIVE_OK ||
|
||||
archive_read_support_format_raw(a) != ARCHIVE_OK ||
|
||||
archive_read_open_fd(a, fd, 65536) != ARCHIVE_OK)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot open ``%s'': %s", path,
|
||||
archive_error_string(a));
|
||||
|
||||
pv = read_pkg_vulnerabilities_archive(a, check_sum);
|
||||
close(fd);
|
||||
|
||||
return pv;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef BOOTSTRAP
|
||||
static struct pkg_vulnerabilities *
|
||||
read_pkg_vulnerabilities_archive(struct archive *a, int check_sum)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct archive_entry *ae;
|
||||
struct pkg_vulnerabilities *pv;
|
||||
char *buf;
|
||||
size_t buf_len, off;
|
||||
ssize_t r;
|
||||
|
||||
if (archive_read_next_header(a, &ae) != ARCHIVE_OK)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot read pkg_vulnerabilities: %s",
|
||||
archive_error_string(a));
|
||||
|
||||
off = 0;
|
||||
buf_len = 65536;
|
||||
buf = xmalloc(buf_len + 1);
|
||||
|
||||
for (;;) {
|
||||
r = archive_read_data(a, buf + off, buf_len - off);
|
||||
if (r <= 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
off += r;
|
||||
if (off == buf_len) {
|
||||
buf_len *= 2;
|
||||
if (buf_len < off)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "pkg_vulnerabilties too large");
|
||||
buf = xrealloc(buf, buf_len + 1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (r != ARCHIVE_OK)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Cannot read pkg_vulnerabilities: %s",
|
||||
archive_error_string(a));
|
||||
|
||||
archive_read_close(a);
|
||||
|
||||
buf[off] = '\0';
|
||||
pv = parse_pkg_vuln(buf, off, check_sum);
|
||||
free(buf);
|
||||
return pv;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static struct pkg_vulnerabilities *
|
||||
parse_pkg_vuln(const char *input, size_t input_len, int check_sum)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct pkg_vulnerabilities *pv;
|
||||
long version;
|
||||
char *end;
|
||||
const char *iter, *next;
|
||||
size_t allocated_vulns;
|
||||
int in_pgp_msg;
|
||||
|
||||
pv = xmalloc(sizeof(*pv));
|
||||
|
||||
allocated_vulns = pv->entries = 0;
|
||||
pv->vulnerability = NULL;
|
||||
pv->classification = NULL;
|
||||
pv->advisory = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
if (strlen(input) != input_len)
|
||||
errx(1, "Invalid input (NUL character found)");
|
||||
|
||||
if (check_sum)
|
||||
verify_signature(input, input_len);
|
||||
|
||||
if (strncmp(input, pgp_msg_start, strlen(pgp_msg_start)) == 0) {
|
||||
iter = input + strlen(pgp_msg_start);
|
||||
in_pgp_msg = 1;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
iter = input;
|
||||
in_pgp_msg = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
for (; *iter; iter = next) {
|
||||
if ((next = strchr(iter, '\n')) == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Missing newline in pkg-vulnerabilities");
|
||||
++next;
|
||||
if (*iter == '\0' || *iter == '\n')
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (strncmp(iter, "Hash:", 5) == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (strncmp(iter, "# $NetBSD", 9) == 0)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (*iter == '#' && isspace((unsigned char)iter[1])) {
|
||||
for (++iter; iter != next; ++iter) {
|
||||
if (!isspace((unsigned char)*iter))
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Invalid header");
|
||||
}
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (strncmp(iter, "#FORMAT", 7) != 0)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Input header is malformed");
|
||||
|
||||
iter += 7;
|
||||
if (!isspace((unsigned char)*iter))
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Invalid #FORMAT");
|
||||
++iter;
|
||||
version = strtol(iter, &end, 10);
|
||||
if (iter == end || version != 1 || *end != '.')
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Input #FORMAT");
|
||||
iter = end + 1;
|
||||
version = strtol(iter, &end, 10);
|
||||
if (iter == end || version != 1 || *end != '.')
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Input #FORMAT");
|
||||
iter = end + 1;
|
||||
version = strtol(iter, &end, 10);
|
||||
if (iter == end || version != 0)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Input #FORMAT");
|
||||
for (iter = end; iter != next; ++iter) {
|
||||
if (!isspace((unsigned char)*iter))
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Input #FORMAT");
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (*iter == '\0')
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Missing #CHECKSUM or content");
|
||||
|
||||
for (iter = next; *iter; iter = next) {
|
||||
if ((next = strchr(iter, '\n')) == NULL)
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Missing newline in pkg-vulnerabilities");
|
||||
++next;
|
||||
if (*iter == '\0' || *iter == '\n')
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (in_pgp_msg && strncmp(iter, pgp_msg_end, strlen(pgp_msg_end)) == 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
if (!in_pgp_msg && strncmp(iter, pkcs7_begin, strlen(pkcs7_begin)) == 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
if (*iter == '#' &&
|
||||
(iter[1] == '\0' || iter[1] == '\n' || isspace((unsigned char)iter[1])))
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (strncmp(iter, "#CHECKSUM", 9) == 0) {
|
||||
iter += 9;
|
||||
if (!isspace((unsigned char)*iter))
|
||||
errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Invalid #CHECKSUM");
|
||||
while (isspace((unsigned char)*iter))
|
||||
++iter;
|
||||
verify_hash(input, iter);
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (*iter == '#') {
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* This should really be an error,
|
||||
* but it is still used.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
/* errx(EXIT_FAILURE, "Invalid data line starting with #"); */
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
add_vulnerability(pv, &allocated_vulns, iter);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (pv->entries != allocated_vulns) {
|
||||
pv->vulnerability = xrealloc(pv->vulnerability,
|
||||
sizeof(char *) * pv->entries);
|
||||
pv->classification = xrealloc(pv->classification,
|
||||
sizeof(char *) * pv->entries);
|
||||
pv->advisory = xrealloc(pv->advisory,
|
||||
sizeof(char *) * pv->entries);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return pv;
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
free_pkg_vulnerabilities(struct pkg_vulnerabilities *pv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t i;
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < pv->entries; ++i) {
|
||||
free(pv->vulnerability[i]);
|
||||
free(pv->classification[i]);
|
||||
free(pv->advisory[i]);
|
||||
}
|
||||
free(pv->vulnerability);
|
||||
free(pv->classification);
|
||||
free(pv->advisory);
|
||||
free(pv);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
check_ignored_entry(struct pkg_vulnerabilities *pv, size_t i)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *iter, *next;
|
||||
size_t entry_len, url_len;
|
||||
|
||||
if (ignore_advisories == NULL)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
url_len = strlen(pv->advisory[i]);
|
||||
|
||||
for (iter = ignore_advisories; *iter; iter = next) {
|
||||
if ((next = strchr(iter, '\n')) == NULL) {
|
||||
entry_len = strlen(iter);
|
||||
next = iter + entry_len;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
entry_len = next - iter;
|
||||
++next;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (url_len != entry_len)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (strncmp(pv->advisory[i], iter, entry_len) == 0)
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
audit_package(struct pkg_vulnerabilities *pv, const char *pkgname,
|
||||
const char *limit_vul_types, int output_type)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *output = output_type == 1 ? stdout : stderr;
|
||||
size_t i;
|
||||
int retval, do_eol;
|
||||
|
||||
retval = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
do_eol = (strcasecmp(check_eol, "yes") == 0);
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < pv->entries; ++i) {
|
||||
if (check_ignored_entry(pv, i))
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (limit_vul_types != NULL &&
|
||||
strcmp(limit_vul_types, pv->classification[i]))
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (!pkg_match(pv->vulnerability[i], pkgname))
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
if (strcmp("eol", pv->classification[i]) == 0) {
|
||||
if (!do_eol)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
retval = 1;
|
||||
if (output_type == 0) {
|
||||
puts(pkgname);
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
fprintf(output,
|
||||
"Package %s has reached end-of-life (eol), "
|
||||
"see %s/eol-packages\n", pkgname,
|
||||
tnf_vulnerability_base);
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
retval = 1;
|
||||
if (output_type == 0) {
|
||||
puts(pkgname);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
fprintf(output,
|
||||
"Package %s has a %s vulnerability, see %s\n",
|
||||
pkgname, pv->classification[i], pv->advisory[i]);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
return retval;
|
||||
}
|
102
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/xwrapper.c
vendored
Normal file
102
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/lib/xwrapper.c
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,102 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: xwrapper.c,v 1.1.1.1 2009/02/02 20:44:09 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*-
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2008 Joerg Sonnenberger <joerg@NetBSD.org>.
|
||||
* All rights reserved.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
|
||||
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
|
||||
* are met:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
|
||||
* notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
|
||||
* the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
|
||||
* distribution.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
|
||||
* ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
|
||||
* LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
|
||||
* FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
|
||||
* COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
|
||||
* INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
|
||||
* BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
|
||||
* AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
|
||||
* OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
|
||||
* OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
* SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include "config.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <nbcompat.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H
|
||||
#include <sys/cdefs.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
__RCSID("$NetBSD: xwrapper.c,v 1.1.1.1 2009/02/02 20:44:09 joerg Exp $");
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ERR_H
|
||||
#include <err.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <stdarg.h>
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "lib.h"
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
xasprintf(const char *fmt, ...)
|
||||
{
|
||||
va_list ap;
|
||||
char *buf;
|
||||
|
||||
va_start(ap, fmt);
|
||||
if (vasprintf(&buf, fmt, ap) == -1)
|
||||
err(1, "asprintf failed");
|
||||
va_end(ap);
|
||||
return buf;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void *
|
||||
xmalloc(size_t len)
|
||||
{
|
||||
void *ptr;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((ptr = malloc(len)) == NULL)
|
||||
err(1, "malloc failed");
|
||||
return ptr;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void *
|
||||
xcalloc(size_t len, size_t n)
|
||||
{
|
||||
void *ptr;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((ptr = calloc(len, n)) == NULL)
|
||||
err(1, "calloc failed");
|
||||
return ptr;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void *
|
||||
xrealloc(void *buf, size_t len)
|
||||
{
|
||||
void *ptr;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((ptr = realloc(buf, len)) == NULL)
|
||||
err(1, "realloc failed");
|
||||
return ptr;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
xstrdup(const char *str)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *buf;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((buf = strdup(str)) == NULL)
|
||||
err(1, "strdup failed");
|
||||
return buf;
|
||||
}
|
136
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/x509/pkgsrc.cnf
vendored
Normal file
136
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/x509/pkgsrc.cnf
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,136 @@
|
|||
# $NetBSD: pkgsrc.cnf,v 1.1.1.1 2009/02/02 20:44:09 joerg Exp $
|
||||
#
|
||||
# OpenSSL sample configuration file for use by pkgsrc.sh
|
||||
#
|
||||
|
||||
# This definition stops the following lines choking if HOME isn't
|
||||
# defined.
|
||||
HOME = .
|
||||
RANDFILE = $ENV::HOME/.rnd
|
||||
|
||||
####################################################################
|
||||
[ ca ]
|
||||
default_ca = CA_default # The default ca section
|
||||
|
||||
####################################################################
|
||||
[ CA_default ]
|
||||
|
||||
dir = ./pkgsrc # Where everything is kept
|
||||
certs = $dir/certs # Where the issued certs are kept
|
||||
crl_dir = $dir/crl # Where the issued crl are kept
|
||||
database = $dir/index.txt # database index file.
|
||||
#unique_subject = no # Set to 'no' to allow creation of
|
||||
# several ctificates with same subject.
|
||||
new_certs_dir = $dir/newcerts # default place for new certs.
|
||||
|
||||
certificate = $dir/cacert.pem # The CA certificate
|
||||
serial = $dir/serial # The current serial number
|
||||
crlnumber = $dir/crlnumber # the current crl number
|
||||
# must be commented out to leave a V1 CRL
|
||||
crl = $dir/crl.pem # The current CRL
|
||||
private_key = $dir/private/cakey.pem# The private key
|
||||
RANDFILE = $dir/private/.rand # private random number file
|
||||
|
||||
# Comment out the following two lines for the "traditional"
|
||||
# (and highly broken) format.
|
||||
name_opt = ca_default # Subject Name options
|
||||
cert_opt = ca_default # Certificate field options
|
||||
|
||||
# Extension copying option: use with caution.
|
||||
# copy_extensions = copy
|
||||
|
||||
# Extensions to add to a CRL. Note: Netscape communicator chokes on V2 CRLs
|
||||
# so this is commented out by default to leave a V1 CRL.
|
||||
# crlnumber must also be commented out to leave a V1 CRL.
|
||||
# crl_extensions = crl_ext
|
||||
|
||||
default_days = 365 # how long to certify for
|
||||
default_crl_days= 30 # how long before next CRL
|
||||
default_md = default # use public key default MD
|
||||
preserve = no # keep passed DN ordering
|
||||
|
||||
# A few difference way of specifying how similar the request should look
|
||||
# For type CA, the listed attributes must be the same, and the optional
|
||||
# and supplied fields are just that :-)
|
||||
policy = policy_match
|
||||
|
||||
# For the CA policy
|
||||
[ policy_match ]
|
||||
countryName = match
|
||||
stateOrProvinceName = match
|
||||
organizationName = match
|
||||
organizationalUnitName = optional
|
||||
commonName = supplied
|
||||
emailAddress = optional
|
||||
|
||||
# For the 'anything' policy
|
||||
# At this point in time, you must list all acceptable 'object'
|
||||
# types.
|
||||
[ policy_anything ]
|
||||
countryName = optional
|
||||
stateOrProvinceName = optional
|
||||
localityName = optional
|
||||
organizationName = optional
|
||||
organizationalUnitName = optional
|
||||
commonName = supplied
|
||||
emailAddress = optional
|
||||
|
||||
####################################################################
|
||||
[ req ]
|
||||
default_bits = 2048
|
||||
default_keyfile = privkey.pem
|
||||
default_md = sha1
|
||||
distinguished_name = req_distinguished_name
|
||||
x509_extensions = v3_ca # The extentions to add to the self signed cert
|
||||
|
||||
string_mask = utf8only
|
||||
|
||||
[ req_distinguished_name ]
|
||||
countryName = Country Name (2 letter code)
|
||||
countryName_default = AU
|
||||
countryName_min = 2
|
||||
countryName_max = 2
|
||||
|
||||
stateOrProvinceName = State or Province Name (full name)
|
||||
stateOrProvinceName_default = Some-State
|
||||
|
||||
localityName = Locality Name (eg, city)
|
||||
|
||||
0.organizationName = Organization Name (eg, company)
|
||||
0.organizationName_default = Internet Widgits Pty Ltd
|
||||
|
||||
# we can do this but it is not needed normally :-)
|
||||
#1.organizationName = Second Organization Name (eg, company)
|
||||
#1.organizationName_default = World Wide Web Pty Ltd
|
||||
|
||||
organizationalUnitName = Organizational Unit Name (eg, section)
|
||||
#organizationalUnitName_default =
|
||||
|
||||
commonName = Common Name (eg, YOUR name)
|
||||
commonName_max = 64
|
||||
|
||||
emailAddress = Email Address
|
||||
emailAddress_max = 64
|
||||
|
||||
[ pkgkey ]
|
||||
nsComment = "Certificate for binary pkgsrc packages"
|
||||
|
||||
subjectKeyIdentifier=hash
|
||||
authorityKeyIdentifier=keyid,issuer
|
||||
|
||||
subjectAltName=email:move
|
||||
|
||||
extendedKeyUsage = codeSigning, emailProtection
|
||||
|
||||
[ pkgsec ]
|
||||
nsComment = "Certificate for pkg-vulnerabilities"
|
||||
|
||||
subjectKeyIdentifier=hash
|
||||
authorityKeyIdentifier=keyid,issuer
|
||||
|
||||
subjectAltName=email:move
|
||||
|
||||
[ v3_ca ]
|
||||
subjectKeyIdentifier=hash
|
||||
authorityKeyIdentifier=keyid:always,issuer:always
|
||||
basicConstraints = critical,CA:true
|
63
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/x509/pkgsrc.sh
vendored
Normal file
63
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/x509/pkgsrc.sh
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,63 @@
|
|||
#!/bin/sh
|
||||
#
|
||||
# $NetBSD: pkgsrc.sh,v 1.1.1.1 2009/02/02 20:44:09 joerg Exp $
|
||||
#
|
||||
|
||||
CA="openssl ca -config pkgsrc.cnf"
|
||||
REQ="openssl req -config pkgsrc.cnf"
|
||||
|
||||
set -e
|
||||
|
||||
new_ca() {
|
||||
if [ -f $1/serial ]; then
|
||||
echo "CA already exists, exiting" >& 2
|
||||
exit 1
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
mkdir -p $1/certs $1/crl $1/newcerts $1/private
|
||||
echo "00" > $1/serial
|
||||
touch $1/index.txt
|
||||
|
||||
echo "Making CA certificate ..."
|
||||
$REQ -new -keyout $1/private/cakey.pem \
|
||||
-out $1/careq.pem
|
||||
$CA -out $1/cacert.pem -batch \
|
||||
-keyfile $1/private/cakey.pem -selfsign \
|
||||
-infiles $1/careq.pem
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
new_pkgkey() {
|
||||
$REQ -new -keyout pkgkey_key.pem -out pkgkey_req.pem
|
||||
$CA -extensions pkgkey -policy policy_match -out pkgkey_cert.pem -infiles pkgkey_req.pem
|
||||
rm pkgkey_req.pem
|
||||
echo "Signed certificate is in pkgkey_cert.pem, key in pkgkey_key.pem"
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
new_pkgsec() {
|
||||
$REQ -new -keyout pkgsec_key.pem -out pkgsec_req.pem
|
||||
$CA -extensions pkgsec -policy policy_match -out pkgsec_cert.pem -infiles pkgsec_req.pem
|
||||
rm pkgsec_req.pem
|
||||
echo "Signed certificate is in pkgsec_cert.pem, key in pkgsec_key.pem"
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
usage() {
|
||||
echo "$0:"
|
||||
echo "setup - create new CA in ./pkgsrc for use by pkg_install"
|
||||
echo "pkgkey - create and sign a certificate for binary packages"
|
||||
echo "pkgsec - create and sign a certificate for pkg-vulnerabilities"
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
case "$1" in
|
||||
setup)
|
||||
new_ca ./pkgsrc
|
||||
;;
|
||||
pkgkey)
|
||||
new_pkgkey
|
||||
;;
|
||||
pkgsec)
|
||||
new_pkgsec
|
||||
;;
|
||||
*)
|
||||
usage
|
||||
;;
|
||||
esac
|
59
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/x509/signing.txt
vendored
Normal file
59
external/bsd/pkg_install/dist/x509/signing.txt
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,59 @@
|
|||
Use of digital signatures in pkg_install
|
||||
----------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
(1) pkg_vulnerabilities: list of known vulnerabilities, provided by
|
||||
the pkgsrc security team and updated regulary
|
||||
(2) binary packages: check who provided binary packages
|
||||
|
||||
For (1) gpg is currently the only choice. After pkgsrcCon (?) a PKCS7
|
||||
signature will be added as well. With the pkg_install-renovation branch,
|
||||
PKCS7 is the only supported verification mechanism for (2) and preferred
|
||||
for (1) once the infrastructure exists.
|
||||
|
||||
PKCS7 is a format to use RSA public key cryptography with X509
|
||||
certificates. Those are commonly used for SSL. X509 implements a
|
||||
hierachical trust model. For this purpose it means that one or more
|
||||
certificates are installed and marked as trusted. A certificate used for
|
||||
signing a binary package or pkg_vulnerabilities will have to be included
|
||||
in the list to be trusted OR it must be itself signed by a trusted
|
||||
certificate. The original list is called the TRUST ANCHOR.
|
||||
|
||||
Optionally, a second list of certificates can be provided to fill gaps.
|
||||
Let's assume A is a trust anchor and C is used to sign a package. C
|
||||
itself is not signed by A, so it won't be trusted. Instead, there's a
|
||||
third certificate B; and C includes a signature with B. The certificate
|
||||
chain file can now provide B signed by A. This gives a certificate chain
|
||||
of C -> B (included in the package) -> A (with the chain file) and the
|
||||
signature is valid and trusted.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Practical implications for pkgsrc users:
|
||||
- get the pkgsrc-security certificate and point CERTIFICATE_ANCHOR_PKGVULN to it
|
||||
- get the certificate used by your bulk builder and point
|
||||
CERTIFICATE_ANCHOR_PKGS to it
|
||||
- at some later point a CA for pkgsrc might be created, in that case it
|
||||
will serve as certificate for both purposes; a list of all certificates
|
||||
will be provided in that case to point CERTIFICATE_CHAIN to.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
How to create your own keys:
|
||||
|
||||
The pkgsrc.sh script and the corresponding pkgsrc.cnf file provide a working
|
||||
wrapper around the OpenSSL command line tool.
|
||||
|
||||
The root certificate can be created by running "sh pkgsrc.sh setup",
|
||||
the output can found in the pkgsrc subdirectory of the current directory.
|
||||
The meta data is for human beings and displayed e.g. by pkg_add, but not
|
||||
relevant for cryptographic purposes. pkgsrc/newcerts/00.pem is the
|
||||
public key and can be used as trust anchor.
|
||||
A certificate for signing packages can be created by running
|
||||
"sh pkgsrc.sh pkgkey". The private key can be found in pkgkey_key.pem
|
||||
and the certificate in pkgkey_cert.pem.
|
||||
Similary, "sh pkgsrc.sh pkgsec" will create a certificate/key pair for
|
||||
signing pkg-vulnerabilities.
|
||||
|
||||
How to verify a certificate:
|
||||
- decode the data with "openssl x509 -text -noout -in newcert.pem"
|
||||
- "Issuer" is vouching for the identity (and reliability) of "Subject"
|
||||
- "X509v3 Basic Constraints" should list "CA:FALSE" for all keys that are not allowed
|
||||
to sign further keys.
|
28
external/bsd/pkg_install/lib/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
28
external/bsd/pkg_install/lib/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,28 @@
|
|||
# $NetBSD: Makefile,v 1.9 2010/04/23 20:56:01 joerg Exp $
|
||||
# Original from FreeBSD, no rcs id.
|
||||
|
||||
LIBISPRIVATE= yes
|
||||
|
||||
LIB= install
|
||||
SRCS= automatic.c conflicts.c dewey.c \
|
||||
fexec.c file.c global.c gpgsig.c iterate.c license.c lpkg.c \
|
||||
opattern.c parse-config.c pkcs7.c pkg_signature.c \
|
||||
pkgdb.c pkg_io.c plist.c remove.c \
|
||||
str.c version.c var.c vulnerabilities-file.c xwrapper.c
|
||||
MAN= pkg_install.conf.5 pkg_summary.5
|
||||
|
||||
version.o: version.h version.c
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.init.mk>
|
||||
|
||||
pkg_install.conf.5: ${DIST}/lib/pkg_install.conf.5.in
|
||||
${TOOL_SED} -e 's,@SYSCONFDIR@,/etc,' \
|
||||
${DIST}/lib/pkg_install.conf.5.in > ${.TARGET}
|
||||
|
||||
.PATH: ${DIST}/lib
|
||||
|
||||
CLEANFILES+= pkg_install.conf.5
|
||||
|
||||
CPPFLAGS+= -DNETBSD
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.lib.mk>
|
197
external/bsd/pkg_install/lib/config.h
vendored
Normal file
197
external/bsd/pkg_install/lib/config.h
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,197 @@
|
|||
/* lib/config.h. Generated from config.h.in by configure. */
|
||||
/* lib/config.h.in. Generated from configure.ac by autoheader. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <assert.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_ASSERT_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <ctype.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_CTYPE_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <dirent.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_DIRENT_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <errno.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_ERRNO_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <err.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_ERR_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <fnctl.h> header file. */
|
||||
/* #undef HAVE_FNCTL_H */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <fnmatch.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_FNMATCH_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <glob.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_GLOB_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <grp.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_GRP_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <inttypes.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_INTTYPES_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the `db' library (-ldb). */
|
||||
/* #undef HAVE_LIBDB */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <limits.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_LIMITS_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <memory.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_MEMORY_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <pwd.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_PWD_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <signal.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_SIGNAL_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <stdarg.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_STDARG_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <stdint.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_STDINT_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <stdio.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_STDIO_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <stdlib.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_STDLIB_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <strings.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_STRINGS_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <string.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_STRING_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/cdefs.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_SYS_CDEFS_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/file.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_SYS_FILE_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/ioctl.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_SYS_IOCTL_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/param.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/queue.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_SYS_QUEUE_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/stat.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_SYS_STAT_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/time.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_SYS_TIME_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/types.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_SYS_TYPES_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/utsname.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_SYS_UTSNAME_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <sys/wait.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_SYS_WAIT_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <time.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_TIME_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <unistd.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_UNISTD_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the `vfork' function. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_VFORK 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the <vis.h> header file. */
|
||||
#define HAVE_VIS_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if the `z' modifider for printf is missing. */
|
||||
/* #undef MISSING_SIZE_T_SUPPORT */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Defined when PRIu64 is missing or broken */
|
||||
/* #undef NEED_PRI_MACRO */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Defined when to retain only the numeric OS version */
|
||||
/* #undef NUMERIC_VERSION_ONLY */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the address where bug reports for this package should be sent. */
|
||||
#define PACKAGE_BUGREPORT "joerg@NetBSD.org"
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the full name of this package. */
|
||||
#define PACKAGE_NAME "pkg_install"
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the full name and version of this package. */
|
||||
#define PACKAGE_STRING "pkg_install 20090911"
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the one symbol short name of this package. */
|
||||
#define PACKAGE_TARNAME "pkg_install"
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the home page for this package. */
|
||||
#define PACKAGE_URL ""
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the version of this package. */
|
||||
#define PACKAGE_VERSION "20090911"
|
||||
|
||||
/* The size of `int', as computed by sizeof. */
|
||||
#define SIZEOF_INT 4
|
||||
|
||||
/* The size of `long', as computed by sizeof. */
|
||||
#define SIZEOF_LONG 8
|
||||
|
||||
/* The size of `long long', as computed by sizeof. */
|
||||
#define SIZEOF_LONG_LONG 8
|
||||
|
||||
/* The size of `size_t', as computed by sizeof. */
|
||||
#define SIZEOF_SIZE_T 8
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the ANSI C header files. */
|
||||
#define STDC_HEADERS 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define for Solaris 2.5.1 so the uint32_t typedef from <sys/synch.h>,
|
||||
<pthread.h>, or <semaphore.h> is not used. If the typedef were allowed, the
|
||||
#define below would cause a syntax error. */
|
||||
/* #undef _UINT32_T */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define for Solaris 2.5.1 so the uint64_t typedef from <sys/synch.h>,
|
||||
<pthread.h>, or <semaphore.h> is not used. If the typedef were allowed, the
|
||||
#define below would cause a syntax error. */
|
||||
/* #undef _UINT64_T */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define for Solaris 2.5.1 so the uint8_t typedef from <sys/synch.h>,
|
||||
<pthread.h>, or <semaphore.h> is not used. If the typedef were allowed, the
|
||||
#define below would cause a syntax error. */
|
||||
/* #undef _UINT8_T */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the type of an unsigned integer type of width exactly 16 bits if
|
||||
such a type exists and the standard includes do not define it. */
|
||||
/* #undef uint16_t */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the type of an unsigned integer type of width exactly 32 bits if
|
||||
such a type exists and the standard includes do not define it. */
|
||||
/* #undef uint32_t */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the type of an unsigned integer type of width exactly 64 bits if
|
||||
such a type exists and the standard includes do not define it. */
|
||||
/* #undef uint64_t */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the type of an unsigned integer type of width exactly 8 bits if
|
||||
such a type exists and the standard includes do not define it. */
|
||||
/* #undef uint8_t */
|
||||
|
||||
#if !HAVE_VFORK
|
||||
# define vfork fork
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef MISSING_SIZE_T_SUPPORT
|
||||
# define PRIzu "zu"
|
||||
#elif SIZEOF_SIZE_T == SIZEOF_INT
|
||||
# define PRIzu "u"
|
||||
#elif SIZEOF_SIZE_T == SIZEOF_LONG
|
||||
# define PRIzu "lu"
|
||||
#elif SIZEOF_SIZE_T == SIZEOF_LONG_LONG
|
||||
# define PRIzu "llu"
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# errror "Unknown size_t size"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
8
external/bsd/pkg_install/lib/nbcompat.h
vendored
Normal file
8
external/bsd/pkg_install/lib/nbcompat.h
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,8 @@
|
|||
/* $NetBSD: nbcompat.h,v 1.1 2008/09/30 19:19:56 joerg Exp $ */
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* In pkgsrc, libnbcompat is used to provide compatibility functions.
|
||||
* This is not needed on native NetBSD, so provide an empty header.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <sys/statvfs.h>
|
13
external/bsd/pkg_install/prepare-import.sh
vendored
Normal file
13
external/bsd/pkg_install/prepare-import.sh
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,13 @@
|
|||
#!/bin/sh
|
||||
# $NetBSD: prepare-import.sh,v 1.4 2013/04/20 15:30:34 wiz Exp $
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Copy new pkgsrc/pkgtools/pkg_install/files to dist.
|
||||
# Run this script and check for additional files and
|
||||
# directories to prune, only relevant content is included.
|
||||
|
||||
set -e
|
||||
|
||||
cd dist
|
||||
rm -f Makefile.in README config* install-sh tkpkg
|
||||
rm -f */Makefile.in */*.cat*
|
||||
rm -rf CVS */CVS view
|
6
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
6
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
|
|||
# $NetBSD: Makefile,v 1.3 2009/02/02 20:47:21 joerg Exp $
|
||||
|
||||
SUBDIR= bpm pkg_add pkg_admin pkg_create \
|
||||
pkg_delete pkg_info
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.subdir.mk>
|
25
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/Makefile.inc
vendored
Normal file
25
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/Makefile.inc
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,25 @@
|
|||
# $NetBSD: Makefile.inc,v 1.3 2010/11/05 09:09:01 he Exp $
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.own.mk>
|
||||
|
||||
.include "${.PARSEDIR}/../Makefile.inc"
|
||||
|
||||
LIBINSTALL != cd ${.PARSEDIR}/../lib && ${PRINTOBJDIR}
|
||||
|
||||
BINDIR?= /usr/sbin
|
||||
CPPFLAGS+= -DBINDIR='"${BINDIR}"'
|
||||
|
||||
DPADD+= ${LIBINSTALL}/libinstall.a
|
||||
LDADD+= -L${LIBINSTALL} -linstall -ltermcap
|
||||
|
||||
DPADD+= ${LIBFETCH} ${LIBSSL} ${LIBCRYPTO}
|
||||
LDADD+= -lfetch -lssl -lcrypto
|
||||
|
||||
DPADD+= ${LIBARCHIVE}
|
||||
LDADD+= -larchive
|
||||
|
||||
DPADD+= ${LIBZ} ${LIBBZ2}
|
||||
LDADD+= -lz -lbz2
|
||||
|
||||
DPADD+= ${LIBLZMA}
|
||||
LDADD+= -llzma
|
15
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/bpm/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
15
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/bpm/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,15 @@
|
|||
# $NetBSD: Makefile,v 1.1 2008/09/30 19:19:56 joerg Exp $
|
||||
|
||||
SCRIPTS= bpm.sh
|
||||
MAN= bpm.1
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.init.mk>
|
||||
|
||||
.PATH: ${DIST}/bpm
|
||||
|
||||
CLEANFILES+= bpm.sh
|
||||
|
||||
bpm.sh: ${DIST}/bpm/bpm.sh.in
|
||||
${TOOL_CAT} ${DIST}/bpm/bpm.sh.in > ${.TARGET}
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.prog.mk>
|
13
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/pkg_add/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
13
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/pkg_add/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,13 @@
|
|||
# $NetBSD: Makefile,v 1.2 2009/02/02 20:47:21 joerg Exp $
|
||||
# Original from FreeBSD, no rcs id.
|
||||
|
||||
PROG= pkg_add
|
||||
SRCS= main.c perform.c
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.init.mk>
|
||||
|
||||
.PATH: ${DIST}/add
|
||||
|
||||
CPPFLAGS+= -DMACHINE_ARCH=\"${MACHINE_ARCH}\"
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.prog.mk>
|
22
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/pkg_admin/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
22
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/pkg_admin/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,22 @@
|
|||
# $NetBSD: Makefile,v 1.2 2009/02/02 20:47:21 joerg Exp $
|
||||
|
||||
PROG= pkg_admin
|
||||
SRCS= audit.c check.c main.c
|
||||
|
||||
SCRIPTS= audit-packages.sh download-vulnerability-list.sh
|
||||
CLEANFILES= audit-packages.sh download-vulnerability-list.sh
|
||||
|
||||
audit-packages.sh: audit-packages.sh.in
|
||||
sed -e 's|@PKG_ADMIN@|/usr/sbin/pkg_admin|' \
|
||||
${DIST}/admin/audit-packages.sh.in > $@
|
||||
|
||||
download-vulnerability-list.sh: download-vulnerability-list.sh.in
|
||||
sed -e 's|@PKG_ADMIN@|/usr/sbin/pkg_admin|' \
|
||||
${DIST}/admin/download-vulnerability-list.sh.in > $@
|
||||
|
||||
LINK_PKGVUL= yes
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.init.mk>
|
||||
|
||||
.PATH: ${DIST}/admin
|
||||
.include <bsd.prog.mk>
|
11
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/pkg_create/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
11
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/pkg_create/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
|
|||
# $NetBSD: Makefile,v 1.2 2009/02/02 20:47:21 joerg Exp $
|
||||
# Original from FreeBSD, no rcs id.
|
||||
|
||||
PROG= pkg_create
|
||||
SRCS= main.c perform.c pl.c util.c build.c
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.init.mk>
|
||||
|
||||
.PATH: ${DIST}/create
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.prog.mk>
|
10
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/pkg_delete/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
10
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/pkg_delete/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,10 @@
|
|||
# $NetBSD: Makefile,v 1.2 2009/02/25 21:23:17 joerg Exp $
|
||||
# Original from FreeBSD, no rcs id.
|
||||
|
||||
PROG= pkg_delete
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.init.mk>
|
||||
|
||||
.PATH: ${DIST}/delete
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.prog.mk>
|
13
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/pkg_info/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
13
external/bsd/pkg_install/sbin/pkg_info/Makefile
vendored
Normal file
|
@ -0,0 +1,13 @@
|
|||
# $NetBSD: Makefile,v 1.3 2011/05/26 12:56:26 joerg Exp $
|
||||
# Original from FreeBSD, no rcs id
|
||||
|
||||
PROG= pkg_info
|
||||
SRCS= main.c perform.c show.c
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.init.mk>
|
||||
|
||||
.PATH: ${DIST}/info
|
||||
|
||||
CWARNFLAGS.clang+= -Wno-format-security
|
||||
|
||||
.include <bsd.prog.mk>
|
Loading…
Reference in a new issue